]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Doc fixes: markup (mainly nil -> @code{nil})
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @documentencoding UTF-8
8 @setchapternewpage odd
9 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
10
11 @include emacsver.texi
12
13 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
14 @c @texline foo
15 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
16 @c @infoline foo
17 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
18
19 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
20 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
21
22 @iftex
23 @macro texline
24 @end macro
25 @alias infoline=comment
26 @alias expr=math
27 @alias tfn=code
28 @alias mathit=expr
29 @alias summarykey=key
30 @macro cpi{}
31 @math{@pi{}}
32 @end macro
33 @macro cpiover{den}
34 @math{@pi/\den\}
35 @end macro
36 @end iftex
37
38 @ifnottex
39 @alias texline=comment
40 @macro infoline{stuff}
41 \stuff\
42 @end macro
43 @alias expr=samp
44 @alias tfn=t
45 @alias mathit=i
46 @macro summarykey{ky}
47 \ky\
48 @end macro
49 @macro cpi{}
50 @expr{pi}
51 @end macro
52 @macro cpiover{den}
53 @expr{pi/\den\}
54 @end macro
55 @end ifnottex
56
57
58 @tex
59 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
60 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
61 @end tex
62
63 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
64 @iftex
65 @finalout
66 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
67 @tex
68 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
69
70 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
71 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
72 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
73 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
74 @end tex
75 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
76 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
77 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
78 @ignore
79 @newcount@calcpageno
80 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
81 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
82 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
83 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
84 \r@ggedbottomtrue
85 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
86 @end ignore
87 @end iftex
88
89 @copying
90 @ifinfo
91 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
92 @end ifinfo
93 @ifnotinfo
94 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
95 GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
96 @end ifnotinfo
97
98 Copyright @copyright{} 1990--1991, 2001--2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
99
100 @quotation
101 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
102 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
103 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
104 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
105 Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
106 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
107 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
108
109 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
110 modify this GNU manual.''
111 @end quotation
112 @end copying
113
114 @dircategory Emacs misc features
115 @direntry
116 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
117 @end direntry
118
119 @titlepage
120 @sp 6
121 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
122 @sp 4
123 @center GNU Emacs Calc
124 @c [volume]
125 @sp 5
126 @center Dave Gillespie
127 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
128 @page
129
130 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
131 @insertcopying
132 @end titlepage
133
134
135 @summarycontents
136
137 @c [end]
138
139 @contents
140
141 @c [begin]
142 @ifnottex
143 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
144 @top The GNU Emacs Calculator
145
146 @noindent
147 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
148 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
149
150 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
151 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
152 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
153 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
154 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
155 @end ifnottex
156
157 @ifinfo
158 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
159 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
160 longer Info tutorial.)
161 @end ifinfo
162
163 @insertcopying
164
165 @menu
166 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
167 @ifinfo
168 * Interactive Tutorial::
169 @end ifinfo
170 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
171
172 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
173 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
174 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
175 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
176 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
177 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
178 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
179 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
180 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
181 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
182 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
183 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
184 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
185 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
186 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
187
188 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
189 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
190 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
191 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
192
193 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
194
195 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
196 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
197 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
198 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
199 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
200 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
201 @end menu
202
203 @ifinfo
204 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
205 @end ifinfo
206 @ifnotinfo
207 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
208 @end ifnotinfo
209 @chapter Getting Started
210 @noindent
211 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
212 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
213 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
214
215 @menu
216 * What is Calc::
217 * About This Manual::
218 * Notations Used in This Manual::
219 * Demonstration of Calc::
220 * Using Calc::
221 * History and Acknowledgments::
222 @end menu
223
224 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
225 @section What is Calc?
226
227 @noindent
228 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
229 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
230 series of calculators, its many features include:
231
232 @itemize @bullet
233 @item
234 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
235
236 @item
237 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
238
239 @item
240 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
241 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
242 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
243 and algebraic formulas.
244
245 @item
246 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
247
248 @item
249 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
250
251 @item
252 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
253
254 @item
255 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
256 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
257
258 @item
259 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
260
261 @item
262 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
263
264 @item
265 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
266 inside any editing buffer.
267
268 @item
269 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
270
271 @item
272 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
273 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
274 @end itemize
275
276 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
277 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
278 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
279 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
280 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
281 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
282 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
283 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
284
285 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
286 @section About This Manual
287
288 @noindent
289 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
290 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
291 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
292 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
293 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
294 regularly.
295
296 This manual is divided into three major parts: the ``Getting
297 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
298 reference manual.
299 @c [when-split]
300 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
301 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
302 @c chapter.
303
304 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
305 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
306 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
307 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
308 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
309
310 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
311 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
312 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
313 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
314 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
315 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
316 to use its features.
317
318 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
319 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
320 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
321 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
322 need to know.
323
324 @c @cindex Marginal notes
325 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
326 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
327 variables also have their own indices.
328 @c @texline Each
329 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
330 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
331 @c in the margin with its index entry.
332
333 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
334 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
335 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
336 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
337 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
338 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
339 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
340 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
341 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
342 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
343
344 @ifnottex
345 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
346 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
347 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
348 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
349 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
350 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
351 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
352 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
353 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
354 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
355 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
356 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
357 The result will be a device-independent output file called
358 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
359 for your system. On many systems, the command is
360
361 @example
362 lpr -d calc.dvi
363 @end example
364
365 @noindent
366 or
367
368 @example
369 dvips calc.dvi
370 @end example
371 @end ifnottex
372 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
373 @c Foundation.
374
375 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
376 @section Notations Used in This Manual
377
378 @noindent
379 This section describes the various notations that are used
380 throughout the Calc manual.
381
382 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
383 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
384 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
385 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
386 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
387 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
388 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
389 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
390 regularly using Emacs.
391
392 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
393 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
394 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
395 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
396 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
397
398 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
399 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
400 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
401
402 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
403 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
404 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
405 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
406
407 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
408 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
409 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
410 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
411 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
412
413 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
414 [@code{sincos}].
415
416 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
417 @section A Demonstration of Calc
418
419 @noindent
420 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
421 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
422 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
423 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
424 Tutorial.
425
426 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
427 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
428 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
429 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
430
431 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
432 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
433 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
434 Delete, and Space keys.
435
436 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
437 then the command to operate on the numbers.
438
439 @noindent
440 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
441 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
442 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
443
444 @noindent
445 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
446 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
447 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
448
449 @noindent
450 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
451
452 @noindent
453 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
454 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
455
456 @noindent
457 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
458
459 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
460 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
461 use the apostrophe key.
462
463 @noindent
464 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
465 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
466 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
467
468 @noindent
469 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
470 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
471 @infoline `pi' squared.
472 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
473
474 @noindent
475 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
476 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
477
478 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
479 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
480 the next section.)
481
482 @noindent
483 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
484 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
485
486 @noindent
487 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
488
489 @noindent
490 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
491
492 @noindent
493 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
494
495 @noindent
496 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
497 the Keypad Calculator off.
498
499 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
500 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
501 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
502 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
503 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
504 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
505 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
506
507 @example
508 @group
509 1.23 1.97
510 1.6 2
511 1.19 1.08
512 @end group
513 @end example
514
515 @noindent
516 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
517 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
518
519 @noindent
520 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
521 the product of the numbers.
522
523 @noindent
524 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
525 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
526 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
527
528 @noindent
529 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
530 @texline @math{3\times2}
531 @infoline 3x2
532 matrix into a
533 @texline @math{2\times3}
534 @infoline 2x3
535 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
536 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
537 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
538 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
539
540 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
541 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
542 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
543
544 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
545 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
546 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
547 many weeks have passed since then.
548
549 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
550 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
551 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
552 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
553 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
554 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
555
556 @noindent
557 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
558 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
559 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
560 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the @LaTeX{} typesetting
561 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
562
563 @noindent
564 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
565 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
566
567 @ifnotinfo
568 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
569 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
570 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
571 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
572 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
573 @end ifnotinfo
574 @ifinfo
575 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
576 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
577 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
578 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
579 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
580 @end ifinfo
581
582 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
583 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
584
585 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgments, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
586 @section Using Calc
587
588 @noindent
589 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
590 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
591 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
592
593 @menu
594 * Starting Calc::
595 * The Standard Interface::
596 * Quick Mode Overview::
597 * Keypad Mode Overview::
598 * Standalone Operation::
599 * Embedded Mode Overview::
600 * Other C-x * Commands::
601 @end menu
602
603 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
604 @subsection Starting Calc
605
606 @noindent
607 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
608 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
609 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
610
611 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
612 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
613 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
614 which Calc interface you want to use.
615
616 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
617 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
618 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
619 a complete list.
620
621 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
622 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
623 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
624
625 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
626 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
627 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
628 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
629 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
630
631 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
632 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
633
634 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
635 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
636
637 @noindent
638 @cindex Standard user interface
639 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
640 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
641 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
642 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
643
644 @smallexample
645 @group
646
647 ...
648 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
649 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
650 2: 17.3 | 17.3
651 1: -5 | 3
652 . | 2
653 | 4
654 | * 8
655 | ->-5
656 |
657 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
658 @end group
659 @end smallexample
660
661 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
662 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
663 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
664 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
665 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
666 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
667 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
668 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
669 you do.
670
671 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
672 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
673 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
674 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
675 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
676
677 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
678 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
679 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
680
681 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
682 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
683 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
684 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
685 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
686 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
687 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
688
689 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
690 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
691 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
692 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
693 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
694 as Calc commands.
695
696 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
697 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
698 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
699 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
700 Calculator.
701
702 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
703 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
704 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
705 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
706 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
707 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
708 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
709
710 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
711
712 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
713 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
714 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
715 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
716 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
717 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
718 normal partial-screen mode.
719
720 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
721 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
722 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
723 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
724 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
725 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
726 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
727
728 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
729 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
730
731 @noindent
732 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
733 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
734 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
735
736 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
737 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
738 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
739 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
740 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
741 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
742 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
743 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
744
745 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
746 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
747
748 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
749 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
750
751 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
752 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
753
754 @noindent
755 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
756 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
757 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
758 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
759
760 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
761 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
762 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
763 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
764
765 @tex
766 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
767 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
768 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
769 \medskip
770 @end tex
771 @smallexample
772 @group
773 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
774 |2: 17.3
775 |1: -5
776 | .
777 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
778 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
779 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
780 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
781 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
782 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
783 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
784 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
785 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
786 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
787 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
788 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
789 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
790 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
791 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
792 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
793 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
794 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
795 @end group
796 @end smallexample
797
798 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
799 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
800 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
801 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
802 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
803 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
804
805 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
806 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
807 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
808 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
809 the stack).
810
811 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
812 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
813 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
814 numbers.
815
816 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
817 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
818 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
819 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
820 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
821
822 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
823 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
824 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
825
826 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
827 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
828
829 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
830 @subsection Standalone Operation
831
832 @noindent
833 @cindex Standalone Operation
834 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
835 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
836 can give the commands:
837
838 @example
839 emacs -f full-calc
840 @end example
841
842 @noindent
843 or
844
845 @example
846 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
847 @end example
848
849 @noindent
850 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
851 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
852 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
853 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
854 itself.
855
856 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
857 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
858
859 @noindent
860 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
861 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
862 document like this:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @group
866 The derivative of
867
868 ln(ln(x))
869
870 is
871 @end group
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
876 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
877 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
878 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
879 formula:
880
881 @smallexample
882 @group
883 The derivative of
884
885 ln(ln(x))
886
887 is
888
889 ln(ln(x))
890 @end group
891 @end smallexample
892
893 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
894 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
895 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
896 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
897 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
898 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
899 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
900 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
901 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
902 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
903 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
904
905 @smallexample
906 @group
907 The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911 is
912
913 1 / x ln(x)
914 @end group
915 @end smallexample
916
917 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
918 so that @samp{1 / x ln(x)} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (x ln(x))}.)
919
920 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
921 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
922
923 @smallexample
924 @group
925 The derivative of
926
927 ln(ln(x))
928
929 is
930 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
931 % [calc-mode: language: big]
932
933 1
934 -------
935 x ln(x)
936 @end group
937 @end smallexample
938
939 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
940 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
941 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
942 @LaTeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
943 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
944 out of the way.)
945
946 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
947 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
948
949 @smallexample
950 @group
951 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
952 % [calc-mode: language: big]
953 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
954
955 1
956 ------- (1)
957 ln(x) x
958 @end group
959 @end smallexample
960
961 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
962 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
963
964 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
965 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
966 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
967 Here's an example of its use (before you try this, remove the Calc
968 annotations or use a new buffer so that the extra settings in the
969 annotations don't take effect):
970
971 @smallexample
972 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
973 @end smallexample
974
975 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
976 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
977 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
978 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
979
980 @smallexample
981 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
982 @end smallexample
983
984 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
985 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
986
987 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
988 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
989
990 @noindent
991 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
992 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
993 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
994 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
995 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
996
997 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
998 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
999 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1000 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1001 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1002 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1003 formula.
1004
1005 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1006 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1007 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1008
1009 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1010 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1011 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1012 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1013 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1014 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1015 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1016 is something on the Calc stack.
1017
1018 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1019 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1020 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1021
1022 @noindent
1023 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1024
1025 @table @kbd
1026 @item *
1027 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1028
1029 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1030 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1031
1032 @item C
1033 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1034 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1035 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1036
1037 @item O
1038 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1039 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1040 move it out of that window.
1041
1042 @item B
1043 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1044
1045 @item Q
1046 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1047
1048 @item K
1049 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1050
1051 @item E
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1053
1054 @item J
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1056
1057 @item W
1058 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1059
1060 @item Z
1061 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1062
1063 @item X
1064 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1065 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1066 @end table
1067 @iftex
1068 @sp 2
1069 @end iftex
1070
1071 @noindent
1072 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1073
1074 @table @kbd
1075 @item G
1076 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1077
1078 @item R
1079 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1080
1081 @item :
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1083
1084 @item _
1085 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1086
1087 @item Y
1088 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1089 @end table
1090 @iftex
1091 @sp 2
1092 @end iftex
1093
1094 @noindent
1095 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1096
1097 @table @kbd
1098 @item A
1099 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1100 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1101 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1102
1103 @item D
1104 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1105 the duplicate.
1106
1107 @item F
1108 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1109
1110 @item N
1111 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item P
1114 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1115
1116 @item U
1117 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1118
1119 @item `
1120 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1121 @end table
1122 @iftex
1123 @sp 2
1124 @end iftex
1125
1126 @noindent
1127 Miscellaneous commands:
1128
1129 @table @kbd
1130 @item I
1131 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1132 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1133
1134 @item T
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1136
1137 @item S
1138 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1139
1140 @item L
1141 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1142 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1143
1144 @item M
1145 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1146 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1147
1148 @item 0
1149 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1150 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node History and Acknowledgments, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1154 @section History and Acknowledgments
1155
1156 @noindent
1157 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1158 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1159 the value of
1160 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1161 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1162 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1163 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1164 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1165 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1166 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1167 all.
1168
1169 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1170 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1171 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1172 got too far out of hand.
1173
1174 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1175 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1176 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1177
1178 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1179 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1180 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so (at the time)---not
1181 enough for a decent calculator. So I had to write my own
1182 high-precision integer code as well, and once I had this I figured
1183 that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large integers.
1184 Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step. Also,
1185 since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1186 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it
1187 practical to support fractions as well as floats. All these features
1188 inspired me to look around for other data types that might be worth
1189 having.
1190
1191 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1192 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1193 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1194 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1195 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1196 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1197 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1198 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1199 implement what they needed for themselves.
1200
1201 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1202 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1203 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1204
1205 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1206 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1207 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1208
1209 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1210 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1211 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1212 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1213 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1214 algebra system for microcomputers.
1215
1216 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1217 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1218 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1219 rules, and many other algebra features;
1220 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1221 @infoline Francois
1222 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1223 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1224 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1225 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1226 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1227 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1228 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1229 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1230 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1231 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1232 well as many other things.
1233
1234 @cindex Bibliography
1235 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1236 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1237 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1238 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1239 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1240 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1241 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1242 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1243 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1244 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1245 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1246 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1247 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1248 Dan LaLiberte.
1249
1250 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1251 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1252 finished in two weeks.
1253
1254 @c [tutorial]
1255
1256 @ifinfo
1257 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1258 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1259 @chapter Tutorial
1260
1261 @noindent
1262 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1263
1264 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1265 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1266 for this).
1267
1268 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1269 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1270 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1271 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1272
1273 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1274 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1275 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1276 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1277 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1278
1279 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1280
1281 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1282
1283 @menu
1284 * Tutorial::
1285 @end menu
1286
1287 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1288 @end ifinfo
1289 @ifnotinfo
1290 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1291 @end ifnotinfo
1292 @chapter Tutorial
1293
1294 @noindent
1295 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1296 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1297 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1298 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1299 @c [not-split]
1300 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1301 @c [when-split]
1302 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1303
1304 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1305 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1306 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1307 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1308 the Embedded mode interface.
1309
1310 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1311 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1312 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1313 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1314 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1315 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1316 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1317 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1318
1319 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1320 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1321 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1322 general areas.
1323
1324 @ifnottex
1325 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1326 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1327 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1328 @end ifnottex
1329 @iftex
1330 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1331 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1332 Calc.
1333 @end iftex
1334
1335 @menu
1336 * Basic Tutorial::
1337 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1338 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1339 * Types Tutorial::
1340 * Algebra Tutorial::
1341 * Programming Tutorial::
1342
1343 * Answers to Exercises::
1344 @end menu
1345
1346 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1347 @section Basic Tutorial
1348
1349 @noindent
1350 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1351 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1352 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1353
1354 @menu
1355 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1356 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1357 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1358 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1359 @end menu
1360
1361 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1362 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1363
1364 @cindex RPN notation
1365 @noindent
1366 @ifnottex
1367 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1368 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1369 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1370 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1371 @end ifnottex
1372 @tex
1373 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1374 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1375 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1376 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1377 @end tex
1378
1379 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1380 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1381 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1382 from the top of the stack.
1383
1384 @cindex Operators
1385 @cindex Operands
1386 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1387 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1388 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1389 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1390 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1391 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1392
1393 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1394 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1395 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1396 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1397 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1398 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1399 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1400 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1401 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 @group
1405 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1406 . 1: 3 .
1407 .
1408
1409 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1410 @end group
1411 @end smallexample
1412
1413 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1414 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1415 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1416 less distracting in regular use.
1417
1418 @cindex Stack levels
1419 @cindex Levels of stack
1420 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1421 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1422 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1423 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1424 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1425 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1426 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1427
1428 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1429 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1430 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1431 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1432 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1433 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1434 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1435 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1436 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1437 if you are interested.
1438
1439 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1440 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1441 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1442 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1443 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1444
1445 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1446 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1447
1448 @smallexample
1449 @group
1450 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1451 . 1: 3 .
1452 .
1453
1454 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1455 @end group
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1460 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1461 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1462
1463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1464 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1465 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1466 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1467 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1468 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1469 return to where you were.)
1470
1471 @noindent
1472 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1473 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1474 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1475 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1476
1477 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1478 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.5) + {5\over4}}
1479 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1480 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1481
1482 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1483 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1484 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1485 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1486 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1487 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1488 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1489 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1490 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1491
1492 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1493 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1494 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1495
1496 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1497 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1498 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1499 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1500 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1501
1502 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1503 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1504 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1505
1506 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1507 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1508 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @group
1512 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1513 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1514 . .
1515
1516 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1517 @end group
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 @noindent
1521 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1522 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1523
1524 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1525 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1526 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1527
1528 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1529 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1530 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1531 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1532 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1533
1534 @smallexample
1535 @group
1536 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1537 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1538 . .
1539
1540 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1541 @end group
1542 @end smallexample
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 @group
1549 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1550 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1551 . 1: 3 .
1552 .
1553
1554 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1555 @end group
1556 @end smallexample
1557
1558 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1559 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1560 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1561
1562 @smallexample
1563 @group
1564 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1565 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1566 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1567 . . .
1568
1569 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1570 @end group
1571 @end smallexample
1572
1573 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1574 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1575 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1576 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1577
1578 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1579 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1580 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1581 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1582
1583 @smallexample
1584 @group
1585 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1586 . . 1: 16 . .
1587 .
1588
1589 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1590 @end group
1591 @end smallexample
1592
1593 @noindent
1594 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1595 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1596
1597 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1598 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1599 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1600 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1601 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1602
1603 @smallexample
1604 @group
1605 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1606 . 1: 4 .
1607 .
1608
1609 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1610 @end group
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1614 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1615 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1616 prefix for you:
1617
1618 @smallexample
1619 @group
1620 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1621 . 1: 4 .
1622 .
1623
1624 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1625 @end group
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1633 . . .
1634
1635 4 @key{RET} n Q
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent
1640 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1641 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1642 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1643 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1644
1645 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1646 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1647 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1648 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1649 complex result.)
1650
1651 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1652 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1653
1654 @smallexample
1655 @group
1656 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1657 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1658 . .
1659
1660 ( 2 , 3 )
1661 @end group
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1665 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1666
1667 @smallexample
1668 @group
1669 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1670 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1671 . 1: 3 . .
1672 .
1673 (error)
1674 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1675 @end group
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent
1679 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1680 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1681
1682 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1683 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1684
1685 @smallexample
1686 @group
1687 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1688 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1689 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1690 . . .
1691
1692 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1693 @end group
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 @noindent
1697 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1698 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1699 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1700 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1701
1702 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1703 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1704 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1705 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1706 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1707
1708 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1709 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1710 the tutorial.
1711
1712 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1713 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1714 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1715 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1716 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1717 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1718 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1719
1720 @smallexample
1721 @group
1722 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1723 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1724 . 1: 30 1: 30
1725 . .
1726
1727 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1728 @end group
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1732 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1733 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1734 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1735 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 @group
1739 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1740 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1741 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1742 . . 1: 20
1743 .
1744
1745 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1746 @end group
1747 @end smallexample
1748
1749 @cindex Clearing the stack
1750 @cindex Emptying the stack
1751 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1752 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1753 entire stack.)
1754
1755 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1756 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1757
1758 @noindent
1759 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1760 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1761 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1762 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1763
1764 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1765 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1766 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1767
1768 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1769 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1770 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1771 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1772 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1773 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1774 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1775
1776 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1777 The result should be the number 9.
1778
1779 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1780 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1781 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1782 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1783 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1784
1785 @example
1786 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 is equivalent to
1791
1792 @example
1793 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1794 @end example
1795
1796 @noindent
1797 or, in large mathematical notation,
1798
1799 @ifnottex
1800 @example
1801 @group
1802 3 * 4 * 5
1803 2 + --------- - 9
1804 8
1805 6 * 7
1806 @end group
1807 @end example
1808 @end ifnottex
1809 @tex
1810 \beforedisplay
1811 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1812 \afterdisplay
1813 @end tex
1814
1815 @noindent
1816 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1817
1818 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1819 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1820 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1821 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1822
1823 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1824 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1825 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1826 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1827
1828 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1829 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1830 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1831 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1832 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1833
1834 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1835
1836 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1837 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1838 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1839 an algebraic entry.
1840
1841 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1842 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1843 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1844 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1845 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1846
1847 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1848 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1849
1850 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1851 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1852 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1853 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1854 rule to use!
1855
1856 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1857 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1858 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1859
1860 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1861
1862 @smallexample
1863 @group
1864 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1865 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1866 . .
1867
1868 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1869 @end group
1870 @end smallexample
1871
1872 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1873 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1874 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1875
1876 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1877 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1878 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1879 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1880 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1881 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1882 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1883
1884 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1885
1886 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1887 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1888 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1889 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1890 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1891 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1892 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1893 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1894 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1895 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1896 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1897 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1898 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 @group
1902 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1903 . . .
1904
1905 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1906 @end group
1907 @end smallexample
1908
1909 @noindent
1910 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1911 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1912
1913 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1914 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1915 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1916 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1917
1918 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1919 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1920
1921 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1922 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1923 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1924 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1925 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1926 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1927 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1928
1929 @smallexample
1930 @group
1931 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1932 . . .
1933
1934 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1935 @end group
1936 @end smallexample
1937
1938 @noindent
1939 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1940 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1941
1942 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1943 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1944 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 @group
1948 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1949 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1950 . 1: 2 .
1951 .
1952
1953 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1954 @end group
1955 @end smallexample
1956
1957 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1958 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1959 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1960 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1961 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1962 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1963
1964 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1965 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1966
1967 @smallexample
1968 @group
1969 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 2 b + 34
1970 . .
1971
1972 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1973 @end group
1974 @end smallexample
1975
1976 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1977 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1978
1979 @smallexample
1980 @group
1981 1: log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3) + 2
1982 .
1983
1984 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1985 @end group
1986 @end smallexample
1987
1988 @noindent
1989 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1990 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1991 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1992 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1993 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1994 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1995 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1996 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1997 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1998 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1999 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2000 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2001 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2002 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2003
2004 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2005 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2006 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2007 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2008 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2009
2010 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2011 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2012 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2013
2014 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2015 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2016 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2017 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2018 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2019 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2020 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2021 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 @group
2025 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2026 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2027 . .
2028
2029 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2030 @end group
2031 @end smallexample
2032
2033 @noindent
2034 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2035 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2036 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2037 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2038 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2039
2040 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2045 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2046 .
2047
2048 s u a @key{RET}
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2053 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2054
2055 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2056 @subsection Undo and Redo
2057
2058 @noindent
2059 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2060 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2061 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2062 with a clean slate. Now:
2063
2064 @smallexample
2065 @group
2066 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2067 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2068 . .
2069
2070 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2071 @end group
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2075 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2076 above example, you could type:
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 @group
2080 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2081 . 1: 3 .
2082 .
2083 (error)
2084 U U U U
2085 @end group
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2089 mistakenly.
2090
2091 @smallexample
2092 @group
2093 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2094 . 1: 3 . .
2095 .
2096 (error)
2097 D D D D
2098 @end group
2099 @end smallexample
2100
2101 @noindent
2102 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2103 by something other than an undo command.
2104
2105 @cindex Time travel
2106 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2107 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2108 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2109 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2110 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2111 was an earlier undo command.
2112
2113 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2114 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2115 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2116 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2117
2118 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2119 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2120 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2121 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2122 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2123 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2124 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2125 stack.
2126
2127 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2128 went into the trail.
2129
2130 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2131 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2132 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2133 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2134 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2135 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2136 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2137 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2138
2139 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2140 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2141 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2142 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2143 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2144
2145 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2146 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2147 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2148 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2149 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2150 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2151 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2152 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2153 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2154 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2155 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2156
2157 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2158
2159 @smallexample
2160 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2161 @end smallexample
2162
2163 @noindent
2164 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2165 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2166 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2167 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2168 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2169 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2170 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2171
2172 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2173 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2174 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2175 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2176 the prefix.
2177
2178 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2179 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2180 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2181 to edit a stack entry.
2182
2183 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2184 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2185 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2186 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2187 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2188 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2189 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2190 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2191
2192 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2193 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2194
2195 @noindent
2196 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2197 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2198 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2199 try some of the most common ones here.
2200
2201 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2202 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 @noindent
2209 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2210 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2211 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2212 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2213 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2214 leading and trailing zeros.
2215
2216 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2217 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2218 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 @group
2222 1: 0.142857142857
2223 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2224 .
2225 @end group
2226 @end smallexample
2227
2228 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2229 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2230 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2231 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2232
2233 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2234 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2235
2236 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2237 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2238 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2239 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2240 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2241 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2242 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 @group
2246 1: 0.142857142857
2247 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2248 3: 1.14285714286
2249 .
2250 @end group
2251 @end smallexample
2252
2253 @noindent
2254 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2255 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2256
2257 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2258 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2259 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2260 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2261 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2262 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2263 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2264 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2265 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2266 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2267 arithmetic.
2268
2269 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2270 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2271 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2272
2273 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 @group
2277 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2278 . 1: 10000 .
2279 .
2280
2281 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2282 @end group
2283 @end smallexample
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2287 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2288 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2289 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2290 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2291
2292 @smallexample
2293 @group
2294 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2295 . 1: 10000. .
2296 .
2297
2298 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2299 @end group
2300 @end smallexample
2301
2302 @cindex Round-off errors
2303 @noindent
2304 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2305 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2306 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2307 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2308 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2309 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2310 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2311 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2312 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2313 out:
2314
2315 @smallexample
2316 @group
2317 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2318 . 1: 10000. .
2319 .
2320
2321 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2322 @end group
2323 @end smallexample
2324
2325 @noindent
2326 @cindex Guard digits
2327 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2328 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2329 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2330 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2331 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2332 last place.
2333
2334 @cindex Guard digits
2335 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2336 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2337 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2338 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2339 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2340 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2341 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2342
2343 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2344 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2345 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2346 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2347 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2348 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2349 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2350 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2351 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2352 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2353 numbers shown here:
2354
2355 @smallexample
2356 @group
2357 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2358 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2359 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2360 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2361 . . . . .
2362
2363 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2364 @end group
2365 @end smallexample
2366
2367 @noindent
2368 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2369 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2370 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2371 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2372 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2373 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2374
2375 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2376 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2377 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2378 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2379
2380 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2381 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2382 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2383 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2384 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 @group
2388 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2389 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2390 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2391 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2392 . . . . .
2393
2394 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2395 @end group
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2400 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2401 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2402 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2403 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2404 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2405 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2406
2407 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2408 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2409 displayed exactly.
2410
2411 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2412 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2413 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2414
2415 @example
2416 2417851639229258349412352
2417 @end example
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2421
2422 @example
2423 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2428 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2429 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2430
2431 @example
2432 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2433 @end example
2434
2435 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2436 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2437 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2438
2439 @example
2440 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2441 @end example
2442
2443 @noindent
2444 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2445 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2446
2447 @example
2448 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2449 @end example
2450
2451 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2452 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2453
2454 @example
2455 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2456 @end example
2457
2458 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2459 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2460 restore the default precision.
2461
2462 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2463 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2464 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2465 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2466
2467 @example
2468 16#200000000000000000000
2469 @end example
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2473 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2474 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2475 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2476 form:
2477
2478 @example
2479 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @noindent
2483 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2484 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2485 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2486 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2487 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2488 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2489
2490 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2491 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2492 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2493 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2494 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2495
2496 @example
2497 2#101,1111,1110
2498 @end example
2499
2500 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2501 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2502 other radix.
2503
2504 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2505
2506 @example
2507 1,534
2508 @end example
2509
2510 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2511 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2512 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2513 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2514
2515 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2516 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2517 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2518 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2519 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2520 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2521 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2522 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2523 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2524
2525 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2526 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2527 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2528 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2529 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2530 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2531 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2532 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2533
2534 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2535 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2536 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2537 the way they are actually computed.
2538
2539 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2540 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2541 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2542 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2543
2544 @smallexample
2545 @group
2546 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2547 . . . .
2548
2549 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2550 @end group
2551 @end smallexample
2552
2553 @noindent
2554 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2555 of 45 degrees is
2556 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2557 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2558 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2559 roundoff error because the representation of
2560 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2561 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2562 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2563 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2564 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2565
2566 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2567 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2568 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2569 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2570 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2571
2572 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2573 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2574 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2575 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2576 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2577
2578 @smallexample
2579 @group
2580 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2581 . . .
2582
2583 P 4 / m r S
2584 @end group
2585 @end smallexample
2586
2587 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2588 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 @group
2592 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2593 . . .
2594
2595 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2596 @end group
2597 @end smallexample
2598
2599 @noindent
2600 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2601 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2602 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2603 first in radians, then in degrees.
2604
2605 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2606 and vice-versa.
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 @group
2610 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2611 . . .
2612
2613 45 c r c d
2614 @end group
2615 @end smallexample
2616
2617 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2618 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2619 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2620 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2621 number, instead.
2622
2623 @smallexample
2624 @group
2625 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2626 1: 9 . .
2627 .
2628
2629 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2630 @end group
2631 @end smallexample
2632
2633 @noindent
2634 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2635 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2636
2637 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2638 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2639 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2640 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2641 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2642 what to do when dividing two integers.
2643
2644 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2645 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2646 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2647 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2648 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2649
2650 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2651 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2652 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2653 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2654 recompute for you.
2655
2656 @smallexample
2657 @group
2658 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2659 . . .
2660
2661 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2662 @end group
2663 @end smallexample
2664
2665 @noindent
2666 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2667 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2668 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2669 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2670 might affect their values.
2671
2672 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2673 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2674
2675 @noindent
2676 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2677 available in the Calculator.
2678
2679 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2680 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2681 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2682 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2683
2684 @smallexample
2685 @group
2686 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2687 . . . . .
2688
2689 5 & & n n
2690 @end group
2691 @end smallexample
2692
2693 @cindex Binary operators
2694 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2695 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2696 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2697 a negative prefix.
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 @group
2701 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2702 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2703 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2704 . . 1: 10 .
2705 .
2706
2707 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2708 @end group
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 @cindex Unary operators
2712 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2713 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2714
2715 @smallexample
2716 @group
2717 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2718 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2719 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2720 . . .
2721
2722 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2723 @end group
2724 @end smallexample
2725
2726 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2727 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2728 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2729 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2730 integer.
2731
2732 @smallexample
2733 @group
2734 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2735 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2736 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2737 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2738 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2739 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2740 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2741 . . .
2742
2743 M-7 F U M-7 R
2744 @end group
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2748 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2749 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2750 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2751 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2752
2753 @smallexample
2754 @group
2755 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2756 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2757 . .
2758
2759 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2760 @end group
2761 @end smallexample
2762
2763 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2764
2765 @smallexample
2766 @group
2767 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2768 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2769 . .
2770
2771 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2772 @end group
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2776 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2777 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2778 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2779 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2780
2781 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2782 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2783 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2784 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2785 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2786
2787 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2788 identity
2789 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2790 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2791 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2792 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2793
2794 @smallexample
2795 @group
2796 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2797 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2798 . . . .
2799
2800 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2801 @end group
2802 @end smallexample
2803
2804 @noindent
2805 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2806 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2807
2808 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2809 of squares, command.
2810
2811 Another identity is
2812 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2813 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2814 @smallexample
2815 @group
2816
2817 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2818 1: 0.43837 . .
2819 .
2820
2821 U / I T
2822 @end group
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2826 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2827 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2828 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 @group
2832 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2833 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2834 . .
2835
2836 U U M-2 n / I T
2837 @end group
2838 @end smallexample
2839
2840 @noindent
2841 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2842 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2843 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2844 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2845 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2846 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2847 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2848
2849 @smallexample
2850 @group
2851 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2852 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2853 . 1: 0.43837 .
2854 .
2855
2856 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2857 @end group
2858 @end smallexample
2859
2860 @noindent
2861 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2862 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2863
2864 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2865 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2866 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2867 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2868 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2869 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2870 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2871 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2872
2873 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2874 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2875 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2876 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2877 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 @group
2881 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2882 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2883 . . . . .
2884
2885 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2886 @end group
2887 @end smallexample
2888
2889 @noindent
2890 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2891 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2892 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2893 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2894 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2895 error.
2896
2897 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2898 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2899 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2900 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2901
2902 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2903 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2904
2905 @cindex Common logarithm
2906 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2907 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2908 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2909 prefix.
2910
2911 @smallexample
2912 @group
2913 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2914 . . . .
2915
2916 1000 L U H L
2917 @end group
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 @noindent
2921 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2922 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2923
2924 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2925 value of @var{b}.
2926
2927 @smallexample
2928 @group
2929 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2930 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2931 . .
2932
2933 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2934 @end group
2935 @end smallexample
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2939 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2940 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2941 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2942 onto the stack.
2943
2944 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2945 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2946 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2947 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2948 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2949 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2950 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2951 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2952 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2953 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2954
2955 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2956 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2957 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2958
2959 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2960 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2961 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2962
2963 @smallexample
2964 @group
2965 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2966 . . . .
2967
2968 100 ! U c f !
2969 @end group
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2974 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2975 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2976 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2977 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2978 in this case).
2979
2980 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2981 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2982 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2983 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2984 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2985
2986 @smallexample
2987 @group
2988 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2989 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2990 1: 5. 1: 120.
2991 . .
2992
2993 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2994 @end group
2995 @end smallexample
2996
2997 @noindent
2998 Here we verify the identity
2999 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3000 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3001
3002 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3003 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3004 is defined by
3005 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3006 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3007 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3008 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3009 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3010 large intermediate values.
3011
3012 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3013 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3014 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3015
3016 @smallexample
3017 @group
3018 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3019 1: 20 . .
3020 .
3021
3022 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3023 @end group
3024 @end smallexample
3025
3026 @noindent
3027 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3028 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3029 number, 30045015.
3030
3031 @cindex Hash tables
3032 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3033 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3034 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 @group
3038 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3039 . . .
3040
3041 10000 k n I k n
3042 @end group
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 @noindent
3046 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3047 10000.
3048
3049 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3050 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3051 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3052 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3053
3054 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3055 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3056 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3057
3058 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3059 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3063 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3064 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3065 a vector as a list of objects.
3066
3067 @menu
3068 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3069 * Matrix Tutorial::
3070 * List Tutorial::
3071 @end menu
3072
3073 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3074 @subsection Vector Analysis
3075
3076 @noindent
3077 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3078 elements, taken pairwise.
3079
3080 @smallexample
3081 @group
3082 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3083 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3084 .
3085
3086 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3087 @end group
3088 @end smallexample
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3092 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3093 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3094 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3095
3096 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3097 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3098 of the vectors.
3099
3100 @smallexample
3101 @group
3102 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3103 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3104 .
3105
3106 r 1 r 2 *
3107 @end group
3108 @end smallexample
3109
3110 @cindex Dot product
3111 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3112 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3113 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3114 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3115 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3116 vector.
3117
3118 @smallexample
3119 @group
3120 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3121 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3122 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3123 . .
3124
3125 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3126 @end group
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @noindent
3130 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3131 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3132 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3133 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3134 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3135 is about 56 degrees.
3136
3137 @cindex Cross product
3138 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3139 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3140 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3141 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3142 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3143 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3144 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3145
3146 @smallexample
3147 @group
3148 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3149 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3150 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3151 .
3152
3153 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3154 @end group
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @noindent
3158 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3159 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3160 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3161 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3162
3163 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3164 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3165 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3166 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3167 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3168 prefix keys have this property.)
3169
3170 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3171 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3172 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3173
3174 @smallexample
3175 @group
3176 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3177 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3178 . .
3179
3180 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3181 @end group
3182 @end smallexample
3183
3184 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3185 @cindex Unit vectors
3186 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3187 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3188 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3189 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3190
3191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3192 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3193 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3194 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3195 Find the average position of the particle.
3196 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3197
3198 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3199 @subsection Matrices
3200
3201 @noindent
3202 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3203 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3204 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3205 both methods here:
3206
3207 @smallexample
3208 @group
3209 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3210 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3211 . .
3212
3213 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3214 @end group
3215 @end smallexample
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3219
3220 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3221 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3222 the second example.
3223
3224 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3225 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3226 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3227 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3228 of the right matrix.
3229
3230 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3231 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3232
3233 @smallexample
3234 @group
3235 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3236 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3237 .
3238
3239 @key{RET} *
3240 @end group
3241 @end smallexample
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3245 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3246 been left in symbolic form.
3247
3248 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 @group
3252 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3253 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3254 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3255 [ 2, 5 ] .
3256 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3257 .
3258
3259 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3260 @end group
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3264 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3265 matrix, as happened here!
3266
3267 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3268 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3269 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3270 as a row or column as appropriate.
3271
3272 @smallexample
3273 @group
3274 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3275 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3276 1: [1, 2, 3]
3277 .
3278
3279 r 4 r 1 *
3280 @end group
3281 @end smallexample
3282
3283 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3284 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3285 vector.
3286
3287 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3288 of the above
3289 @texline @math{2\times3}
3290 @infoline 2x3
3291 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3292 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3293 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3294
3295 @cindex Identity matrix
3296 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3297 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3298 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3299 the original matrix.
3300
3301 @smallexample
3302 @group
3303 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3304 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3305 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3306 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3307 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3308 .
3309
3310 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3311 @end group
3312 @end smallexample
3313
3314 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3315 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3316 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3317 inverse of a matrix.
3318
3319 @smallexample
3320 @group
3321 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3322 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3323 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3324 . .
3325
3326 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3327 @end group
3328 @end smallexample
3329
3330 @noindent
3331 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3332 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3333 our matrix to make it square.
3334
3335 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3336
3337 @smallexample
3338 @group
3339 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3340 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3341 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3342 . .
3343
3344 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3345 @end group
3346 @end smallexample
3347
3348 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3349 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3350 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3351 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3352
3353 @ifnottex
3354 @group
3355 @example
3356 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3357 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3358 7a + 6b = 3
3359 @end example
3360 @end group
3361 @end ifnottex
3362 @tex
3363 \beforedisplayh
3364 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3365 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3368 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3369 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3370 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3371 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3372 $$
3373 \afterdisplayh
3374 @end tex
3375
3376 @noindent
3377 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3378
3379 @ifnottex
3380 @group
3381 @example
3382 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3383 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3384 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3385 @end example
3386 @end group
3387 @end ifnottex
3388 @tex
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \beforedisplay
3461 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3462 x &+ b y = 10}
3463 $$
3464 \afterdisplay
3465 @end tex
3466
3467 @noindent
3468 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3469
3470 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3471 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3472 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3473 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3474 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3475 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3476 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3477 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3478 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3479 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3480 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3481 @ifnottex
3482 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3483 @end ifnottex
3484 @tex
3485 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3486 @end tex
3487 Now
3488 @texline @math{A^T A}
3489 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3490 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3491 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3492 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3493 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3494 system:
3495
3496 @ifnottex
3497 @group
3498 @example
3499 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3500 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3501 7a + 6b = 3
3502 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3503 @end example
3504 @end group
3505 @end ifnottex
3506 @tex
3507 \beforedisplayh
3508 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3509 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3510 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3511 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3512 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3513 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3514 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3515 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3516 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3517 $$
3518 \afterdisplayh
3519 @end tex
3520
3521 @noindent
3522 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3523
3524 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3525 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3526
3527 @noindent
3528 @cindex Lists
3529 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3530 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3531 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3532 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3533 number.
3534
3535 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3536
3537 @smallexample
3538 @group
3539 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3540 2: 20 . 2: 20
3541 1: 30 1: 30
3542 . .
3543
3544 M-3 v p v u
3545 @end group
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3549 of many copies of a given value:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 @group
3553 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3554 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3555 . .
3556
3557 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3558 @end group
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3562 @dfn{map} command.
3563
3564 @smallexample
3565 @group
3566 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3567 . . .
3568
3569 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3570 @end group
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 @noindent
3574 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3575 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3576 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3577 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3578 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3579 of each element.
3580
3581 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3582 from
3583 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3584 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3585 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3586
3587 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3588 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3589 elements in the vector:
3590
3591 @smallexample
3592 @group
3593 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3594 . . .
3595
3596 123123 k f V R *
3597 @end group
3598 @end smallexample
3599
3600 @noindent
3601 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3602 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3603
3604 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3605 reduction:
3606
3607 @smallexample
3608 @group
3609 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3610 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3611 .
3612
3613 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3614 @end group
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @noindent
3618 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3619 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3620 for the dot product as before.
3621
3622 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3623 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3624 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3625
3626 @smallexample
3627 @group
3628 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3629 . .
3630
3631 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3632 @end group
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3636 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3637 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3638 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3639 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3640 vector size).
3641
3642 @smallexample
3643 @group
3644 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3645 . .
3646
3647 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3648 @end group
3649 @end smallexample
3650
3651 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3652 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3653 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3654
3655 @smallexample
3656 @group
3657 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3658 . .
3659
3660 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3661 @end group
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 @noindent
3665 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3666 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3667 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3668 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3669 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3670 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3671 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3672
3673 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3674 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3675 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3676
3677 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3678 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3679 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3680 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3681 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3682 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3683 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3684 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3685 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3686 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3687
3688 @smallexample
3689 x y
3690 --- ---
3691 1.34 0.234
3692 1.41 0.298
3693 1.49 0.402
3694 1.56 0.412
3695 1.64 0.466
3696 1.73 0.473
3697 1.82 0.601
3698 1.91 0.519
3699 2.01 0.603
3700 2.11 0.637
3701 2.22 0.645
3702 2.33 0.705
3703 2.45 0.917
3704 2.58 1.009
3705 2.71 0.971
3706 2.85 1.062
3707 3.00 1.148
3708 3.15 1.157
3709 3.32 1.354
3710 @end smallexample
3711
3712 @noindent
3713 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3714 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3715 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3716 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3717
3718 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3719 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3720 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3721 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3722 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3723 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3724 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3725 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3726
3727 @smallexample
3728 @group
3729 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3730 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3731 @dots{}
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @noindent
3736 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3737 large matrix.)
3738
3739 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3740 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3741 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3742 of row vectors on the stack.
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 @group
3746 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3747 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3748 . .
3749
3750 v t v u
3751 @end group
3752 @end smallexample
3753
3754 @noindent
3755 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3756
3757 @smallexample
3758 @group
3759 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3760 .
3761
3762 t 2 t 1
3763 @end group
3764 @end smallexample
3765
3766 @noindent
3767 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3768 stored value from the stack.)
3769
3770 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3771
3772 @ifnottex
3773 @example
3774 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3775 @end example
3776 @end ifnottex
3777 @tex
3778 \beforedisplay
3779 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3780 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3781 \afterdisplay
3782 @end tex
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 where
3786 @texline @math{\sum x}
3787 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3788 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3789 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3790 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3791 this formula uses.
3792
3793 @smallexample
3794 @group
3795 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3796 . .
3797
3798 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3799
3800 @end group
3801 @end smallexample
3802 @noindent
3803 @smallexample
3804 @group
3805 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3806 . .
3807
3808 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3809 @end group
3810 @end smallexample
3811
3812 @ifnottex
3813 @noindent
3814 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3815 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3816 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3817 @end ifnottex
3818 @tex
3819 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3820 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3821 $\sum x y$.)
3822 @end tex
3823
3824 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3825 the length of either of our lists.
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 @group
3829 1: 19
3830 .
3831
3832 r 1 v l t 7
3833 @end group
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 @noindent
3837 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3838
3839 Now we grind through the formula:
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 @group
3843 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3844 . 1: 566.70919 .
3845 .
3846
3847 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3848
3849 @end group
3850 @end smallexample
3851 @noindent
3852 @smallexample
3853 @group
3854 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3855 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3856 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3857 .
3858
3859 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3860 @end group
3861 @end smallexample
3862
3863 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3864 be found with the simple formula,
3865
3866 @ifnottex
3867 @example
3868 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3869 @end example
3870 @end ifnottex
3871 @tex
3872 \beforedisplay
3873 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3874 \afterdisplay
3875 \vskip10pt
3876 @end tex
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 @group
3880 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3881 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3882 .
3883
3884 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3885 @end group
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3889 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3890 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3891 and compare it with the original data.
3892
3893 @smallexample
3894 @group
3895 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3896 . .
3897
3898 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3899 @end group
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3904 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3905 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3906 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3907
3908 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3909 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3910
3911 @smallexample
3912 @group
3913 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3914 . . .
3915
3916 r 2 - V M A V R X
3917 @end group
3918 @end smallexample
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3922 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3923 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3924 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3925 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3926 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3927 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3928 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3929 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3930
3931 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3932 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3933 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3934 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3935 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3936
3937 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3938 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3939 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3940 plotting of data.
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 @group
3944 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3945 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3946 .
3947
3948 r 1 r 2 g f
3949 @end group
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3953 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3954 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3955 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3956 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3957 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3958
3959 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3960 @ifinfo
3961 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3962 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3963 replaced by a buffer named @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3964 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3965 @end ifinfo
3966
3967 @smallexample
3968 @group
3969 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3970 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3971 .
3972
3973 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3974 @end group
3975 @end smallexample
3976
3977 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3978 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3979 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3980
3981 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3982 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3983 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3984 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3985 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3986 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3987
3988 @cindex Geometric mean
3989 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3990 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3991 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3992 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3993 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3994 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3995
3996 @example
3997 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3998 15 14 7.5
3999 2.5
4000 @end example
4001
4002 @noindent
4003 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4004 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4005 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4006
4007 @ifnottex
4008 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4009 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4010 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4011 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4012 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4013 for @expr{n=6}.
4014 @end ifnottex
4015 @tex
4016 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4017 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4018 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4019 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4020 for \cite{n=6}.
4021 @end tex
4022
4023 @smallexample
4024 @group
4025 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4026 . .
4027
4028 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4029
4030 @end group
4031 @end smallexample
4032 @noindent
4033 @smallexample
4034 @group
4035 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4036 . .
4037
4038 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4039 @end group
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4043 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4044 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4045 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4046 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4047
4048 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4049 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4050 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4051 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4052 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4053 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4054
4055 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4056 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4057 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4058 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4059 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4060 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4061 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4062 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4063 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4064 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4065 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4066 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4067 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4068 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4069 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4070
4071 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4072 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4073 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4074 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4075
4076 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4077 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4078 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4079 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4080 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4081 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4082
4083 @cindex Divisor functions
4084 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4085 @tex
4086 $\sigma_k(n)$
4087 @end tex
4088 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4089 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4090 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4091 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4092 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4093
4094 @cindex Square-free numbers
4095 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4096 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4097 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4098 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4099 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4100 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4101 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4102 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4103
4104 @cindex Triangular lists
4105 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4106 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4107 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 @group
4111 1: [ [1],
4112 [1, 2],
4113 [1, 2, 3],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4115 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4116 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4117 @end group
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 @noindent
4121 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4122
4123 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 @group
4127 1: [ [0],
4128 [1, 2],
4129 [3, 4, 5],
4130 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4131 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4132 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4133 @end group
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4138
4139 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4140 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4141 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4142 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4143 @infoline @expr{J1}
4144 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4145 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4146 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4147 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4148 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4149 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4150 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4151
4152 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4153 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4154 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4155 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4156 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4157 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4158 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4159 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4160 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4161 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4162 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4163
4164 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4165 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4166 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4167
4168 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4169 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4170 @texline @math{2\times2}
4171 @infoline 2x2
4172 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4173 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4174 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4175 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4176 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4177 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4178 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4179 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4180 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4181 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4182
4183 @cindex Matchstick problem
4184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4185 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4186 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4187 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4188 a line turns out to be
4189 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4190 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4191 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4192 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4193 one turns out to be
4194 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4195 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4196 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4197 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4198
4199 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4200 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4201 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4202 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4203 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4204 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4205 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4206 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4207 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4208 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4209 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4210 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4211 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4212 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4213 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4214 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4215 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4216 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4217
4218 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4219 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4220 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4221 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4222 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4223 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4224 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4225 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4226 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4227 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4228 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4229 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4230
4231 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4232 @section Types Tutorial
4233
4234 @noindent
4235 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4236 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4237
4238 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4239 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4240 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4241 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4242 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 @group
4246 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4247 . 1: 49 . . .
4248 .
4249
4250 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4251 @end group
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 @noindent
4255 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4256 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4257 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4258 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4259 fraction beginning with 49.
4260
4261 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4262 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 @group
4266 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4267 . .
4268
4269 c f c F
4270 @end group
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4274 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4275 same, to within the current precision.
4276
4277 @smallexample
4278 @group
4279 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4280 . . . .
4281
4282 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4283 @end group
4284 @end smallexample
4285
4286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4287 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4288 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4289 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4290
4291 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4292
4293 @smallexample
4294 @group
4295 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4296 . . . . .
4297
4298 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4299 @end group
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 @noindent
4303 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4304 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4305 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4306 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4307
4308 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4309 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4310 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4311 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4312 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4313 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4314 algebraic entry.
4315
4316 @smallexample
4317 @group
4318 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4319 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4320 . . . .
4321
4322 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4328 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4329 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4330 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4331 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4332 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4333 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4334 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4335 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4336 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4337 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4338 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4339 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4340
4341 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4342 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4343 to turn on Infinite mode.
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 @group
4347 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4348 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4349 1: 0 . . .
4350 .
4351
4352 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4353 @end group
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 @noindent
4357 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4358 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4359 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4360 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4361 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4362 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4363 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4364 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4365 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4366 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4367 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4368 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4369 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4370 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4371 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4372 that matter, with anything else.
4373
4374 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4375 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4376 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4377 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4378 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4381 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4382 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4383 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4384
4385 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4386 seconds.
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 @group
4390 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4391 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4392 .
4393
4394 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4395 @end group
4396 @end smallexample
4397
4398 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4399 seconds.
4400
4401 @smallexample
4402 @group
4403 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4404 . . . .
4405
4406 0.5 I T c h S
4407 @end group
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4412 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4413 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4414
4415 @cindex Beatles
4416 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4417 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4418 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4419 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4420 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4421
4422 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4423 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4424 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4425
4426 @smallexample
4427 @group
4428 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4429 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4430 .
4431
4432 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4433 @end group
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 @noindent
4437 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4438 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4439 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4440 date form.
4441
4442 @smallexample
4443 @group
4444 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4445 . .
4446
4447 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4448 @end group
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4452 @noindent
4453 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4454 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4455 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4456 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4457 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4458 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4459
4460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4461 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4462
4463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4464 between now and the year 10001 AD@? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4465
4466 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4467 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4468 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4469 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4470 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4471 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4472 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4473 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4474
4475 @smallexample
4476 @group
4477 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4478 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4479 .
4480
4481 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4482 @end group
4483 @end smallexample
4484
4485 @noindent
4486 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4487 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4488 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4489
4490 @cindex Torus, volume of
4491 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4492 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4493 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4494 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4495 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4496 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4497 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4498 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4499
4500 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4501 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4502 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4503 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4504 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4509 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4510 .
4511
4512 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4513 @end group
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 @noindent
4517 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4518 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4519
4520 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4521 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4522 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4523 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4524 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4525 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4526 the other.
4527
4528 @smallexample
4529 @group
4530 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4531 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4532 .
4533
4534 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4535 @end group
4536 @end smallexample
4537
4538 @noindent
4539 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4540 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4541 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4542 or both endpoints.
4543
4544 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4545 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4546 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4547 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4548 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4551 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4552 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4553 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4557 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4558 or 24 hours.
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 @group
4562 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4563 . . . .
4564
4565 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4566 @end group
4567 @end smallexample
4568
4569 @noindent
4570 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4571 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4572 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4573 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4574 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 @group
4578 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4579 . . . .
4580
4581 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4582 @end group
4583 @end smallexample
4584
4585 @noindent
4586 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4587 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4588 that arises in the second one.
4589
4590 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4591 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4592 says that
4593 @texline @math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}
4594 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4595 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4596 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4597 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4598 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4599 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4600 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4601
4602 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4603 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4604 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4605 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4606
4607 @smallexample
4608 @group
4609 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4610 . .
4611
4612 x time @key{RET} n
4613 @end group
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4618
4619 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4620 is about
4621 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4622 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4623 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4624 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4625
4626 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4627 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4628 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4629 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4630 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4631 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4632
4633 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4634 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4635 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4636 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4637 like centimeters and inches.
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 @group
4641 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4642 . . . .
4643
4644 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4645 @end group
4646 @end smallexample
4647
4648 @noindent
4649 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4650 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4651 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4652 which in this case means meters.
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 @group
4656 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4657 . . . .
4658
4659 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4660
4661 @end group
4662 @end smallexample
4663 @noindent
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4667 . . .
4668
4669 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4670 @end group
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 @noindent
4674 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4675 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4676 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4677 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4678 being interpreted as unit names.
4679
4680 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4681 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4682 as its standard unit of length.
4683
4684 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4685
4686 @smallexample
4687 @group
4688 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4689 . . . .
4690
4691 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4692 @end group
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4697 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4698 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4699
4700 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4701 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4702 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4703 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4704 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4705 for them.
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 @group
4709 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4710 . . . .
4711
4712 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET}
4713 @end group
4714 @end smallexample
4715
4716 @noindent
4717 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4718 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4719 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius.
4720
4721 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4722 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4723 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4724 numbers are in which units:
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 @group
4728 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4729 . . .
4730
4731 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4732 @end group
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4736 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4737 at the units table.
4738
4739 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4740 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4741
4742 @cindex Speed of light
4743 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4744 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4745 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4746 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4747 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4748
4749 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4750 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4751 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4752 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4753 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4754
4755 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4756 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4757
4758 @noindent
4759 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4760 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4761 formulas.
4762
4763 @menu
4764 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4765 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4769 @subsection Basic Algebra
4770
4771 @noindent
4772 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4773 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4774 formulas as regular data objects.
4775
4776 @smallexample
4777 @group
4778 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (3 x^2 + y) (6 - 2 x^2)
4779 . . .
4780
4781 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4782 @end group
4783 @end smallexample
4784
4785 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4786 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4787 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4788
4789 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4790 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 @group
4794 1: 18 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y - 2 y x^2 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4795 . .
4796
4797 a x a c x @key{RET}
4798 @end group
4799 @end smallexample
4800
4801 @noindent
4802 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4803 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4804
4805 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4806 is one-half.
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 @group
4810 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4811 . .
4812
4813 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4814 @end group
4815 @end smallexample
4816
4817 @noindent
4818 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4819 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4820 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4821 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4822 back to its original value, if any.
4823
4824 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4825 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4826 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4827 properly.)
4828
4829 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4830 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4831 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4832 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4833 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4834 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4835 the function has a local maximum there.
4836
4837 @smallexample
4838 @group
4839 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4840 . .
4841
4842 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4843 @end group
4844 @end smallexample
4845
4846 @noindent
4847 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4848 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4849
4850 @smallexample
4851 @group
4852 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4853 . .
4854
4855 ' x @key{RET} / a x
4856
4857 @end group
4858 @end smallexample
4859 @noindent
4860 @smallexample
4861 @group
4862 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023
4863 . .
4864
4865 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4866 @end group
4867 @end smallexample
4868
4869 @noindent
4870 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 @group
4874 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4875 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4876 . .
4877
4878 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4879 @end group
4880 @end smallexample
4881
4882 @noindent
4883 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4884 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4885 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4886 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4887
4888 @smallexample
4889 @group
4890 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4891 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4892 . .
4893
4894 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4895 @end group
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4900 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4901 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4902
4903 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4904 @expr{0.70588 x^2 = 1} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4905 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4906 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4907 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4908 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4909 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 @group
4913 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4914 . . .
4915
4916 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4917 @end group
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 @noindent
4921 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4922 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4923 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4924 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4925 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4926
4927 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4928 into the original formula.
4929
4930 @smallexample
4931 @group
4932 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4933 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4934 .
4935
4936 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4937 @end group
4938 @end smallexample
4939
4940 @noindent
4941 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4942 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4943 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4944
4945 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4946 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 @group
4950 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4951 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4952 .
4953
4954 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4955 @end group
4956 @end smallexample
4957
4958 @noindent
4959 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4960 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4961 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4962 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4963 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4964 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4965 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4966 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4967 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4968 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4969
4970 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4971 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4972
4973 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4974 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4975 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4976 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4977 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4978 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4979 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4980 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4981
4982 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4983 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4984 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4985 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4986 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4987 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4988
4989 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4990 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4991 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4992 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4993
4994 @smallexample
4995 @group
4996 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4997 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4998 . .
4999
5000 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5001 @end group
5002 @end smallexample
5003
5004 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 3
5009 2: 34 x - 24 x
5010
5011 ____ ____
5012 V 51 V 51
5013 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5014 6 -6
5015
5016 .
5017
5018 d B
5019 @end group
5020 @end smallexample
5021
5022 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5023 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5024 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5025 and @LaTeX{} mode.
5026
5027 @smallexample
5028 @group
5029 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5030 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5031 . .
5032
5033 d C d F
5034
5035 @end group
5036 @end smallexample
5037 @noindent
5038 @smallexample
5039 @group
5040 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5041 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5042 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5043 .
5044
5045 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5046 @end group
5047 @end smallexample
5048
5049 @noindent
5050 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5051 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5052 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5053 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5054
5055 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5056 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5057 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5058 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5059 correct.
5060
5061 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5062 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5063 are shown in normal mode.)
5064
5065 @cindex Area under a curve
5066 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5067 This is simply the integral of the function:
5068
5069 @smallexample
5070 @group
5071 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5072 . .
5073
5074 r 1 a i x
5075 @end group
5076 @end smallexample
5077
5078 @noindent
5079 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5080 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5081
5082 @smallexample
5083 @group
5084 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5085 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5086
5087 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5088 @end group
5089 @end smallexample
5090
5091 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5092 of
5093 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5094 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5095 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5096 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5097 3}. (@bullet{})
5098
5099 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5100 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5101 under the curve
5102 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5103 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5104 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5105 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5106 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5107 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5108
5109 @cindex Integration, numerical
5110 @cindex Numerical integration
5111 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5112 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5113 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5114 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5115
5116 @smallexample
5117 @group
5118 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5119 2: 1 .
5120 1: 0.1
5121 .
5122
5123 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5124 @end group
5125 @end smallexample
5126
5127 @noindent
5128 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5129 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5134 1: ln(x) sin(x) .
5135 .
5136
5137 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5138
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141 @noindent
5142 @smallexample
5143 @group
5144 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5145 . .
5146
5147 V R + 0.1 *
5148 @end group
5149 @end smallexample
5150
5151 @noindent
5152 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5153 to Radians mode?)
5154
5155 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5156 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5157 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5158 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5159 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5160 is the same for every box.)
5161
5162 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5163 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5164
5165 @smallexample
5166 @group
5167 1: ln(x) sin(x) 1: 0.84147 x + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5168 . .
5169
5170 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5171 @end group
5172 @end smallexample
5173
5174 @noindent
5175 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5176 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5177 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5178
5179 @smallexample
5180 @group
5181 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5182 . . .
5183
5184 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5185 @end group
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @noindent
5189 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5190 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5191 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5192 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5193 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5194 of @expr{x=1}.)
5195
5196 @cindex Simpson's rule
5197 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5198 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5199 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5200 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5201 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5202 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5203 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5204 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5205 down to the formula,
5206
5207 @ifnottex
5208 @example
5209 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5210 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5211 @end example
5212 @end ifnottex
5213 @tex
5214 \beforedisplay
5215 $$ \displaylines{
5216 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5217 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5218 } $$
5219 \afterdisplay
5220 @end tex
5221
5222 @noindent
5223 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5224 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5225 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5226 method:
5227
5228 @ifnottex
5229 @example
5230 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5231 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5232 @end example
5233 @end ifnottex
5234 @tex
5235 \beforedisplay
5236 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5237 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5238 \afterdisplay
5239 @end tex
5240
5241 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5242 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5243 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5244 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5245 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5246
5247 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5248 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5249 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5250 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5251
5252 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5253 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5254 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5255 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5256 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5257 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5258 details and examples.
5259
5260 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5261 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5262
5263 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5264 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5268 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5269 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5270 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5271
5272 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 @group
5276 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2
5277 .
5278
5279 ' 2sec(x)^2/tan(x)^2 - 2/tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
5280 @end group
5281 @end smallexample
5282
5283 @noindent
5284 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably combine over the common
5285 denominator. The @kbd{a n} algebra command will do this, but we'll do
5286 it with a rewrite rule just for practice.
5287
5288 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 @group
5292 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2
5293 .
5294
5295 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5296 @end group
5297 @end smallexample
5298
5299 @noindent
5300 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5301 by itself the formula @samp{a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x} doesn't do anything,
5302 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5303 it as a rewrite rule.)
5304
5305 The lefthand side, @samp{a/x + b/x}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5306 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5307 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5308 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5309 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5310 the expression @samp{2 sec(x)^2}, the meta-variable @samp{b} matched
5311 the constant @samp{-2} and the meta-variable @samp{x} matched
5312 the expression @samp{tan(x)^2}.
5313
5314 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5315 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5316 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5317 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5318 denominators.
5319
5320 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5321 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5322 the subformula @samp{tan(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5323 @samp{x}.
5324
5325 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5326 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5327 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5328 @samp{a = 2 sec(x)^2}, @samp{b = -2}, and @samp{x = tan(x)^2}.
5329
5330 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5331 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5332 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5333 @samp{(2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2}.
5334
5335 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5336 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5337 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5338 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5339 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5340 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5341
5342 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5343 @samp{tan(x)^2 + 1 = sec(x)^2}, but of course we must first rearrange
5344 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5345 would be @samp{@w{2 sec(x)^2 - 2} := 2 tan(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5346 that the rule @samp{sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2} will also work. The
5347 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5348 situations, too.
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 @group
5352 1: 2
5353 .
5354
5355 a r sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET}
5356 @end group
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5360 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5361 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5362 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5363 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5364 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5365 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5366 having to retype it.
5367
5368 @smallexample
5369 @group
5370 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5371 ' sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s t secsqr @key{RET}
5372
5373 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5374 . .
5375
5376 r 1 a r merge @key{RET} a r secsqr @key{RET}
5377 @end group
5378 @end smallexample
5379
5380 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5381 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5382 the edited value back into the variable.
5383 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5384
5385 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5386 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5387 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5388 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5389 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5390 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5391 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5392 entering them on the fly.
5393
5394 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5395 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5396 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5397 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5398 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5399 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5400
5401 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5402 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5403
5404 @smallexample
5405 @group
5406 1: [merge, secsqr] 1: [a/x + b/x := (a + b)/x, ... ]
5407 . .
5408
5409 ' [merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5410
5411 @end group
5412 @end smallexample
5413 @noindent
5414 @smallexample
5415 @group
5416 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5417 . .
5418
5419 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET}
5420 @end group
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5424 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5425 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5426 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5427 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5428 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5429
5430 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5431 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5432 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5433 only one rewrite at a time.
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 @group
5437 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5438 . .
5439
5440 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5441 @end group
5442 @end smallexample
5443
5444 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5445 of rewrites that occur.
5446
5447 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5448 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 @group
5452 1: sin(x + 2 pi) + sin(x + 3 pi) + sin(x + 4 pi)
5453 .
5454
5455 ' sin(x+2pi) + sin(x+3pi) + sin(x+4pi) @key{RET}
5456
5457 @end group
5458 @end smallexample
5459 @noindent
5460 @smallexample
5461 @group
5462 1: sin(x + 3 pi) + 2 sin(x)
5463 .
5464
5465 a r sin(a + k pi) := sin(a) :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5466 @end group
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 @noindent
5470 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5471 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5472
5473 An interesting point is that the variable @samp{pi} was matched
5474 literally rather than acting as a meta-variable.
5475 This is because it is a special-constant variable. The special
5476 constants @samp{e}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5477 A common error with rewrite
5478 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5479 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5480 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5481
5482 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5483 @ignore
5484 @starindex
5485 @end ignore
5486 @tindex fib
5487 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5488 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5489 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5490 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5491 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 @group
5495 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5496
5497 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5498 . .
5499
5500 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5501 @end group
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5505 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5506 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5507 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5508 be used preferentially.
5509
5510 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5511 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5512 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5513 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5514 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5515 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5516 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5520 @end smallexample
5521
5522 @noindent
5523 Now:
5524
5525 @smallexample
5526 @group
5527 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: fib(x) + fib(0) + 8
5528 . .
5529
5530 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5531 @end group
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @noindent
5535 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5536 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5537 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5538 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5539 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5540
5541 @smallexample
5542 @group
5543 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5544 . .
5545
5546 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5547 @end group
5548 @end smallexample
5549
5550 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5551 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5552 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5553
5554 @smallexample
5555 @group
5556 fib(6) =
5557 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5558 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5559 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5560 @end group
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @noindent
5564 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5565 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5566 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5567 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5568 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5569 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5570
5571 @smallexample
5572 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575 @noindent
5576 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5577 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5578 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5579 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5580 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5581 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5582
5583 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5584 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5585
5586 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5587 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5588 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5589 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5590 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5591
5592 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5593 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5594 un-store the variable.
5595
5596 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5597 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5598 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5599 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5600 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5601 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5602 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5603 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5604 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5605
5606 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5607 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5608 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5609 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5610
5611 @example
5612 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5613 @end example
5614
5615 @noindent
5616 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5617 to 1.''
5618
5619 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5620 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5621 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5622 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5623 and one for @samp{b}.
5624
5625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5626 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5627 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5628 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5629
5630 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5631 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5632 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5633 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5634 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5635 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5636 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5637 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5638 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5639 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5640 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5641 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5642 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5643 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5644
5645 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5646 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5647 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5648 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5649 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5650 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5653 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5654 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5655
5656 @ifnottex
5657 @example
5658 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5659 @end example
5660 @end ifnottex
5661 @tex
5662 \beforedisplay
5663 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5664 \afterdisplay
5665 @end tex
5666
5667 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5668 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5669 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5670 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5671 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5672
5673 @ifnottex
5674 @example
5675 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5676 @end example
5677 @end ifnottex
5678 @tex
5679 \beforedisplay
5680 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5681 \afterdisplay
5682 @end tex
5683
5684 @noindent
5685 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5686 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5687
5688 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5689 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5690 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5691 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5692 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5693 rearranged. (This one is rather tricky; the solution at the end of
5694 this chapter uses 6 rewrite rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)}
5695 condition tests whether @samp{x} is a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer
5696 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5697
5698 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5699 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5700 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5701
5702 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5703
5704 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5705 @section Programming Tutorial
5706
5707 @noindent
5708 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5709 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5710 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5711 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5712 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5713 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5714
5715 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5716 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5717 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5718 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5719 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1
5724 . .
5725
5726 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5727 @end group
5728 @end smallexample
5729
5730 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5731 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5732 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5733 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5734 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5735 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5736 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5737 arguments?''
5738
5739 @smallexample
5740 @group
5741 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5742 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5743 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5744 .
5745
5746 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5747 @end group
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @noindent
5751 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5752 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5753 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5754 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5755 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5756 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5757 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5758
5759 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5760 @ignore
5761 @starindex
5762 @end ignore
5763 @tindex Si
5764 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5765 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5766 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5767 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5768 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5769 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5770 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5771 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5772 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5773 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5774 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5775 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5776 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5777 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5778 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5779 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5780
5781 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5782 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5783 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5784 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5785 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5786
5787 @smallexample
5788 @group
5789 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5790 . .
5791
5792 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5793
5794 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 n1 pi
5795 . .
5796
5797 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5798 @end group
5799 @end smallexample
5800
5801 @noindent
5802 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5803 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5804 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5805 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5806 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5807
5808 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5809
5810 @smallexample
5811 @group
5812 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5813 . .
5814
5815 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5816 @end group
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 @noindent
5820 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5821 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5822
5823 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 @group
5827 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5828 . . . .
5829
5830 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5831 @end group
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5835 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5836 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5837
5838 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5839 the following functions:
5840
5841 @enumerate
5842 @item
5843 Compute
5844 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5845 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5846 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5847
5848 @item
5849 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5850 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5851
5852 @item
5853 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5854 the stack.
5855 @end enumerate
5856 @noindent
5857 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5858
5859 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5860 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5861 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5862
5863 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5864 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5865 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5866
5867 @smallexample
5868 @group
5869 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5870 . 1: 4 .
5871 .
5872
5873 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5874 @end group
5875 @end smallexample
5876
5877 @noindent
5878 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5879 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5880 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5881 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5882
5883 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5884 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5885
5886 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5887 Here's another example:
5888
5889 @smallexample
5890 @group
5891 3: 1 2: 10946
5892 2: 1 1: 17711
5893 1: 20 .
5894 .
5895
5896 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5897 @end group
5898 @end smallexample
5899
5900 @noindent
5901 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5902 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5903 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5904 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5905
5906 @cindex Golden ratio
5907 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5908 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5909 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5910 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5911 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5912 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5913 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5914 @infoline @expr{phi},
5915 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5916 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5917 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5918 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5919 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 @group
5923 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5924 . . . .
5925
5926 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5927 @end group
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 @cindex Continued fractions
5931 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5932 representation of
5933 @texline @math{\phi}
5934 @infoline @expr{phi}
5935 is
5936 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5937 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5938 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5939 and then replacing the innermost
5940 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5941 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5942 by 1. Approximate
5943 @texline @math{\phi}
5944 @infoline @expr{phi}
5945 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5946 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5947
5948 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5949 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5950 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5951 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5952 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5953 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5954 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5955
5956 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5957 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5958 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5959 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5960
5961 @smallexample
5962 @group
5963 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5964 2: 1 .
5965 1: 20
5966 .
5967
5968 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5969 @end group
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @noindent
5973 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5974 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5975 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5976 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5977 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5978 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5979 uses a step of one.
5980
5981 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5982 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5983 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 @group
5987 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5988 . 1: 20 .
5989 .
5990
5991 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
5992 @end group
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @noindent
5996 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
5997 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
5998
5999 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6000 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6001 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6002 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6003 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6004 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6005 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6006
6007 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6008 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6009 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6010
6011 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6012 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6013 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6014 fix, though:
6015
6016 @smallexample
6017 @group
6018 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6019 . . 2: 3.597739
6020 1: 0.6667
6021 .
6022
6023 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6024 @end group
6025 @end smallexample
6026
6027 @noindent
6028 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6029 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6030 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6031 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6032 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6033 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6034 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6035 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6036 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6037
6038 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6039 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6040 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6041 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6042 by the formula
6043 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6044 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6045 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6046 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6047 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6048 numbers are very large fractions.)
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 @group
6052 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6053 . .
6054
6055 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6056 @end group
6057 @end smallexample
6058
6059 @noindent
6060 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6061 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6062 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6063 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6064 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6065 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6066 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6067
6068 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 @group
6072 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6073 2: 5:66 . . . .
6074 1: 0.0757575
6075 .
6076
6077 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6078 @end group
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6082 Bernoulli numbers.
6083
6084 @smallexample
6085 @group
6086 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6087 2: 2 .
6088 1: 30
6089 .
6090
6091 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6092 @end group
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 @noindent
6096 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6097 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6098 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6099 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6100 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6101 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6102 sequence of keystrokes.)
6103
6104 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6105 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6106 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6107 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6108 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6109
6110 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6111 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6112 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6113 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6118 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6119
6120 1 ;; calc digits
6121 RET ;; calc-enter
6122 2 ;; calc digits
6123 + ;; calc-plus
6124
6125 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6126 @end group
6127 @end smallexample
6128
6129 @noindent
6130 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6131 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6132 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6133 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6134 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6135 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6136 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6137 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6138 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6139 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6140
6141 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6142 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6143 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6144 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6145 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6146
6147 @smallexample
6148 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6149 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6150 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6151 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6152 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6153 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6154 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6155 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6156 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6157 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6158 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6159 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6160 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6161 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6162 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @noindent
6166 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6167
6168 @smallexample
6169 @group
6170 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6171 . .
6172
6173 20 z h
6174 @end group
6175 @end smallexample
6176
6177 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6178 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6179 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6180 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6181 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6182 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6183 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6184
6185 @example
6186 @group
6187 Z ` 0 t 1
6188 1 TAB
6189 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6190 r 1
6191 Z '
6192 @end group
6193 @end example
6194
6195 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6196 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6197 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6198 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6199 this formula over and over:
6200
6201 @ifnottex
6202 @example
6203 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6204 @end example
6205 @end ifnottex
6206 @tex
6207 \beforedisplay
6208 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
6209 \afterdisplay
6210 @end tex
6211
6212 @noindent
6213 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6214 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6215 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6216 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6217 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6218 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6219 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6220 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6221 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6222 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6223 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6224 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6225 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6226 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6227
6228 @cindex Digamma function
6229 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6230 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6231 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6232 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6233 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6234 is defined as the derivative of
6235 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6236 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6237 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6238
6239 @ifnottex
6240 @example
6241 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6242 @end example
6243 @end ifnottex
6244 @tex
6245 \beforedisplay
6246 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6247 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6248 $$
6249 \afterdisplay
6250 @end tex
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 where
6254 @texline @math{\sum}
6255 @infoline @expr{sum}
6256 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6257 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6258 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6259 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6260 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6261 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6262 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6263 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6264 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6265 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6266 Fortunately, we can compute
6267 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6268 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6269 from
6270 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6271 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6272 using the recurrence
6273 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6274 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6275 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6276 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6277 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6278 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6279 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6280 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6281 to compute
6282 @texline @math{\gamma}
6283 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6284 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6285 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6286 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6287
6288 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6289 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6290 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6291 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6292 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6293 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6294 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6295 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6296 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6297
6298 @cindex Recursion
6299 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6300 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6301
6302 @ifnottex
6303 @example
6304 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6305 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6306 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6307 @end example
6308 @end ifnottex
6309 @tex
6310 \beforedisplay
6311 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6312 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6313 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6314 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6315 $$
6316 \afterdisplay
6317 \vskip5pt
6318 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6319 @end tex
6320
6321 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6322 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6323 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6324 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6325 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6326 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6327 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6328 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6329 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6330 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6331 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6332 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6333 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6334 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6335 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6336 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6337 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6338 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6339
6340 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6341 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6342 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6343 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6344 program can:
6345
6346 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6347 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6348 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6349 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6350
6351 @example
6352
6353 @end example
6354 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6355 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6356 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6357 @c [not-split]
6358 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6359 @c [when-split]
6360 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6361
6362 @page
6363 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6364 @section Answers to Exercises
6365
6366 @noindent
6367 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6368
6369 @menu
6370 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6371 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6372 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6373 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6374 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6375 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6376 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6377 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6378 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6379 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6380 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6381 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6382 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6383 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6384 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6385 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6386 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6387 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6388 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6389 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6390 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6391 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6392 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6393 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6394 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6395 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6396 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6397 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6398 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6399 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6400 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6401 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6402 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6403 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6404 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6405 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6406 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6407 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6408 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6409 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6410 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6411 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6412 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6413 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6414 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6415 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6416 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6417 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6418 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6419 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6420 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6421 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6422 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6423 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6424 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6425 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6426 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6427 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6428 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6429 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6430 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6431 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6432 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6433 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6434 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6435 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6436 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6437 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6438 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6439 @end menu
6440
6441 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6442 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6443 @tex
6444 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6445 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6446 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6447 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6448 @end tex
6449
6450 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6451 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6455
6456 The result is
6457 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6458 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6459
6460 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6461 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6462
6463 @noindent
6464 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6465 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6466
6467 After computing the intermediate term
6468 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6469 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6470 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6471 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6472 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6473
6474 @smallexample
6475 @group
6476 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6477 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6478 . 1: 9.5 .
6479 .
6480
6481 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6482
6483 @end group
6484 @end smallexample
6485 @noindent
6486 @smallexample
6487 @group
6488 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6489 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6490 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6491 1: 4 .
6492 .
6493
6494 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6495 @end group
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6499 with the third term.
6500
6501 @smallexample
6502 @group
6503 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6504 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6505 . 1: 4 .
6506 .
6507
6508 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6509 @end group
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6513 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6514 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6515 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6516
6517 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6518 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6519
6520 @noindent
6521 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6522
6523 @smallexample
6524 @group
6525 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6526 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6527 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6528 . . 1: 1 . .
6529 .
6530
6531 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6532 @end group
6533 @end smallexample
6534
6535 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6536
6537 @smallexample
6538 @group
6539 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6540 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6541 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6542 . . . . .
6543
6544 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6545 @end group
6546 @end smallexample
6547
6548 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6549 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6550
6551 @noindent
6552 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6553 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 @group
6557 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6558 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6559 . . .
6560
6561 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6566 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6567 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6568 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6569 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 @group
6573 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6574 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6575 . . .
6576
6577 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6578 @end group
6579 @end smallexample
6580
6581 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6582 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6583 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6584 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6585
6586 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6587 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6588
6589 @noindent
6590 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6591
6592 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6593 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6594
6595 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6596 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6597 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6598
6599 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6600 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6601
6602 @noindent
6603 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6604 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6605 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6606 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6607
6608 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6609 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6610
6611 @noindent
6612 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6613 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6614 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6615 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6616 times anything is zero.''
6617
6618 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6619 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6620 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6621 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6622 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6623 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6624
6625 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6626 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6627
6628 @noindent
6629 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6630 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6631 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6632 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6633 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6634 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6635
6636 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6637 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6638 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6639 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6640 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6641 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6642 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6643 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6644 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6645 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6646 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6647
6648 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6649 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6650 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6651 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6652 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6653 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6654 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6655 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6656 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6657 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6658
6659 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6660 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6661 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6662 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6663 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6664 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6665 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6666 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6667 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6668 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6669
6670 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6671 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6672 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6673 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6674 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6675 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6676 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6677 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6678 in decimal display mode.
6679
6680 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6681 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6682 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6683 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6684
6685 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6686 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6687
6688 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6689 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6690 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6691 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6692 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6693 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6694 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6695 way to enter this number.
6696
6697 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6698 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6699 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6700 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6701 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6702 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6703 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6704
6705 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6706 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6707
6708 @noindent
6709 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6710
6711 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6712 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6713 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6714 their inputs.
6715
6716 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6717 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6718 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6719 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6720 determining facts like this.
6721
6722 @smallexample
6723 @group
6724 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6725 . .
6726
6727 45 S 2 ^
6728
6729 @end group
6730 @end smallexample
6731 @noindent
6732 @smallexample
6733 @group
6734 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6735 . . .
6736
6737 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6738 @end group
6739 @end smallexample
6740
6741 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6742 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6743 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6744 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6745 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6746
6747 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6748 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6749
6750 @noindent
6751 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6752 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6753 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6754 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6755 of time.
6756
6757 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6758 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6759 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6760 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6761 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6762 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6763
6764 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6765 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6766 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6767
6768 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6769 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6770
6771 @noindent
6772 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6773 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6774 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6775 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6776 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6777 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6778 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6779 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6780
6781 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6782 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6783 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6784 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6785 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6786 format.
6787
6788 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6789 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6793 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6794
6795 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6796 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6797 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6798 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6799
6800 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6801 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6802
6803 @noindent
6804 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6805 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 @group
6809 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6810 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6811 .
6812
6813 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6814 @end group
6815 @end smallexample
6816
6817 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6818 indeed have unit length.
6819
6820 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6821 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6822
6823 @noindent
6824 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6825 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6826 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6827 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6828
6829 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6830 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6834 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6835
6836 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6837 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6838
6839 @ifnottex
6840 @example
6841 @group
6842 x + a y = 6
6843 x + b y = 10
6844 @end group
6845 @end example
6846 @end ifnottex
6847 @tex
6848 \beforedisplay
6849 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6850 x &+ b y = 10}
6851 $$
6852 \afterdisplay
6853 @end tex
6854
6855 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6856 matrix as usual.
6857
6858 @smallexample
6859 @group
6860 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [4 a / (a - b) + 6, 4 / (b - a) ]
6861 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6862 [ 1, b ] ]
6863 .
6864
6865 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6866 @end group
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6870 mode:
6871
6872 @smallexample
6873 @group
6874 4 a 4
6875 1: [----- + 6, -----]
6876 a - b b - a
6877 @end group
6878 @end smallexample
6879
6880 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6881
6882 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6883 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6884
6885 @noindent
6886 To solve
6887 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6888 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6889 first we compute
6890 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6891 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6892 and
6893 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6894 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6895 now, we have a system
6896 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6897 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6898 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6899
6900 @ifnottex
6901 @example
6902 @group
6903 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6904 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6905 7a + 6b = 3
6906 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6907 @end group
6908 @end example
6909 @end ifnottex
6910 @tex
6911 \beforedisplayh
6912 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6913 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6914 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6915 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6916 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6917 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6918 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6919 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6920 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6921 $$
6922 \afterdisplayh
6923 @end tex
6924
6925 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6926 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6927 @texline @math{B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{B2}
6929 vector.
6930
6931 @smallexample
6932 @group
6933 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6934 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6935 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6936 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6937 . .
6938
6939 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6940 @end group
6941 @end smallexample
6942
6943 @noindent
6944 Now we compute the matrix
6945 @texline @math{A'}
6946 @infoline @expr{A2}
6947 and divide.
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 @group
6951 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6952 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6953 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6954 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6955 .
6956
6957 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6958 @end group
6959 @end smallexample
6960
6961 @noindent
6962 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6963 round-off error.)
6964
6965 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6966 @texline @math{3\times3}
6967 @infoline 3x3
6968 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6969 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6970 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6971 answer since the
6972 @texline @math{4\times3}
6973 @infoline 4x3
6974 system would be equivalent to the original
6975 @texline @math{3\times3}
6976 @infoline 3x3
6977 system.)
6978
6979 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6980 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6981 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6982
6983 @smallexample
6984 @group
6985 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6986 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
6987 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
6988 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
6989 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
6990 .
6991
6992 r 7 @key{TAB} *
6993 @end group
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 @noindent
6997 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
6998 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
6999
7000 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7001 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7005 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7006 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7007 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7008
7009 @smallexample
7010 @group
7011 2: 2 2: 2
7012 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7013 . .
7014
7015 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7016 @end group
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 @noindent
7020 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7021 vector.
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 @group
7025 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7026 .
7027
7028 V M ^
7029 @end group
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7037 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7038
7039 @ifnottex
7040 @example
7041 m*x + b*1 = y
7042 @end example
7043 @end ifnottex
7044 @tex
7045 \beforedisplay
7046 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7047 \afterdisplay
7048 @end tex
7049
7050 Thus we want a
7051 @texline @math{19\times2}
7052 @infoline 19x2
7053 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7054 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7055 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 @group
7059 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7060 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7061 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7062 @dots{}
7063
7064 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7065 @end group
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 @noindent
7069 Now we compute
7070 @texline @math{A^T y}
7071 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7072 and
7073 @texline @math{A^T A}
7074 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7075 and divide.
7076
7077 @smallexample
7078 @group
7079 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7080 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7081 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7082 .
7083
7084 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7085 @end group
7086 @end smallexample
7087
7088 @noindent
7089 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7094 .
7095
7096 /
7097 @end group
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 Since we were solving equations of the form
7101 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7102 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7103 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7104 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7105 @kbd{V R}!
7106
7107 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7108 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7109 arithmetic functions!
7110
7111 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7112 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7113 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7114
7115 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7116 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7117
7118 @noindent
7119 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7120 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7121 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7122
7123 @smallexample
7124 @group
7125 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7126 .
7127 @end group
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7131 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7132
7133 @smallexample
7134 @group
7135 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7136 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7137 . .
7138
7139 @key{RET} V R *
7140
7141 @end group
7142 @end smallexample
7143 @noindent
7144 @smallexample
7145 @group
7146 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7147 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7148 . .
7149
7150 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7151 @end group
7152 @end smallexample
7153
7154 @noindent
7155 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7156 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7157 then raise the number to that power.)
7158
7159 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7160 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7164 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7165 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7166 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7167
7168 @smallexample
7169 @group
7170 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7171 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7172 . .
7173
7174 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7175 @end group
7176 @end smallexample
7177
7178 @noindent
7179 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7180
7181 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7182 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 @group
7186 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7187 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7188 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7189 .
7190
7191 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7192 @end group
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7197 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7198
7199 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7200 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7204 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7205 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7206 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7207
7208 @smallexample
7209 @group
7210 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7211 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7212 . .
7213
7214 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7215
7216 @end group
7217 @end smallexample
7218 @noindent
7219 @smallexample
7220 @group
7221 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7222 . . .
7223
7224 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7230 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7231 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7232 the job is pretty straightforward.
7233
7234 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7235 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7236 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7237 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7238 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7239
7240 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7241 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7245 to get a list of lists of integers!
7246
7247 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7248 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7249
7250 @noindent
7251 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7252 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7253
7254 @smallexample
7255 @group
7256 1: [ [0],
7257 [0, 1],
7258 [0, 1, 2],
7259 @dots{}
7260
7261 1 -
7262 @end group
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7266 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7267 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7268 can be computed directly by the formula
7269 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7270 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 @group
7274 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7275 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7276 . .
7277
7278 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7279 @end group
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7284 result:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 1: [ [0],
7289 [1, 2],
7290 [3, 4, 5],
7291 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7292 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7293 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7294 .
7295
7296 V M +
7297 @end group
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7301 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7302 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7303 triangular list.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 @key{RET} V M V R +
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7317 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7318 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7319
7320 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7321 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7322
7323 @noindent
7324 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7325
7326 @smallexample
7327 @group
7328 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7329 . . .
7330
7331 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7332 @end group
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7336
7337 @smallexample
7338 @group
7339 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7340 .
7341
7342 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7343 @end group
7344 @end smallexample
7345
7346 @noindent
7347 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7348
7349 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7350 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7351
7352 @smallexample
7353 @group
7354 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7355 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7356 . .
7357
7358 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7359 @end group
7360 @end smallexample
7361
7362 @noindent
7363 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7364 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7365 @texline @math{\sin x}
7366 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7367 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7368
7369 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7370 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7371 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7372
7373 @smallexample
7374 @group
7375 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7376 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7377 .
7378
7379 r 1 V M * V R +
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7384 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7385 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7386 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7387 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7388 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7389
7390 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7391 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7392 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7393
7394 @smallexample
7395 @group
7396 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7397 1: [0 .. 5] .
7398 .
7399
7400 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7401 @end group
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 @noindent
7405 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7406 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7407 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7408
7409 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7410 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7411
7412 @noindent
7413 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7414
7415 @smallexample
7416 @group
7417 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7418 . 2: 10
7419 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7420 .
7421
7422 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7423
7424 @end group
7425 @end smallexample
7426 @noindent
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7430 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7431 .
7432
7433 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7443 .
7444
7445 10 V M % s 2
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7450 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7451 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7452 the right of it are nines.
7453
7454 @smallexample
7455 @group
7456 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7457 . .
7458
7459 9 V M a = v v
7460
7461 @end group
7462 @end smallexample
7463 @noindent
7464 @smallexample
7465 @group
7466 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7467 . .
7468
7469 V U * v v 1 |
7470 @end group
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 @noindent
7474 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7475 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7476 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7477 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7478 rightmost digit.
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 @group
7482 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7483 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7484 .
7485
7486 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7487 @end group
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 @noindent
7491 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7492 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7493 digits that generated them.
7494
7495 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7496
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7500 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7501 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7502 .
7503
7504 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7505
7506 @end group
7507 @end smallexample
7508 @noindent
7509 @smallexample
7510 @group
7511 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7512 . .
7513
7514 V M * V R +
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7520 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 @group
7524 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7525 . .
7526
7527 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7528 @end group
7529 @end smallexample
7530
7531 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7532 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7536 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7537 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7538 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7539
7540 Here's a more correct method:
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7545 . 1: 7
7546 .
7547
7548 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7549
7550 @end group
7551 @end smallexample
7552 @noindent
7553 @smallexample
7554 @group
7555 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7556 . .
7557
7558 V M a = V R *
7559 @end group
7560 @end smallexample
7561
7562 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7563 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7564
7565 @noindent
7566 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7567 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7568 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7569
7570 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7571 commands.
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 @group
7575 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7576 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7577 . .
7578
7579 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7580
7581 @end group
7582 @end smallexample
7583 @noindent
7584 @smallexample
7585 @group
7586 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7587 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7588 . .
7589
7590 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7591 @end group
7592 @end smallexample
7593
7594 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7595 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7596
7597 @smallexample
7598 @group
7599 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7600 . . .
7601
7602 + 1 V M a < V R +
7603 @end group
7604 @end smallexample
7605
7606 @noindent
7607 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7608
7609 @smallexample
7610 @group
7611 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7612 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7613
7614 100 / 4 * P /
7615 @end group
7616 @end smallexample
7617
7618 @noindent
7619 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7620 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7621 not very efficient!
7622
7623 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7624 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7625
7626 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7627 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7628
7629 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7630 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7631
7632 @noindent
7633 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7634 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7635 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7636 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7637 @texline @math{\theta},
7638 @infoline @expr{theta},
7639 and see if @expr{x} and
7640 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7641 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7642 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7643 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7644 numbers surround an integer.
7645
7646 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7647 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7648 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7649 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7650 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7651
7652 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7653 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7654 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7655 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7656 Pick random @expr{x} and
7657 @texline @math{\theta},
7658 @infoline @expr{theta},
7659 compute
7660 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7661 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7662 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7663
7664 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7665 commands.
7666
7667 @smallexample
7668 @group
7669 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7670 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7671 .
7672
7673 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7674 @end group
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 @noindent
7678 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7679
7680 @smallexample
7681 @group
7682 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7683 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7684 .
7685
7686 m d V M C +
7687
7688 @end group
7689 @end smallexample
7690 @noindent
7691 @smallexample
7692 @group
7693 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7694 . . .
7695
7696 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7697 @end group
7698 @end smallexample
7699
7700 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7701 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7702 a random integer.
7703
7704 @smallexample
7705 @group
7706 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7707 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7708 . .
7709
7710 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7711
7712 @end group
7713 @end smallexample
7714 @noindent
7715 @smallexample
7716 @group
7717 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7718 . . .
7719
7720 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7721
7722 @end group
7723 @end smallexample
7724 @noindent
7725 @smallexample
7726 @group
7727 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7728 . .
7729
7730 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7731 @end group
7732 @end smallexample
7733
7734 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7735 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7736
7737 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7738 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7739
7740 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7741 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7745
7746 @smallexample
7747 @group
7748 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7749 .
7750
7751 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7752 @end group
7753 @end smallexample
7754
7755 @noindent
7756 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7757 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7758 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7759 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7760
7761 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7762 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7763 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7764 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7765
7766 @smallexample
7767 @group
7768 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7769 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7770 . .
7771
7772 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7773
7774 @end group
7775 @end smallexample
7776 @noindent
7777 @smallexample
7778 @group
7779 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7780 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7781 .
7782
7783 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7784 @end group
7785 @end smallexample
7786
7787 @noindent
7788 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7789 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7790 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7791 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7792 plus its second argument.
7793
7794 @smallexample
7795 @group
7796 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7797 . .
7798
7799 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7800 @end group
7801 @end smallexample
7802
7803 @noindent
7804 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7805 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7806 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7807
7808 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7809 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7810 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7811 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7812 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7813 the operations are faster.
7814
7815 @smallexample
7816 @group
7817 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7818 . .
7819
7820 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7821 @end group
7822 @end smallexample
7823
7824 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7825 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7826 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7827 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7828
7829 @ifnottex
7830 @example
7831 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7832 @end example
7833 @end ifnottex
7834 @tex
7835 \beforedisplay
7836 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7837 \afterdisplay
7838 @end tex
7839
7840 @noindent
7841 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7842 the distributive law yields
7843
7844 @ifnottex
7845 @example
7846 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7847 @end example
7848 @end ifnottex
7849 @tex
7850 \beforedisplay
7851 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7852 \afterdisplay
7853 @end tex
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7857 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7858 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7859 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7860
7861 @ifnottex
7862 @example
7863 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7864 @end example
7865 @end ifnottex
7866 @tex
7867 \beforedisplay
7868 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
7869 \afterdisplay
7870 @end tex
7871
7872 @noindent
7873 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7874 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7875
7876 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7877 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7878 modulo some value @var{m}.
7879
7880 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7881 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7882
7883 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7884 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7885 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 @group
7889 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7890 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7891 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7892 ...
7893
7894 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7895 @end group
7896 @end smallexample
7897
7898 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7899 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7900 before nesting even begins.
7901
7902 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7903 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7904 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7905
7906 @smallexample
7907 @group
7908 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7909 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7910 .
7911
7912 v t v u g f
7913 @end group
7914 @end smallexample
7915
7916 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7917 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7918 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7919
7920 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7921 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7922 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7923 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 @group
7927 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7928 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7929 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7930 ...
7931
7932 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7933 @end group
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7937
7938 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7939 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7940 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7941 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7942 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7943 Schwartz.)
7944
7945 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7946 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7947
7948 @noindent
7949 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7950 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7951
7952 @smallexample
7953 @group
7954 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7955 . . .
7956
7957 2 ^ P / c F
7958 @end group
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7963 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7964 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7965 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7966
7967 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7968 precision slightly and try again:
7969
7970 @smallexample
7971 @group
7972 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7973 . .
7974
7975 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7976 @end group
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 @noindent
7980 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7981 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7982 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
7983 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
7984
7985 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
7986 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
7987 to the current precision before they begin.
7988
7989 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7990 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
7994 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
7995
7996 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
7997 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
7998 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
7999 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8000 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8001 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8002
8003 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8004 the input is infinite.
8005
8006 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8007 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8008 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8009 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8010 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8011
8012 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8013 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8014 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8015 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8016
8017 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8018 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8019
8020 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8021 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8022 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8023 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8030 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8031 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8032 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8033 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8034 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8035
8036 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8037 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8038 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8039 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8040
8041 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8042 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8043 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8044 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8045 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8046
8047 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8048 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 @group
8052 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8053 1: 17 .
8054 .
8055
8056 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8057 @end group
8058 @end smallexample
8059
8060 @noindent
8061 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8062
8063 @smallexample
8064 @group
8065 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8066 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8067 .
8068
8069 20" + 17 *
8070 @end group
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 @noindent
8074 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8075
8076 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8077 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8078
8079 @noindent
8080 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8081 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8082 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 @group
8086 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8087 . . .
8088
8089 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8090 @end group
8091 @end smallexample
8092
8093 @noindent
8094 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8095
8096 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8097 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8098 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8099 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8100 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8101
8102 @smallexample
8103 @group
8104 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8105 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8106 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8107 .
8108
8109 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8110 @end group
8111 @end smallexample
8112
8113 @noindent
8114 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 @group
8118 1: 242
8119 .
8120
8121 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8122 @end group
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @noindent
8126 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8127
8128 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8129 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8130
8131 @noindent
8132 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8133 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8134 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8135 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8136 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8137 don't know the leap year rule.
8138
8139 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8140 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8141 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8142 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8143 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 @group
8147 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8148 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8149 .
8150
8151 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8152
8153 @end group
8154 @end smallexample
8155 @noindent
8156 @smallexample
8157 @group
8158 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8159 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8160 1: 1991 . .
8161 .
8162
8163 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8164 @end group
8165 @end smallexample
8166
8167 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8168 @noindent
8169 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8170 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8171 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8172 background information in that regard.)
8173
8174 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8175 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8176
8177 @noindent
8178 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8179 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: 1. 2: 1.
8184 . 1: 0.2
8185 .
8186
8187 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8188 @end group
8189 @end smallexample
8190
8191 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 @group
8195 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8196 . . .
8197
8198 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8199 @end group
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8203 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8204
8205 @smallexample
8206 @group
8207 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8208 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8209 1: 706.21 .
8210 .
8211
8212 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8213 @end group
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8218
8219 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8220 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8221
8222 @noindent
8223 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8224 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8225 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8226 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8227 but with no upper bound.
8228
8229 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8230
8231 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8232 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8233 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8234 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8235
8236 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8237 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8238 as a possible value.
8239
8240 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8241 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8242 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8243 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8244 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8245 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8246 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8247 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8248 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8249 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8250
8251 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8252 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 @group
8256 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8257 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8258 . .
8259
8260 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8261 @end group
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8266 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8267 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8268
8269 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8270 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8271 for different numbers.
8272
8273 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8274
8275 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8276 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8280
8281 @smallexample
8282 @group
8283 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8284 . 811749612 .
8285 .
8286
8287 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8288 @end group
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 @noindent
8292 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8293 must not be prime.
8294
8295 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8296 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8297 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8298 use this method to test the second number.
8299
8300 @smallexample
8301 @group
8302 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8303 1: 15485863 .
8304 .
8305
8306 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8307 @end group
8308 @end smallexample
8309
8310 @noindent
8311 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8312 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8313
8314 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8315 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8316 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8317
8318 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8319 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8320 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8321 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8322
8323 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8324 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8325
8326 @noindent
8327 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8328 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8329 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8330
8331 @smallexample
8332 @group
8333 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8334 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8335 .
8336
8337 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8338
8339 @end group
8340 @end smallexample
8341 @noindent
8342 @smallexample
8343 @group
8344 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8345 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8346 .
8347
8348 x time @key{RET} +
8349 @end group
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 It will be just after six in the morning.
8354
8355 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8356 HMS form:
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 @group
8360 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8361 . .
8362
8363 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8364 @end group
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 @noindent
8368 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8369 the actual number 3.14159...
8370
8371 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8372 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8373
8374 @noindent
8375 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8376 each.
8377
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8381 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8382 .
8383
8384 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8385
8386 @end group
8387 @end smallexample
8388 @noindent
8389 @smallexample
8390 @group
8391 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8392 .
8393
8394 17 *
8395 @end group
8396 @end smallexample
8397
8398 @noindent
8399 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8400
8401 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8402 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8412 to the other?
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8417 . .
8418
8419 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8420 @end group
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @noindent
8424 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 @group
8428 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356
8429 2: 4.1 ns .
8430 .
8431
8432 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} /
8433 @end group
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @noindent
8437 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8438 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8439 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8440
8441 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8442 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8443
8444 @noindent
8445 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8446 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 @group
8450 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8451 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8452 .
8453
8454 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8455 @end group
8456 @end smallexample
8457
8458 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8459 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8460 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8465 . 1: 2 .
8466 .
8467
8468 u s 2 B
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8474
8475 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8476 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8477
8478 @noindent
8479 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8480 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8481 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8482 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8483 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8484 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8485 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8486
8487 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8488 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8489
8490 @noindent
8491 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8492 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8493 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8494 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8495 familiar form.
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 @group
8499 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8500 . .
8501
8502 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8503
8504 @end group
8505 @end smallexample
8506 @noindent
8507 @smallexample
8508 @group
8509 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: x*(x + 1.19023) (x - 1.19023)
8510 . .
8511
8512 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8513
8514 @end group
8515 @end smallexample
8516 @noindent
8517 @smallexample
8518 @group
8519 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8520 . .
8521
8522 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8523 @end group
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8528 same as the original polynomial.
8529
8530 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8531 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: x sin(pi x) 1: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8536 . .
8537
8538 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [y, 1]
8546 2: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8547 .
8548
8549 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8550
8551 @end group
8552 @end smallexample
8553 @noindent
8554 @smallexample
8555 @group
8556 1: [sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi, 1 / pi]
8557 .
8558
8559 V M $ @key{RET}
8560
8561 @end group
8562 @end smallexample
8563 @noindent
8564 @smallexample
8565 @group
8566 1: sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi - 1 / pi
8567 .
8568
8569 V R -
8570
8571 @end group
8572 @end smallexample
8573 @noindent
8574 @smallexample
8575 @group
8576 1: sin(3.14159 y) / 9.8696 - y cos(3.14159 y) / 3.14159 - 0.3183
8577 .
8578
8579 =
8580
8581 @end group
8582 @end smallexample
8583 @noindent
8584 @smallexample
8585 @group
8586 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8587 .
8588
8589 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8590 @end group
8591 @end smallexample
8592
8593 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8594 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8595
8596 @noindent
8597 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8598 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8599 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8600 coefficients. Here's one way:
8601
8602 @smallexample
8603 @group
8604 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8605 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8606 . .
8607
8608 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8609
8610 @end group
8611 @end smallexample
8612 @noindent
8613 @smallexample
8614 @group
8615 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8616 . .
8617
8618 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8619 @end group
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8624 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 @group
8628 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8629 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8630 .
8631
8632 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8633
8634 @end group
8635 @end smallexample
8636 @noindent
8637 @smallexample
8638 @group
8639 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8640 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8641 .
8642
8643 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8644 @end group
8645 @end smallexample
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8649 same thing.
8650
8651 @smallexample
8652 @group
8653 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8654 . . .
8655
8656 * .1 * 3 /
8657 @end group
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @noindent
8661 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8662
8663 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8664 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8665
8666 @noindent
8667 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8668
8669 @smallexample
8670 @group
8671 ___
8672 V 2 + 2
8673 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: ---------
8674 . ___
8675 V 2 + 1
8676
8677 .
8678
8679 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 @group
8688 ___ ___
8689 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8690 .
8691
8692 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8693
8694 @end group
8695 @end smallexample
8696 @noindent
8697 @smallexample
8698 @group
8699 ___
8700 1: V 2
8701 .
8702
8703 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c
8704 @end group
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8709 second step.)
8710
8711 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8712 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8713 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8714
8715 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8716 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8717
8718 @noindent
8719 Here is the rule set:
8720
8721 @smallexample
8722 @group
8723 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8724 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8725 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8726 @end group
8727 @end smallexample
8728
8729 @noindent
8730 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8731 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8732 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8733 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8734 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8735 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8736 numbers.
8737
8738 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8739 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8740 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8741 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8742 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8743
8744 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8745 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8746 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8747 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8748 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8749 function.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8756 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8757 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8758 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8759 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8760 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8761 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8762
8763 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8764 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8765 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8766 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8767 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8768 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8769 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8770 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8771 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8772
8773 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8774 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8775
8776 @noindent
8777 @ignore
8778 @starindex
8779 @end ignore
8780 @tindex seq
8781 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8782
8783 @smallexample
8784 @group
8785 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8786 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8787 @end group
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8791 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8792
8793 @example
8794 seq( 3, 1)
8795 seq(10, 2)
8796 seq( 5, 3)
8797 seq(16, 4)
8798 seq( 8, 5)
8799 seq( 4, 6)
8800 seq( 2, 7)
8801 seq( 1, 8)
8802 @end example
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8806
8807 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8808
8809 @smallexample
8810 @group
8811 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8812 seq(1, c) := c,
8813 ... ]
8814 @end group
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8819 as the result.
8820
8821 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 @group
8825 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8826 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8827 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8828 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8829 @end group
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 @noindent
8833 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8834
8835 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8836 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8837 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8838 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8839
8840 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8841 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8842 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8843 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8844 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8845
8846 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8847 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8848
8849 @noindent
8850 @ignore
8851 @starindex
8852 @end ignore
8853 @tindex nterms
8854 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8855 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8856 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8857
8858 @smallexample
8859 @group
8860 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8861 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8867 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8868 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8869
8870 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8871 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8872
8873 @noindent
8874 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8875
8876 @smallexample
8877 @group
8878 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8879 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8880 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8881 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8882 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8883 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8884 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8885 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8886 @end group
8887 @end smallexample
8888
8889 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8890 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8891 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8892 say, @code{O}, first.
8893
8894 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8895 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8896 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8897 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8898 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8899
8900 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O@.
8901 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8902 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8903 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8904
8905 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8906
8907 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8908 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8909 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8910
8911 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8912 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8913 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8914 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8915 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8916
8917 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8918
8919 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8920 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8921 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8922 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8923 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8924 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8925 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8926 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8927 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8928 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8929 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8930
8931 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8932 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8933 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8934 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8935 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8936 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8937 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8938 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8939 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8940 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8941 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8942 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8943 in Lisp.)
8944
8945 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8946 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8947
8948 @noindent
8949 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8950 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8951 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8952 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8953 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8954
8955 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8956 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8957
8958 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8959 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8960
8961 @noindent
8962 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8963 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8964
8965 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8966 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8967
8968 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8969 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8970 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8971
8972 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8973 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8974
8975 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8976 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8980 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8981
8982 @noindent
8983 Computing
8984 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
8985 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
8986
8987 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
8988
8989 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
8990
8991 @noindent
8992 Computing the logarithm:
8993
8994 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
8995
8996 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 Computing the vector of integers:
9000
9001 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9002 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9003 from the stack.)
9004
9005 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9006 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9007 next command.)
9008
9009 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9016
9017 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9018 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9019
9020 @smallexample
9021 @group
9022 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9023 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9024 . .
9025
9026 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9027 @end group
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @noindent
9031 This answer is quite accurate.
9032
9033 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9034 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9035
9036 @noindent
9037 Here is the matrix:
9038
9039 @example
9040 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9041 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9042 @end example
9043
9044 @noindent
9045 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9046 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9047
9048 @example
9049 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9050 @end example
9051
9052 @noindent
9053 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9054 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9055 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9056 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9057 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9058 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9059 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9060 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9061
9062 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9063 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9064
9065 @noindent
9066 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9067 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9068 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9069
9070 @smallexample
9071 @group
9072 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9073 . 1: 4
9074 .
9075
9076 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9077 @end group
9078 @end smallexample
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9082 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9083 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9084 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9085 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9086 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9087 loop counter exceeds 4.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 @group
9091 2: 31 3: 31
9092 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9093 . 1: 4.02724519544
9094 .
9095
9096 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9097 @end group
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9101 harmonic number is 4.02.
9102
9103 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9104 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9108 the formula
9109 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9110 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9111
9112 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9113 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9114 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9115 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9116 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9117 just for purposes of illustration.)
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 @group
9121 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9122 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9123 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9124 .
9125
9126 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9127
9128 @end group
9129 @end smallexample
9130 @noindent
9131 @smallexample
9132 @group
9133 2: 4.5
9134 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9135 .
9136
9137 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9138 @end group
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9142 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9143 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9144 repetitions are done.)
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 @group
9148 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9149 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9150 1: 4.5 .
9151 .
9152
9153 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9154 @end group
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9158 old one to see if we've converged.
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 @group
9162 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9163 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9164 1: 4.5 .
9165 .
9166
9167 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9168 @end group
9169 @end smallexample
9170
9171 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9172 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 @group
9176 2: 5.26345856348
9177 1: 0.499999999997
9178 .
9179
9180 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9181 @end group
9182 @end smallexample
9183
9184 Let's test the new definition again:
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 @group
9188 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9189 1: 1 .
9190 .
9191
9192 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9193 @end group
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9197
9198 @example
9199 @group
9200 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9201 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9202 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9203 Z >
9204 Z '
9205 C-x )
9206 @end group
9207 @end example
9208
9209 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9210 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9211 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9212 to see how to use it.
9213
9214 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9215 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9216 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9217 @xref{Root Finding}.
9218
9219 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9220 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9221
9222 @noindent
9223 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9224 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9225 reduce the problem using
9226 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9227 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9228 on to compute
9229 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9230 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9231 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9232 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9233
9234 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9235 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9236 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9237 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9238 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9239 just for purposes of illustration.)
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 @group
9243 1: 1. 1: 1.
9244 . .
9245
9246 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9247 @end group
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9251 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9252
9253 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9254 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9255 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9256 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9257
9258 @smallexample
9259 @group
9260 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9261 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9262 1: 5 .
9263 .
9264
9265 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9266 @end group
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9270 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9271 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9272 minus the adjustment factor.
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 @group
9276 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9277 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9278 . .
9279
9280 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9281 @end group
9282 @end smallexample
9283
9284 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9285 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9286 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 @group
9290 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9291 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9292 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9293 . . 1: 36.
9294 .
9295
9296 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9297
9298 @end group
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @noindent
9301 @smallexample
9302 @group
9303 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9304 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9305 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9306 . .
9307
9308 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9309 @end group
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 This is the value of
9313 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9314 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9315 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9316 a higher precision:
9317
9318 @smallexample
9319 @group
9320 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9321 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9322
9323 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9324 @end group
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9328
9329 @example
9330 @group
9331 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9332 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9333 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9334 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9335 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9336 2 Z )
9337 Z '
9338 C-x )
9339 @end group
9340 @end example
9341
9342 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9343 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9344
9345 @noindent
9346 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9347 a term like
9348 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9349 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9350 Taking the derivative of a constant
9351 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9352 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9353 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9354
9355 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9356 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9357 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9358 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9359 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9360 just for purposes of illustration.)
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 @group
9364 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9365 1: 6 2: 0
9366 . 1: 6
9367 .
9368
9369 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9375
9376 @smallexample
9377 @group
9378 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9379 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9380 . 1: 1 .
9381 .
9382
9383 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9384 @end group
9385 @end smallexample
9386
9387 @noindent
9388 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9389 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9390 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9395 . . .
9396
9397 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9398 @end group
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9402 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9407 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9408 . .
9409
9410 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9411
9412 @end group
9413 @end smallexample
9414 @noindent
9415 @smallexample
9416 @group
9417 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9418 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9419 .
9420
9421 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9422 @end group
9423 @end smallexample
9424
9425 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9426
9427 @example
9428 @group
9429 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9430 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9431 a d x @key{RET}
9432 1 Z ) r 1
9433 Z '
9434 C-x )
9435
9436 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9437 @end group
9438 @end example
9439
9440 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9441 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9442
9443 @noindent
9444 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9445 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9446 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9447 sure the stack comes out right.
9448
9449 @smallexample
9450 @group
9451 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9452 1: 2 . 1: 2
9453 . .
9454
9455 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9456 @end group
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9460 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9461 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9462 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9463
9464 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9465 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9466
9467 @smallexample
9468 @group
9469 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9470 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9471 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9472 1: 2 .
9473 .
9474
9475 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9476
9477 @end group
9478 @end smallexample
9479 @noindent
9480 @smallexample
9481 @group
9482 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9483 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9484 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9485 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9486 . . .
9487
9488 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9489 @end group
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @noindent
9493 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9494 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9495
9496 @smallexample
9497 @group
9498 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9499 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9500 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9501 . 1: 2 .
9502 .
9503
9504 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9505
9506 @end group
9507 @end smallexample
9508 @noindent
9509 @smallexample
9510 @group
9511 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9512 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9513 . .
9514
9515 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9516 @end group
9517 @end smallexample
9518
9519 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9520 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9521 the right answers.
9522
9523 Here's the full program once again:
9524
9525 @example
9526 @group
9527 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9528 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9529 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9530 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9531 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9532 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9533 Z ]
9534 Z ]
9535 C-x )
9536 @end group
9537 @end example
9538
9539 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9540 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9541 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9542 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9543 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9544
9545 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9546 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9547
9548 @noindent
9549 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9550 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9551
9552 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9553 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9554
9555 @smallexample
9556 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9557 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9558 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9559 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9560 C-c C-c
9561 @end smallexample
9562
9563 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 @group
9567 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9568 1: 2 . .
9569 .
9570
9571 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9576 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9577 the last rule.
9578
9579 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9580 @tex
9581 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9582 @end tex
9583
9584 @c [reference]
9585
9586 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9587 @chapter Introduction
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9591 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9592 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9593
9594 @c [when-split]
9595 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9596
9597 @menu
9598 * Basic Commands::
9599 * Help Commands::
9600 * Stack Basics::
9601 * Numeric Entry::
9602 * Algebraic Entry::
9603 * Quick Calculator::
9604 * Prefix Arguments::
9605 * Undo::
9606 * Error Messages::
9607 * Multiple Calculators::
9608 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9609 @end menu
9610
9611 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9612 @section Basic Commands
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 @pindex calc
9616 @pindex calc-mode
9617 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9618 @cindex Running the Calculator
9619 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9620 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @file{*Calculator*}
9621 and @file{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9622 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9623 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9624 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9625 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9626 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9627 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9628 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9629 to turn the trail window off, but the @file{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9630 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9631
9632 @kindex C-x * c
9633 @kindex C-x * *
9634 @ignore
9635 @mindex @null
9636 @end ignore
9637 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9638 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9639 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9640 in its Keypad mode.
9641
9642 @kindex x
9643 @kindex M-x
9644 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9645 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9646 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9647 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9648 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9649 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9650 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9651 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9652
9653 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9654 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9655 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9656 numbers.
9657
9658 @cindex Extensions module
9659 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9660 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9661 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9662 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9663 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9664 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9665 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9666 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9667 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9668 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9669 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9670
9671 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9672 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9673 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9674 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9675 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9676 to auto-load the Calculator.
9677
9678 @kindex C-x * b
9679 @pindex full-calc
9680 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9681 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9682 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9683 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9684 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9685 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9686 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9687
9688 @kindex C-x * o
9689 @pindex calc-other-window
9690 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9691 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9692 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9693 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9694 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9695 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9696
9697 @ignore
9698 @mindex C-x * q
9699 @end ignore
9700 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9701 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9702 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9703 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9704
9705 @ignore
9706 @mindex C-x * k
9707 @end ignore
9708 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9709 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9710 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9711 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9712
9713 @kindex q
9714 @pindex calc-quit
9715 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9716 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9717 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9718 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9719 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9720 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9721 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9722 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9723 Calculator on and off.
9724
9725 @kindex C-x * x
9726 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9727 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9728 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9729
9730 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9731 @pindex calc-refresh
9732 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9733 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9734 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9735 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9736 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9737
9738 @ignore
9739 @mindex o
9740 @end ignore
9741 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9742 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9743
9744 @kindex <
9745 @kindex >
9746 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9747 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9748 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9749 @cindex Scrolling
9750 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9751 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9752 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9753 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9754 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9755 window whenever it can.)
9756
9757 @kindex @{
9758 @kindex @}
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9760 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9761 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9762 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9763 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9764 height of the Calc window.
9765
9766 @kindex C-x * 0
9767 @pindex calc-reset
9768 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9769 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9770 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9771 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9772 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9773 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9774 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9775 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9776 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9777 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9778 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9779
9780 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9781 @section Help Commands
9782
9783 @noindent
9784 @cindex Help commands
9785 @kindex ?
9786 @kindex a ?
9787 @kindex b ?
9788 @kindex c ?
9789 @kindex d ?
9790 @kindex f ?
9791 @kindex g ?
9792 @kindex j ?
9793 @kindex k ?
9794 @kindex m ?
9795 @kindex r ?
9796 @kindex s ?
9797 @kindex t ?
9798 @kindex u ?
9799 @kindex v ?
9800 @kindex V ?
9801 @kindex z ?
9802 @kindex Z ?
9803 @pindex calc-help
9804 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9805 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs's
9806 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9807 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9808 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9809 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9810
9811 @kindex h h
9812 @pindex calc-full-help
9813 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9814 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9815 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9816
9817 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9818 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9819 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9820
9821 @kindex h i
9822 @kindex C-x * i
9823 @kindex i
9824 @pindex calc-info
9825 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9826 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9827 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9828 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9829 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9830 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9831 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9832 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9833 different command in a future version of Calc.
9834
9835 @kindex h t
9836 @kindex C-x * t
9837 @pindex calc-tutorial
9838 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9839 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9840 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9841 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9842 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9843 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9844 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9845 all times).
9846
9847 @kindex h s
9848 @kindex C-x * s
9849 @pindex calc-info-summary
9850 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9851 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9852 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9853
9854 @kindex h k
9855 @pindex calc-describe-key
9856 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9857 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9858 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9859 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9860 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9861 node indicated by the index.
9862
9863 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9864 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9865 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9866 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9867
9868 @kindex h c
9869 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9870 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9871 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9872 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9873 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9874 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9875 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9876 gives the description:
9877
9878 @smallexample
9879 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9884 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9885 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9886 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9887 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9888
9889 @kindex h f
9890 @pindex calc-describe-function
9891 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9892 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9893 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9894 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9895 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9896 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9897 @samp{=>}.
9898
9899 @kindex h v
9900 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9901 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9902 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9903 @code{PlotRejects}.
9904
9905 @kindex h b
9906 @pindex describe-bindings
9907 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9908 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9909 listed.
9910
9911 @kindex h n
9912 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9913 the ``news'' or change history of Emacs, and jumps to the most recent
9914 portion concerning Calc (if present). For older history, see the file
9915 @file{etc/CALC-NEWS} in the Emacs distribution.
9916
9917 @kindex h C-c
9918 @kindex h C-d
9919 @kindex h C-w
9920 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9921 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9922 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9923 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9924
9925 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9926 @section Stack Basics
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 @cindex Stack basics
9930 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9931 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9932 Tutorial}.
9933
9934 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9935 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9936 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9937 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9938 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9939 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9940 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9941 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9942
9943 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9944 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9945 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9946 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9947 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9948 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9949
9950 @kindex d l
9951 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9952 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9953 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9954 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9955 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9956 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9957
9958 @kindex o
9959 @pindex calc-realign
9960 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9961 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9962 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9963 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9964
9965 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9966 two consecutive numbers.
9967 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9968 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9969 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9970 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9971
9972 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9973 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9974 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9975 commands.
9976
9977 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9978 @section Numeric Entry
9979
9980 @noindent
9981 @kindex 0-9
9982 @kindex .
9983 @kindex e
9984 @cindex Numeric entry
9985 @cindex Entering numbers
9986 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9987 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9988 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9989 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9990 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9991
9992 @cindex Minus signs
9993 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9994 @kindex _
9995 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9996 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9997 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9998 different keys for these operations, respectively:
9999 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10000 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10001 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10002 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10003 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10004 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10005 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10006
10007 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10008 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10009 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10010 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10011
10012 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10013
10014 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10015 @section Algebraic Entry
10016
10017 @noindent
10018 @kindex '
10019 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10020 @cindex Algebraic notation
10021 @cindex Formulas, entering
10022 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10023 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10024 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10025
10026 @example
10027 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @noindent
10031 This will compute
10032 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10033 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10034 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10035 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10036 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10037 clear previous results off the stack.
10038
10039 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10040 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10041 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10042 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10043
10044 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10045 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10046 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10047 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10048
10049 @kindex m a
10050 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10051 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10052 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10053 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10054 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10055 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10056 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10057 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10058 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10059 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10060 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10061
10062 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10063 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10064 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10065 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10066 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10067
10068 @kindex m t
10069 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10070 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10071 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10072 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10073 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10074 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10075 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10076 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10077 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10078 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10079 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10080 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10081 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10082
10083 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10084 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10085 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10086
10087 @kindex $
10088 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10089 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10090 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10091 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10092 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10093 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10094 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10095 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10096 first character in the new formula.
10097
10098 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10099 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10100 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10101 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10102 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10103 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10104 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10105
10106 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10107 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10108 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10109 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10110 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10111 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10112
10113 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10114 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10115 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10116 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10117 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10118 @key{TAB} key.
10119
10120 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10121 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10122 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10123 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10124
10125 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10126 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables simplification
10127 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10128 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10129 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10130 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10131
10132 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10133 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10134
10135 @noindent
10136 @kindex C-x * q
10137 @pindex quick-calc
10138 @cindex Quick Calculator
10139 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10140 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10141 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10142 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10143 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10144
10145 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10146 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10147 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10148 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10149 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10150 @samp{$} as the formula.
10151
10152 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10153 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @file{*Calculator*}
10154 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10155 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10156 Calculator refers to the @file{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10157 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10158 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10159 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10160
10161 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10162 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10163
10164 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10165 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10166 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10167 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10168 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10169 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10170
10171 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10172 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10173 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10174
10175 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10176 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10177 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10178 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10179 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10180 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10181
10182 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10183 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10184 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10185 an ASCII character.
10186
10187 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10188 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10189 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10190 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10191 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10192 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10193 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10194
10195 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10196 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10197 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10198 small calculations.
10199
10200 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10201 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10202
10203 @noindent
10204 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10205 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10206 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10207 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10208 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10209
10210 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10211 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10212 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10213 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10214 on the entire stack.
10215
10216 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10217 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10218 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10219 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10220 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10221 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10222 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10223 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10224 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10225 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10226 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10227 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10228 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10229 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10230 argument for some other purpose.
10231
10232 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10233 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10234 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10235 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10236
10237 @kindex ~
10238 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10239 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10240 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10241 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10242 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10243 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10244
10245 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10246 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10247
10248 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10249 @section Undoing Mistakes
10250
10251 @noindent
10252 @kindex U
10253 @kindex C-_
10254 @pindex calc-undo
10255 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10256 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10257 @cindex Errors, undoing
10258 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10259 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10260 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10261 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10262 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10263 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10264 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10265 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10266 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10267 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10268 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10269 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10270 undo history.)
10271
10272 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10273 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10274 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10275
10276 @kindex D
10277 @pindex calc-redo
10278 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10279 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10280 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10281 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10282 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10283 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10284 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10285 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10286
10287 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10288 @pindex calc-last-args
10289 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10290 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10291 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10292 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10293 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10294 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10295 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10296 onto the stack.
10297
10298 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10299 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10300
10301 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10302 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10303
10304 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10305
10306 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10307 @section Error Messages
10308
10309 @noindent
10310 @kindex w
10311 @pindex calc-why
10312 @cindex Errors, messages
10313 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10314 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10315 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10316 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10317 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10318 reasons for this to happen.
10319
10320 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10321 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10322 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10323 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10324 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10325 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10326 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10327
10328 @kindex d w
10329 @pindex calc-auto-why
10330 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10331 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10332 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10333 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10334 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10335 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10336
10337 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10338 @section Multiple Calculators
10339
10340 @noindent
10341 @pindex another-calc
10342 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10343 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10344 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @file{*Calculator*}
10345 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10346 form @file{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10347 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10348 this would ordinarily never be done.
10349
10350 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10351 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10352 Calculator buffer.
10353
10354 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10355 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10356 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10357 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10358 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10359 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10360
10361 There is only one trail buffer, @file{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10362 Calculator buffers.
10363
10364 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10365 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10366
10367 @noindent
10368 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10369 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10370
10371 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10372 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10373
10374 @menu
10375 * Autoloading Problems::
10376 * Recursion Depth::
10377 * Caches::
10378 * Debugging Calc::
10379 @end menu
10380
10381 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10382 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10383
10384 @noindent
10385 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10386 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10387 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10388 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10389 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10390
10391 @kindex C-x * L
10392 @pindex calc-load-everything
10393 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10394 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10395 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10396 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10397
10398 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10399 @subsection Recursion Depth
10400
10401 @noindent
10402 @kindex M
10403 @kindex I M
10404 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10405 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10406 @cindex Recursion depth
10407 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10408 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10409 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10410 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10411 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10412 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10413 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10414 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10415 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10416 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10417
10418 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10419 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10420 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10421 The default value is 1000.
10422
10423 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10424 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10425
10426 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10427 @subsection Caches
10428
10429 @noindent
10430 @cindex Caches
10431 @cindex Flushing caches
10432 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10433 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10434 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10435 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10436 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10437 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10438 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10439 @cpiover{4} and
10440 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10441 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10442 The visible effect of caching is that
10443 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10444 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10445 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10446 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10447
10448 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10449 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10450 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10451 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10452 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10453 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10454
10455 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10456 @subsection Debugging Calc
10457
10458 @noindent
10459 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10460 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10461 your own Calc commands.
10462
10463 @kindex Z T
10464 @pindex calc-timing
10465 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10466 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10467 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10468 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10469 accurate only to within one second.
10470
10471 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10472 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10473 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10474 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10475 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10476 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10477 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10478 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10479 to execute the whole macro.
10480
10481 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10482 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10483 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10484 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10485 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10486 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10487 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10488
10489 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10490 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10491 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10492 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10493 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10494 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10495 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10496
10497 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10498 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10499 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10500 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10501 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10502 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10503 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10504 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10505 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10506 will be lost.
10507
10508 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10509 @chapter Data Types
10510
10511 @noindent
10512 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10513 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10514 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10515 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10516
10517 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10518 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10519 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10520 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10521 arbitrarily: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10522 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10523 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10524
10525 @menu
10526 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10527 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10528 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10529 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10530 * Infinities::
10531 * Vectors and Matrices::
10532 * Strings::
10533 * HMS Forms::
10534 * Date Forms::
10535 * Modulo Forms::
10536 * Error Forms::
10537 * Interval Forms::
10538 * Incomplete Objects::
10539 * Variables::
10540 * Formulas::
10541 @end menu
10542
10543 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10544 @section Integers
10545
10546 @noindent
10547 @cindex Integers
10548 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10549 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10550 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10551 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10552 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10553 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10554
10555 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10556 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10557 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10558 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10559
10560 @kindex #
10561 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10562 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10563 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10564 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10565 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10566 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10567 number, the current display radix is used.
10568
10569 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10570 @section Fractions
10571
10572 @noindent
10573 @cindex Fractions
10574 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10575 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10576 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10577 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10578 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10579 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10580 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10581
10582 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10583 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10584 display formats.
10585
10586 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10587 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10588 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10589
10590 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10591 @section Floats
10592
10593 @noindent
10594 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10595 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10596 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10597 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10598 range of acceptable values is from
10599 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10600 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10601 (inclusive) to
10602 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10603 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10604 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10605
10606 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10607 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10608 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10609 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10610 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10611 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10612 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10613 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10614 would have overflowed!)
10615
10616 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10617 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10618 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10619 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10620
10621 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10622 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10623 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10624 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10625 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10626 or 0.235.
10627
10628 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10629 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10630 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10631 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10632
10633 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10634 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10635 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10636 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10637 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10638 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10639 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10640 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10641 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10642 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10643 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10644 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10645 way.
10646
10647 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10648 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10649 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10650 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10651 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10652 current precision. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10653 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10654 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10655 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10656 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10657 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10658 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10659 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10660 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10661 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10662 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10663
10664 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10665 @section Complex Numbers
10666
10667 @noindent
10668 @cindex Complex numbers
10669 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10670 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10671 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10672 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10673 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10674 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10675
10676 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10677 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10678 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10679 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10680 @texline @math{\theta}
10681 @infoline @var{theta}
10682 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10683 @texline @math{\theta}
10684 @infoline @var{theta}
10685 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10686 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10687 in radians.
10688
10689 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10690 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10691
10692 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10693 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10694 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10695 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10696 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10697
10698 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10699 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10700 number.
10701
10702 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10703 @section Infinities
10704
10705 @noindent
10706 @cindex Infinity
10707 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10708 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10709 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10710 @vindex inf
10711 @vindex uinf
10712 @vindex nan
10713 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10714 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10715 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10716 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10717 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10718 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10719 entered using algebraic entry.
10720
10721 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10722 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10723 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10724 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10725 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10726 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10727 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10728 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10729 @texline @math{e^x}
10730 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10731 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10732 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10733 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10734 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10735
10736 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10737 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10738 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10739 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10740 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10741 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10742 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10743 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10744 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10745 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10746 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10747
10748 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10749 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10750 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10751 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10752 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10753 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10754 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10755 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10756 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10757 some cases.
10758
10759 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10760 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10761 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10762 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10763 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10764 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10765 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10766 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10767 notation.
10768
10769 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10770 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10771 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10772 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10773 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10774 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10775 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10776 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10777 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10778 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10779 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10780 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10781 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10782 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10783 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10784 (as described above).
10785
10786 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10787 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10788
10789 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10790 @section Vectors and Matrices
10791
10792 @noindent
10793 @cindex Vectors
10794 @cindex Plain vectors
10795 @cindex Matrices
10796 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10797 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10798 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10799 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10800 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10801
10802 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10803 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10804 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10805 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10806 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10807 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10808 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10809 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10810 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10811 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10812 this case.
10813
10814 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10815 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10816 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10817 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10818 of its elements.
10819
10820 @ignore
10821 @starindex
10822 @end ignore
10823 @tindex vec
10824 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10825 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10826 @texline @math{n\times m}
10827 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10828 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10829 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10830
10831 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10832 @section Strings
10833
10834 @noindent
10835 @kindex "
10836 @cindex Strings
10837 @cindex Character strings
10838 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10839 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10840 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10841 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10842 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10843 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10844
10845 @example
10846 @group
10847 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10848 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10849 \e 27 \^[ 27
10850 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10851 \n 10 \^] 29
10852 \r 13 \^^ 30
10853 \t 9 \^_ 31
10854 \^? 127
10855 @end group
10856 @end example
10857
10858 @noindent
10859 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10860 character from its ASCII code.
10861
10862 @kindex d "
10863 @pindex calc-display-strings
10864 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10865 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10866 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10867 instead.
10868
10869 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10870 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10871 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10872 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10873 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10874 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10875
10876 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10877 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10878 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10879
10880 @ignore
10881 @starindex
10882 @end ignore
10883 @tindex string
10884 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10885 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10886 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10887 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10888 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10889 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10890 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10891 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10892 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10893
10894 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10895 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10896 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10897 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10898
10899 @ignore
10900 @starindex
10901 @end ignore
10902 @tindex bstring
10903 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10904 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10905 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10906 character in the string.
10907
10908 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10909 @section HMS Forms
10910
10911 @noindent
10912 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10913 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10914 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10915 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10916 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10917 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10918 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10919 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10920
10921 @kindex @@
10922 @ignore
10923 @mindex @null
10924 @end ignore
10925 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10926 @ignore
10927 @mindex @null
10928 @end ignore
10929 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10930 @ignore
10931 @mindex @null
10932 @end ignore
10933 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10934 @ignore
10935 @mindex @null
10936 @end ignore
10937 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10938 @ignore
10939 @mindex @null
10940 @end ignore
10941 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10942 @ignore
10943 @mindex @null
10944 @end ignore
10945 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10946 The default format for HMS values is
10947 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10948 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10949 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10950 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10951 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10952 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10953 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10954 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10955 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10956 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10957 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10958 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10959
10960 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10961 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10962 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10963 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10964
10965 @pindex calc-time
10966 @cindex Time of day
10967 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10968 the stack as an HMS form.
10969
10970 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10971 @section Date Forms
10972
10973 @noindent
10974 @cindex Date forms
10975 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10976 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10977 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10978 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10979 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10980 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10981 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10982
10983 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10984 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10985 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10986 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10987 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10988
10989 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10990 of days since midnight on the morning of December 31 of the year 1 BC@.
10991 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10992 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10993 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Thu Jan 10, 1991>}
10994 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10995 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10996 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10997
10998 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
10999 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11000 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11001 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11002 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11003 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11004 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11005 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11006 never an issue for them.
11007
11008 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11009 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11010 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11011
11012 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11013 year numbers represent years BC@. There is no ``year 0''; the day
11014 before @samp{<Mon Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Sun Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11015 days 1 and 0 respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme. The
11016 Gregorian calendar is used for all dates, including dates before the
11017 Gregorian calendar was invented (although that can be configured; see
11018 below). Thus Calc's use of the day number @mathit{-10000} to
11019 represent August 15, 28 BC should be taken with a grain of salt.
11020
11021 @cindex Julian calendar
11022 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11023 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11024 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the confusion
11025 caused by the irregular Roman calendar that was used before that time.
11026 The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in all years divisible by
11027 four. After some initial confusion, the calendar was adopted around
11028 the year we call 8 AD@. Some centuries later it became
11029 apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was itself not quite
11030 right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the Gregorian calendar,
11031 which added the new rule that years divisible by 100, but not by 400,
11032 were not to be considered leap years despite being divisible by four.
11033 Many countries delayed adoption of the Gregorian calendar
11034 because of religious differences. For example, Great Britain and the
11035 British colonies switched to the Gregorian calendar in September
11036 1752, when the Julian calendar was eleven days behind the
11037 Gregorian calendar. That year in Britain, the day after September 2
11038 was September 14. To take another example, Russia did not adopt the
11039 Gregorian calendar until 1918, and that year in Russia the day after
11040 January 31 was February 14. Calc's reckoning therefore matches English
11041 practice starting in 1752 and Russian practice starting in 1918, but
11042 disagrees with earlier dates in both countries.
11043
11044 When the Julian calendar was introduced, it had January 1 as the first
11045 day of the year. By the Middle Ages, many European countries
11046 had changed the beginning of a new year to a different date, often to
11047 a religious festival. Almost all countries reverted to using January 1
11048 as the beginning of the year by the time they adopted the Gregorian
11049 calendar.
11050
11051 Some calendars attempt to mimic the historical situation by using the
11052 Gregorian calendar for recent dates and the Julian calendar for older
11053 dates. The @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations does this,
11054 for example. While January 1 wasn't always the beginning of a calendar
11055 year, these hybrid calendars still use January 1 as the beginning of
11056 the year even for older dates. The customizable variable
11057 @code{calc-gregorian-switch} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}) can be set to
11058 have Calc's date forms switch from the Julian to Gregorian calendar at
11059 any specified date.
11060
11061 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second''.
11062 These do not occur regularly and Calc does not take these minor
11063 effects into account. (If it did, it would have to report a
11064 non-integer number of days between, say,
11065 @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11066 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11067
11068 @cindex Julian day counting
11069 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11070 ``Julian.'' Julian days go from noon to noon. The Julian day number
11071 is the numbers of days since 12:00 noon (GMT) on November 24, 4714 BC
11072 in the Gregorian calendar (i.e., January 1, 4713 BC in the Julian
11073 calendar). In Calc's scheme (in GMT) the Julian day origin is
11074 @mathit{-1721422.5}, because Calc starts at midnight instead of noon.
11075 Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11076 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721422.5 after
11077 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11078 command performs this conversion for you.
11079
11080 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11081 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11082 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11083 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11084 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11085 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11086 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11087 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11088 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11089 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11090 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11091 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11092 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11093 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11094 pairwise relatively prime) is
11095 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11096 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11097 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11098 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scaliger
11099 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11100 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11101 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11102 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11103 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11104 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11105 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11106 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11107 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11108 noon GMT@.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11109
11110 @cindex Unix time format
11111 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11112 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11113 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11114 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11115 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11116 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11117 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11118 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11119 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11120 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11121 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11122 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11123 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11124 conversions.
11125
11126 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11127 @section Modulo Forms
11128
11129 @noindent
11130 @cindex Modulo forms
11131 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11132 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11133 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11134 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11135 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11136 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11137 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11138 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11139 integers but this is not required.
11140
11141 @ignore
11142 @mindex M
11143 @end ignore
11144 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11145 @ignore
11146 @mindex mod
11147 @end ignore
11148 @tindex mod (operator)
11149 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11150 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11151 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11152 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11153 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11154 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11155
11156 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11157 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11158 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11159 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11160 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11161 the result always lies in the desired range.
11162
11163 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11164 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11165 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11166 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11167 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11168 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11169 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11170 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11171
11172 @cindex Modulo division
11173 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11174 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11175 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11176 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11177 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11178 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11179 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11180 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11181 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11182 in the sense of reducing
11183 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11184 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11185 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11186 number-theoretical point of view.)
11187
11188 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11189 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11190 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11191 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11192 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11193 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11194 24 radians!
11195
11196 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11197 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11198 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11199
11200 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11201 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11202
11203 @ignore
11204 @starindex
11205 @end ignore
11206 @tindex makemod
11207 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11208 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11209
11210 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11211 @section Error Forms
11212
11213 @noindent
11214 @cindex Error forms
11215 @cindex Standard deviations
11216 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11217 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11218 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11219 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11220 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11221 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11222 deviation or ``error''
11223 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11224 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11225 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11226 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11227 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11228 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11229 regular number by the Calculator.
11230
11231 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11232 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11233 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11234 @texline @math{\sin x}
11235 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11236 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11237 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11238 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11239 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11240 @tex
11241 $$ \eqalign{
11242 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11243 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11244 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11245 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11246 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11247 \right| \right)^2
11248 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11249 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11250 } $$
11251 @end tex
11252 Note that this
11253 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11254 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11255 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11256 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11257 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11258 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11259 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11260
11261 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11262 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11263 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11264 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11265 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11266 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11267 is
11268 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11269 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11270 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11271 @texline @math{\cos x}
11272 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11273 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11274 @texline @math{\sigma};
11275 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11276 this makes sense, since
11277 @texline @math{\sin x}
11278 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11279 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11280 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11281 @texline @math{\cos x}
11282 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11283 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11284 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11285 has relatively little effect on the value of
11286 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11287 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11288 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11289 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11290 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11291 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11292 @texline @math{\sin x}
11293 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11294 would indeed have been negligible.
11295
11296 @ignore
11297 @mindex p
11298 @end ignore
11299 @kindex p (error forms)
11300 @tindex +/-
11301 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11302 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11303 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11304 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11305 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11306
11307 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11308 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11309 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11310 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11311 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11312 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11313 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11314 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11315
11316 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11317 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11318
11319 @ignore
11320 @starindex
11321 @end ignore
11322 @tindex sdev
11323 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11324
11325 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11326 @section Interval Forms
11327
11328 @noindent
11329 @cindex Interval forms
11330 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11331 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11332 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11333 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11334 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11335 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11336 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11337 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11338 set of possible values of the input.
11339
11340 @ifnottex
11341 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11342 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11343 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11344 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11345 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11346 terms,
11347 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11348 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11349 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11350 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11351 @end ifnottex
11352 @tex
11353 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11354 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11355 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11356 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11357 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11358 terms,
11359 $$ \eqalign{
11360 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11361 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11362 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11363 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11364 } $$
11365 @end tex
11366
11367 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11368 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11369 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11370 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11371 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11372 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11373 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11374 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11375 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11376 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11377 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11378 the real infinities.
11379
11380 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11381 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11382 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11383 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11384 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11385 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11386 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11387
11388 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11389 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11390 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11391 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11392 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11393 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11394 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11395 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11396 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11397
11398 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11399 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11400 form
11401 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11402 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11403 means a variable is random, and its value could
11404 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11405 @texline @math{\sigma}
11406 @infoline @var{sigma}
11407 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11408 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11409 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11410 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11411 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11412 answer.
11413
11414 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11415 HMS forms or date forms.
11416
11417 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11418 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11419
11420 @ignore
11421 @starindex
11422 @end ignore
11423 @tindex intv
11424 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11425 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11426 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11427 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11428
11429 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11430 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11431 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11432 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11433 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11434 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11435 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11436 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11437 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11438 error.
11439
11440 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11441 @section Incomplete Objects
11442
11443 @noindent
11444 @ignore
11445 @mindex [ ]
11446 @end ignore
11447 @kindex [
11448 @ignore
11449 @mindex ( )
11450 @end ignore
11451 @kindex (
11452 @kindex ,
11453 @ignore
11454 @mindex @null
11455 @end ignore
11456 @kindex ]
11457 @ignore
11458 @mindex @null
11459 @end ignore
11460 @kindex )
11461 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11462 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11463 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11464 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11465 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11466 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11467 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11468 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11469 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11470
11471 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11472 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11473 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11474
11475 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11476 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11477 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11478 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11479
11480 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11481 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11482 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11483 from the list.
11484
11485 @kindex ;
11486 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11487 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11488 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11489 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11490
11491 @kindex ..
11492 @pindex calc-dots
11493 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11494 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11495 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11496 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11497 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11498 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11499
11500 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11501 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11502
11503 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11504 @section Variables
11505
11506 @noindent
11507 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11508 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11509 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11510 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11511 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11512 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11513 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11514 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11515 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11516 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11517 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11518 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11519 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11520 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11521 refer to the same variable.)
11522
11523 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11524 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11525 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11526 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11527 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11528 @code{foo}.
11529
11530 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11531 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11532 (@key{'}) key.
11533
11534 @kindex =
11535 @pindex calc-evaluate
11536 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11537 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11538 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11539 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11540 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11541 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11542 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11543 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11544 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11545 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11546 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11547 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11548
11549 @cindex @code{e} variable
11550 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11551 @cindex @code{i} variable
11552 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11553 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11554 @vindex e
11555 @vindex pi
11556 @vindex i
11557 @vindex phi
11558 @vindex gamma
11559 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11560 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11561 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11562 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11563 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11564 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11565
11566 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11567 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11568 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11569 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11570 a value into any of these special variables.
11571
11572 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11573
11574 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11575 @section Formulas
11576
11577 @noindent
11578 @cindex Formulas
11579 @cindex Expressions
11580 @cindex Operators in formulas
11581 @cindex Precedence of operators
11582 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11583 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11584 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11585 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11586 Parentheses may
11587 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11588 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11589 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11590 with their equivalent function names, are:
11591
11592 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11593
11594 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11595
11596 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11597
11598 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11599 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11600
11601 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11602 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11603
11604 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11605
11606 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11607
11608 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11609
11610 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11611 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11612
11613 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11614
11615 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11616
11617 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11618 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11619
11620 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11621
11622 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11623
11624 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11625
11626 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11627
11628 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11629
11630 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11631
11632 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11633
11634 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11635
11636 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11637
11638 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11639 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11640 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11641 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11642
11643 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11644 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11645 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11646 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11647 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11648 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11649 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11650 as in @samp{f(x)},
11651 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11652 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11653 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11654 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11655 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11656
11657 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11658 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11659 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11660 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11661 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11662 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11663 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11664 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11665 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11666 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11667 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11668
11669 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11670 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11671 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11672 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11673 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11674 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11675 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11676 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11677 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11678 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11679
11680 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11681 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11682 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11683 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11684
11685 @cindex Function call notation
11686 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11687 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11688 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11689 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11690 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11691 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11692 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11693 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11694 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11695 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11696 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11697
11698 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11699 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11700 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11701 represent the same operation.
11702
11703 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11704 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11705 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11706 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11707 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11708 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11709 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11710
11711 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11712 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11713 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11714 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11715
11716 @example
11717 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11718 c + d,
11719 %% last line is coming up:
11720 e + f ]
11721 @end example
11722
11723 @noindent
11724 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11725
11726 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11727 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11728 formats.
11729
11730 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11731
11732 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11733 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11734
11735 @noindent
11736 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11737 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11738 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11739
11740 @menu
11741 * Stack Manipulation::
11742 * Editing Stack Entries::
11743 * Trail Commands::
11744 * Keep Arguments::
11745 @end menu
11746
11747 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11748 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11749
11750 @noindent
11751 @kindex @key{RET}
11752 @kindex @key{SPC}
11753 @pindex calc-enter
11754 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11755 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11756 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11757 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11758 several elements at the top of the stack.
11759 Given a negative argument,
11760 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11761 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11762 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11763 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11764 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11765 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11766 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11767
11768 @kindex @key{LFD}
11769 @pindex calc-over
11770 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11771 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11772 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11773 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11774 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11775 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11776 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11777
11778 @kindex @key{DEL}
11779 @kindex C-d
11780 @pindex calc-pop
11781 @cindex Removing stack entries
11782 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11783 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11784 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11785 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11786 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11787 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11788 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11789 stack is emptied.
11790 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11791 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11792 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11793 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11794 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11795
11796 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11797 @pindex calc-pop-above
11798 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11799 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11800 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11801 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11802 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11803 the third stack element.
11804
11805 The above commands do not depend on the location of the cursor.
11806 If the customizable variable @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is
11807 non-@code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), these commands will become
11808 context sensitive. For example, instead of duplicating the top of the stack,
11809 @key{RET} will copy the element at the cursor to the top of the
11810 stack. With a positive numeric prefix, a copy of the element at the
11811 cursor and the appropriate number of preceding elements will be placed
11812 at the top of the stack. A negative prefix will still duplicate the
11813 specified element of the stack regardless of the cursor position.
11814 Similarly, @key{DEL} will remove the corresponding elements from the
11815 stack.
11816
11817 @kindex @key{TAB}
11818 @pindex calc-roll-down
11819 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11820 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11821 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11822 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11823 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11824 top-for-bottom.
11825 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11826 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11827 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11828 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11829 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11830
11831 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11832 @pindex calc-roll-up
11833 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11834 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11835 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11836 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11837 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11838 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11839 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11840 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11841
11842 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11843 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11844 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11845 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11846 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11847 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11848 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11849
11850 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11851 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11852 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11853 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11854 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11855
11856 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11857 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11858
11859 @kindex C-xC-t
11860 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11861 @cindex Moving stack entries
11862 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11863 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11864 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11865 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11866 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11867 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11868 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11869 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11870 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11871 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11872 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11873 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11874 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11875
11876 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11877 @section Editing Stack Entries
11878
11879 @noindent
11880 @kindex `
11881 @pindex calc-edit
11882 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11883 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11884 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11885 (@file{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11886 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11887 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11888 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11889 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11890
11891 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11892 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11893 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11894 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11895 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11896
11897 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11898 the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11899 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11900 then kills the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11901 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11902 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11903 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11904
11905 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11906 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11907 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11908 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11909
11910 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11911 Calc will not kill the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11912 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11913 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11914 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11915 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11916 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11917 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11918 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11919
11920 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11921 each line of the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11922 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11923 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11924 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11925
11926 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11927 text entered so far is moved to the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11928 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11929
11930 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11931 @section Trail Commands
11932
11933 @noindent
11934 @cindex Trail buffer
11935 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11936 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11937
11938 @kindex t d
11939 @pindex calc-trail-display
11940 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11941 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11942 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11943 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11944 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11945 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11946 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11947 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11948 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11949
11950 @kindex t i
11951 @pindex calc-trail-in
11952 @kindex t o
11953 @pindex calc-trail-out
11954 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11955 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11956 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11957 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11958 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11959 in the Calculator window.
11960
11961 @cindex Trail pointer
11962 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11963 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11964 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11965 trail pointer in various ways.
11966
11967 @kindex t y
11968 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11969 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11970 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11971 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11972 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11973 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11974 trail pointer.
11975
11976 @kindex t <
11977 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11978 @kindex t >
11979 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11980 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11981 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11982 window left or right by one half of its width.
11983
11984 @kindex t n
11985 @pindex calc-trail-next
11986 @kindex t p
11987 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11988 @kindex t f
11989 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11990 @kindex t b
11991 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11992 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11993 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11994 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11995 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11996 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11997 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11998
11999 @kindex t [
12000 @pindex calc-trail-first
12001 @kindex t ]
12002 @pindex calc-trail-last
12003 @kindex t h
12004 @pindex calc-trail-here
12005 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
12006 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12007 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12008 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12009 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12010
12011 @kindex t s
12012 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12013 @kindex t r
12014 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12015 @ifnottex
12016 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12017 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12018 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12019 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12020 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12021 it was when the search began.
12022 @end ifnottex
12023 @tex
12024 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12025 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12026 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12027 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12028 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12029 it was when the search began.
12030 @end tex
12031
12032 @kindex t m
12033 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12034 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12035 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12036 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12037 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12038 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12039
12040 @kindex t k
12041 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12042 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12043 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12044 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12045 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12046 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12047
12048 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12049 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12050
12051 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12052 @section Keep Arguments
12053
12054 @noindent
12055 @kindex K
12056 @pindex calc-keep-args
12057 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12058 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12059 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12060 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12061 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12062
12063 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12064 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12065 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12066 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12067 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12068 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12069 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12070 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12071 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12072 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12073 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12074 extra work.
12075
12076 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12077 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12078 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12079
12080 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12081 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12082 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12083 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12084 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12085 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12086
12087 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12088 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12089 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12090 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12091 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12092 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12093
12094 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12095 @chapter Mode Settings
12096
12097 @noindent
12098 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12099 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12100 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12101
12102 @menu
12103 * General Mode Commands::
12104 * Precision::
12105 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12106 * Calculation Modes::
12107 * Simplification Modes::
12108 * Declarations::
12109 * Display Modes::
12110 * Language Modes::
12111 * Modes Variable::
12112 * Calc Mode Line::
12113 @end menu
12114
12115 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12116 @section General Mode Commands
12117
12118 @noindent
12119 @kindex m m
12120 @pindex calc-save-modes
12121 @cindex Continuous memory
12122 @cindex Saving mode settings
12123 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12124 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12125 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12126 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12127 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12128 command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12129 it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12130 controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12131 precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12132 the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12133 interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12134 were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12135 Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12136 file.
12137
12138 @kindex m R
12139 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12140 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12141 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12142 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12143 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12144 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12145 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12146 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12147 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12148
12149 @kindex m F
12150 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12151 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12152 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12153 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12154 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12155 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12156 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12157 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12158 file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12159 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12160 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12161
12162 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12163 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12164 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12165 to reread. You can give
12166 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12167 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12168 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12169 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12170 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12171 modes present in the file you were using before.
12172
12173 @kindex m x
12174 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12175 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12176 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12177 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12178 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12179 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12180 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12181 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12182
12183 @kindex m S
12184 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12185 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12186 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12187 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12188 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12189 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12190 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12191 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12192 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12193 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12194 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12195 shifted-prefix mode.
12196
12197 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12198 @section Precision
12199
12200 @noindent
12201 @kindex p
12202 @pindex calc-precision
12203 @cindex Precision of calculations
12204 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12205 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12206 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12207 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12208 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12209
12210 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12211 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12212
12213 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12214 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12215 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12216 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12217 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12218 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12219 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12220 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12221 existing value to a new precision.
12222
12223 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12224 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12225 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12226 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12227 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12228 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12229 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12230 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12231 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12232 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12233 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12234 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12235 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12236
12237 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12238 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12239 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12240 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12241 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12242 of the numbers involved.
12243
12244 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12245 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12246 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12247 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12248 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12249 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12250
12251 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12252 issues.
12253
12254 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12255 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12256
12257 @noindent
12258 @kindex I
12259 @pindex calc-inverse
12260 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12261 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12262 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12263 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12264 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12265
12266 @kindex H
12267 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12268 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12269 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12270 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12271 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12272 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12273 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12274
12275 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12276 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12277 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12278 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12279
12280 @kindex O
12281 @pindex calc-option
12282 The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12283 @dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12284 various ways.
12285
12286 The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12287 Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12288 are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12289 you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12290 prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12291 same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12292 to subtract and keep arguments).
12293
12294 Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12295 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12296
12297 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12298 @section Calculation Modes
12299
12300 @noindent
12301 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12302 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12303 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12304 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12305
12306 @menu
12307 * Angular Modes::
12308 * Polar Mode::
12309 * Fraction Mode::
12310 * Infinite Mode::
12311 * Symbolic Mode::
12312 * Matrix Mode::
12313 * Automatic Recomputation::
12314 * Working Message::
12315 @end menu
12316
12317 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12318 @subsection Angular Modes
12319
12320 @noindent
12321 @cindex Angular mode
12322 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12323 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12324 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12325 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12326 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12327 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12328
12329 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12330 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12331 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12332 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12333 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12334 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12335 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12336
12337 @kindex m r
12338 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12339 @kindex m d
12340 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12341 @kindex m h
12342 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12343 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12344 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12345 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12346 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12347
12348 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12349 @subsection Polar Mode
12350
12351 @noindent
12352 @cindex Polar mode
12353 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12354 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12355 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12356 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12357 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12358
12359 @kindex m p
12360 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12361 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12362 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12363 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12364
12365 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12366 @subsection Fraction Mode
12367
12368 @noindent
12369 @cindex Fraction mode
12370 @cindex Division of integers
12371 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12372 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12373 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12374 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12375 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12376 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12377 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12378
12379 @kindex m f
12380 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12381 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12382 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12383 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12384 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12385 Float mode.
12386
12387 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12388 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12389 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12390
12391 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12392 @subsection Infinite Mode
12393
12394 @noindent
12395 @cindex Infinite mode
12396 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12397 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12398 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12399 results.
12400
12401 @kindex m i
12402 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12403 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12404 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12405 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12406 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12407 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12408 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12409
12410 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12411 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12412 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12413 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12414 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12415 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12416 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12417 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12418
12419 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12420 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12421 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12422 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12423 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12424 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12425 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12426 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12427 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12428 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12429 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12430
12431 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12432 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12433
12434 @noindent
12435 @cindex Symbolic mode
12436 @cindex Inexact results
12437 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12438 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12439 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12440 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12441 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12442
12443 @kindex m s
12444 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12445 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12446 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12447 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12448 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12449
12450 @kindex N
12451 @pindex calc-eval-num
12452 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12453 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12454 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12455 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12456 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12457 of the command.
12458
12459 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12460 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12461 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12462 variables.)
12463
12464 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12465 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12466
12467 @noindent
12468 @cindex Matrix mode
12469 @cindex Scalar mode
12470 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12471 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12472 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12473 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12474
12475 @kindex m v
12476 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12477 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12478 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12479 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12480 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12481 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12482 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12483 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12484 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12485 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12486 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12487 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12488 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12489 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12490 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12491 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12492 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12493 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12494 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12495
12496 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12497 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12498 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12499 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12500 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12501 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12502 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12503
12504 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12505
12506 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12507 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12508 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12509 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12510 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12511 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12512 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12513
12514 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12515 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12516 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12517 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12518 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12519 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12520
12521 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12522 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12523 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12524 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12525 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12526 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12527 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12528
12529 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12530 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12531 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12532 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12533 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12534 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12535
12536 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12537 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12538
12539 @noindent
12540 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12541 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12542 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12543 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12544
12545 @kindex m C
12546 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12547 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12548 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12549 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12550 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12551 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12552 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12553 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12554 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12555
12556 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12557 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12558 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12559
12560 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12561 @subsection Working Messages
12562
12563 @noindent
12564 @cindex Performance
12565 @cindex Working messages
12566 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12567 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12568 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12569 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12570 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12571 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12572 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12573
12574 @kindex m w
12575 @pindex calc-working
12576 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12577 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12578 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12579 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12580 the current mode.
12581
12582 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12583 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12584 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12585 to turn the messages off.
12586
12587 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12588 @section Simplification Modes
12589
12590 @noindent
12591 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12592 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12593 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12594 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12595 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12596 are done automatically but can be turned off when necessary.
12597
12598 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12599 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12600 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12601 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12602
12603 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12604 followed by a shifted letter.
12605
12606 @kindex m O
12607 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12608 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12609 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12610 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12611 in this mode. Explicit simplification commands, such as @kbd{=} or
12612 @kbd{a s}, can still be given to simplify any formulas.
12613 @xref{Algebraic Definitions}, for a sample use of
12614 No-Simplification mode.
12615
12616
12617 @kindex m N
12618 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12619 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12620 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12621 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12622 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12623 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12624 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12625 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12626 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12627 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12628 elements are constant.
12629
12630 @kindex m I
12631 @pindex calc-basic-simplify-mode
12632 The @kbd{m I} (@code{calc-basic-simplify-mode}) command does some basic
12633 simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12634 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12635 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12636 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12637
12638 @kindex m B
12639 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12640 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the basic
12641 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12642 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12643 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12644 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12645 results (after the basic simplifications) are left alone.
12646
12647 @kindex m A
12648 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12649 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does standard
12650 algebraic simplifications. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12651
12652 @kindex m E
12653 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12654 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended'', or
12655 ``unsafe'', algebraic simplification. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12656
12657 @kindex m U
12658 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12659 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12660 simplification. @xref{Simplification of Units}. These include the
12661 algebraic simplifications, plus variable names which
12662 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12663 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12664
12665 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12666 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12667 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12668 perform higher types of simplifications on demand.
12669 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12670 @section Declarations
12671
12672 @noindent
12673 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12674 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12675 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12676 take the fully general situation into account.
12677
12678 @menu
12679 * Declaration Basics::
12680 * Kinds of Declarations::
12681 * Functions for Declarations::
12682 @end menu
12683
12684 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12685 @subsection Declaration Basics
12686
12687 @noindent
12688 @kindex s d
12689 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12690 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12691 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12692 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12693 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12694 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12695 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12696 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12697
12698 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12699 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12700 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12701 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12702 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12703 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12704 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12705 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12706
12707 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12708 @vindex Decls
12709 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12710 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12711 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12712 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12713 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12714 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12715 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12716 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12717 permanently if you wish.
12718
12719 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12720 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12721 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12722 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12723 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12724
12725 For example, the declaration matrix
12726
12727 @smallexample
12728 @group
12729 [ [ foo, real ]
12730 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12731 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12732 @end group
12733 @end smallexample
12734
12735 @noindent
12736 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12737 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12738 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12739
12740 @vindex All
12741 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12742 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12743 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12744 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12745 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12746 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12747 response to the variable-name prompt.
12748
12749 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12750 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12751
12752 @noindent
12753 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12754 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12755 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12756 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12757 for the variable.
12758
12759 @smallexample
12760 @group
12761 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12762 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12763 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12764 @end group
12765 @end smallexample
12766
12767 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12768 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12769 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12770 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12771 nearly equivalent (see below).
12772
12773 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12774 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12775 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12776 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12777
12778 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12779 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12780 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12781 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12782 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12783 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12784
12785 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12786 stored in a variable:
12787
12788 @table @code
12789 @item int
12790 Integers.
12791 @item numint
12792 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12793 @item frac
12794 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12795 @item rat
12796 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12797 @item float
12798 Floating-point numbers.
12799 @item real
12800 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12801 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12802 reals here.)
12803 @item pos
12804 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12805 @item nonneg
12806 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12807 @item number
12808 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12809 @end table
12810
12811 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12812 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12813 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12814 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12815 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12816 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12817 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12818 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12819 of the formula.
12820
12821 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12822 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12823 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12824 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12825 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12826 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12827
12828 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12829 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12830 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12831 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12832 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12833
12834 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12835 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12836 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12837 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12838 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12839 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12840
12841 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12842 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12843 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12844 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12845 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12846 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12847 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12848 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12849 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12850 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12851
12852 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12853 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12854
12855 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12856 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12857 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12858 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12859 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12860 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12861 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12862
12863 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12864 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12865 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12866 type symbol.
12867
12868 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12869 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12870 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12871 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12872 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12873
12874 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12875 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12876 shown above).
12877
12878 Calc's algebraic simplifications also make use of declarations when
12879 simplifying equations and inequalities. They will cancel @code{x}
12880 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12881 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12882 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12883 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12884 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12885 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12886 including canceling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12887 not known to be nonzero.
12888
12889 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12890
12891 @table @code
12892 @item scalar
12893 The value is not a vector.
12894 @item vector
12895 The value is a vector.
12896 @item matrix
12897 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12898 @item sqmatrix
12899 The value is a square matrix.
12900 @end table
12901
12902 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12903 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12904 is a matrix of integers.
12905
12906 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12907 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12908 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12909 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12910 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12911 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12912 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12913 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12914 declarations.)
12915
12916 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12917 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12918 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12919
12920 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12921 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12922
12923 @table @code
12924 @item const
12925 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12926 @end table
12927
12928 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12929 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12930 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12931 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12932 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12933 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12934 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12935 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12936 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12937 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12938
12939 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12940 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12941
12942 @noindent
12943 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12944 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12945 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12946 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12947 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12948 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12949 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12950 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12951 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12952
12953 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12954 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12955 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12956 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12957 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12958
12959 @ignore
12960 @starindex
12961 @end ignore
12962 @tindex dint
12963 @ignore
12964 @starindex
12965 @end ignore
12966 @tindex dnumint
12967 @ignore
12968 @starindex
12969 @end ignore
12970 @tindex dnatnum
12971 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12972 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12973 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12974 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12975 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12976 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12977 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12978 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12979
12980 @ignore
12981 @starindex
12982 @end ignore
12983 @tindex drat
12984 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12985 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12986 and error forms do not.
12987
12988 @ignore
12989 @starindex
12990 @end ignore
12991 @tindex dreal
12992 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12993 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12994
12995 @ignore
12996 @starindex
12997 @end ignore
12998 @tindex dimag
12999 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
13000 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
13001
13002 @ignore
13003 @starindex
13004 @end ignore
13005 @tindex dpos
13006 @ignore
13007 @starindex
13008 @end ignore
13009 @tindex dneg
13010 @ignore
13011 @starindex
13012 @end ignore
13013 @tindex dnonneg
13014 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13015 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13016 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13017 equal to zero. Note that Calc's algebraic simplifications, which are
13018 effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules, can simplify
13019 an expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}.
13020 So the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13021 are rarely necessary.
13022
13023 @ignore
13024 @starindex
13025 @end ignore
13026 @tindex dnonzero
13027 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13028 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13029 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13030 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13031 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13032 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13033 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13034
13035 @ignore
13036 @starindex
13037 @end ignore
13038 @tindex deven
13039 @ignore
13040 @starindex
13041 @end ignore
13042 @tindex dodd
13043 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13044 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13045 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13046 Calc's algebraic simplifications use this to simplify a test of the form
13047 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13048
13049 @ignore
13050 @starindex
13051 @end ignore
13052 @tindex drange
13053 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13054 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13055 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13056 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13057 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13058 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13059 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13060 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13061 remains unevaluated.
13062
13063 @ignore
13064 @starindex
13065 @end ignore
13066 @tindex dscalar
13067 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13068 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13069 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13070 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13071 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13072 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13073 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13074 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13075 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13076 information to tell.
13077
13078 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13079 @section Display Modes
13080
13081 @noindent
13082 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13083 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13084 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13085 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13086 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13087 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13088
13089 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13090 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13091 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13092 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13093 reflect the latest mode settings.
13094
13095 @kindex d @key{RET}
13096 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13097 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13098 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13099 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13100 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13101 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13102 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13103 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13104
13105 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13106 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13107 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13108 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13109
13110 @menu
13111 * Radix Modes::
13112 * Grouping Digits::
13113 * Float Formats::
13114 * Complex Formats::
13115 * Fraction Formats::
13116 * HMS Formats::
13117 * Date Formats::
13118 * Truncating the Stack::
13119 * Justification::
13120 * Labels::
13121 @end menu
13122
13123 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13124 @subsection Radix Modes
13125
13126 @noindent
13127 @cindex Radix display
13128 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13129 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13130 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13131 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13132 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13133 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13134 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13135
13136 @kindex d 2
13137 @kindex d 8
13138 @kindex d 6
13139 @kindex d 0
13140 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13141 @cindex Octal integers
13142 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13143 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13144 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13145 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13146 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13147 as decimal.
13148
13149 @kindex d r
13150 @pindex calc-radix
13151 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13152 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13153 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13154
13155 @kindex d z
13156 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13157 @cindex Leading zeros
13158 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13159 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13160 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13161 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13162 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13163 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13164 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13165 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13166 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13167 entirety.)
13168
13169 @cindex Two's complements
13170 Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13171 notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13172 hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13173 @kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13174 size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13175 complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13176 from
13177 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13178 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13179 to
13180 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13181 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13182 are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
13183 the integers from @expr{0} to
13184 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13185 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13186 are represented by themselves and the integers from
13187 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13188 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13189 to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
13190 @texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13191 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
13192 to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13193 Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13194 @expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13195 representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13196 @expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13197 are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13198 integers from
13199 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13200 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13201 to
13202 @c (
13203 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13204 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
13205 will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13206 radix).
13207
13208 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13209 @subsection Grouping Digits
13210
13211 @noindent
13212 @kindex d g
13213 @pindex calc-group-digits
13214 @cindex Grouping digits
13215 @cindex Digit grouping
13216 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13217 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13218 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13219 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13220 separated by commas.
13221
13222 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13223 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13224 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13225 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13226 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13227 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13228 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13229
13230 @kindex d ,
13231 @pindex calc-group-char
13232 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13233 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13234 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13235 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13236 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13237 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13238 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13239
13240 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13241 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13242 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13243 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13244 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13245
13246 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13247 @subsection Float Formats
13248
13249 @noindent
13250 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13251 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13252 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13253 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13254 formats for floats.
13255
13256 @kindex d n
13257 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13258 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13259 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13260 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13261 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13262 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13263 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13264 current precision is 12.)
13265
13266 @kindex d f
13267 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13268 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13269 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13270 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13271 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13272 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13273 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13274 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13275
13276 @kindex d s
13277 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13278 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13279 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13280 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13281 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13282 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13283 The default is to display all significant digits.
13284
13285 @kindex d e
13286 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13287 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13288 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13289 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13290 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13291 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13292 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13293
13294 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13295 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13296 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13297 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13298 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13299 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13300 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13301 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13302 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13303
13304 @kindex d .
13305 @pindex calc-point-char
13306 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13307 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13308 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13309 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13310 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13311
13312 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13313 @subsection Complex Formats
13314
13315 @noindent
13316 @kindex d c
13317 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13318 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13319 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13320 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13321 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13322
13323 @kindex d i
13324 @pindex calc-i-notation
13325 @kindex d j
13326 @pindex calc-j-notation
13327 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13328 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13329 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13330 in some disciplines.
13331
13332 @cindex @code{i} variable
13333 @vindex i
13334 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13335 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13336 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13337 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13338 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13339 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13340 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13341 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13342
13343 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13344 @subsection Fraction Formats
13345
13346 @noindent
13347 @kindex d o
13348 @pindex calc-over-notation
13349 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13350 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13351 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13352 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13353 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13354 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13355 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13356 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13357
13358 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13359 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13360 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13361 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13362 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13363
13364 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13365 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13366 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13367 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13368 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13369 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13370 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13371 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13372 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13373 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13374 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13375
13376 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13377 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13378 never affects floats.
13379
13380 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13381 @subsection HMS Formats
13382
13383 @noindent
13384 @kindex d h
13385 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13386 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13387 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13388 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13389 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13390 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13391 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13392 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13393
13394 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13395 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13396 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13397 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13398 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13399 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13400 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13401 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13402 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13403 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13404 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13405 entry.
13406
13407 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13408 @subsection Date Formats
13409
13410 @noindent
13411 @kindex d d
13412 @pindex calc-date-notation
13413 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13414 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13415 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13416 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13417 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13418 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13419 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13420 pure dates.
13421
13422 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13423 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13424 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13425 reestablished.
13426
13427 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13428 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13429 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13430
13431 @menu
13432 * ISO 8601::
13433 * Date Formatting Codes::
13434 * Free-Form Dates::
13435 * Standard Date Formats::
13436 @end menu
13437
13438 @node ISO 8601, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats, Date Formats
13439 @subsubsection ISO 8601
13440
13441 @noindent
13442 @cindex ISO 8601
13443 The same date can be written down in different formats and Calc tries
13444 to allow you to choose your preferred format. Some common formats are
13445 ambiguous, however; for example, 10/11/2012 means October 11,
13446 2012 in the United States but it means November 10, 2012 in
13447 Europe. To help avoid such ambiguities, the International Organization
13448 for Standardization (ISO) provides the ISO 8601 standard, which
13449 provides three different but easily distinguishable and unambiguous
13450 ways to represent a date.
13451
13452 The ISO 8601 calendar date representation is
13453
13454 @example
13455 @var{YYYY}-@var{MM}-@var{DD}
13456 @end example
13457
13458 @noindent
13459 where @var{YYYY} is the four digit year, @var{MM} is the two-digit month
13460 number (01 for January to 12 for December), and @var{DD} is the
13461 two-digit day of the month (01 to 31). (Note that @var{YYYY} does not
13462 correspond to Calc's date formatting code, which will be introduced
13463 later.) The year, which should be padded with zeros to ensure it has at
13464 least four digits, is the Gregorian year, except that the year before
13465 0001 (1 AD) is the year 0000 (1 BC). The date October 11, 2012 is
13466 written 2012-10-11 in this representation and November 10, 2012 is
13467 written 2012-11-10.
13468
13469 The ISO 8601 ordinal date representation is
13470
13471 @example
13472 @var{YYYY}-@var{DDD}
13473 @end example
13474
13475 @noindent
13476 where @var{YYYY} is the year, as above, and @var{DDD} is the day of the year.
13477 The date December 31, 2011 is written 2011-365 in this representation
13478 and January 1, 2012 is written 2012-001.
13479
13480 The ISO 8601 week date representation is
13481
13482 @example
13483 @var{YYYY}-W@var{ww}-@var{D}
13484 @end example
13485
13486 @noindent
13487 where @var{YYYY} is the ISO week-numbering year, @var{ww} is the two
13488 digit week number (preceded by a literal ``W''), and @var{D} is the day
13489 of the week (1 for Monday through 7 for Sunday). The ISO week-numbering
13490 year is based on the Gregorian year but can differ slightly. The first
13491 week of an ISO week-numbering year is the week with the Gregorian year's
13492 first Thursday in it (equivalently, the week containing January 4);
13493 any day of that week (Monday through Sunday) is part of the same ISO
13494 week-numbering year, any day from the previous week is part of the
13495 previous year. For example, January 4, 2013 is on a Friday, and so
13496 the first week for the ISO week-numbering year 2013 starts on
13497 Monday, December 31, 2012. The day December 31, 2012 is then part of the
13498 Gregorian year 2012 but ISO week-numbering year 2013. In the week
13499 date representation, this week goes from 2013-W01-1 (December 31,
13500 2012) to 2013-W01-7 (January 6, 2013).
13501
13502 All three ISO 8601 representations arrange the numbers from most
13503 significant to least significant; as well as being unambiguous
13504 representations, they are easy to sort since chronological order in
13505 this formats corresponds to lexicographical order. The hyphens are
13506 sometimes omitted.
13507
13508 The ISO 8601 standard uses a 24 hour clock; a particular time is
13509 represented by @var{hh}:@var{mm}:@var{ss} where @var{hh} is the
13510 two-digit hour (from 00 to 24), @var{mm} is the two-digit minute (from
13511 00 to 59) and @var{ss} is the two-digit second. The seconds or minutes
13512 and seconds can be omitted, and decimals can be added. If a date with a
13513 time is represented, they should be separated by a literal ``T'', so noon
13514 on December 13, 2012 can be represented as 2012-12-13T12:00.
13515
13516 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, ISO 8601, Date Formats
13517 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13518
13519 @noindent
13520 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13521 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13522 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13523 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13524 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13525 below.
13526
13527 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13528 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13529 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13530 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13531 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13532 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13533 since Dec 31, 1 BC@. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13534 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13535
13536 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13537
13538 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13539 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13540 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13541 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13542 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13543
13544 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13545
13546 @table @asis
13547 @item Y
13548 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13549 @item YY
13550 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13551 @item BY
13552 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13553 @item YYY
13554 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13555 @item YYYY
13556 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13557 @item ZYYY
13558 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``0023'' for 23 AD, ``0000'' for 1 BC.
13559 @item IYYY
13560 Year: ISO 8601 week-numbering year.
13561 @item aa
13562 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13563 @item AA
13564 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13565 @item aaa
13566 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13567 @item AAA
13568 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13569 @item aaaa
13570 Year: ``a.d.@:'' or blank.
13571 @item AAAA
13572 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13573 @item bb
13574 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13575 @item BB
13576 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13577 @item bbb
13578 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13579 @item BBB
13580 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13581 @item bbbb
13582 Year: ``b.c.@:'' or blank.
13583 @item BBBB
13584 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13585 @item M
13586 Month: ``8'' for August.
13587 @item MM
13588 Month: ``08'' for August.
13589 @item BM
13590 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13591 @item MMM
13592 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13593 @item Mmm
13594 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13595 @item mmm
13596 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13597 @item MMMM
13598 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13599 @item Mmmm
13600 Month: ``August'' for August.
13601 @item D
13602 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13603 @item DD
13604 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13605 @item BD
13606 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13607 @item W
13608 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13609 @item w
13610 Weekday: ``1'' for Monday, ``7'' for Sunday.
13611 @item WWW
13612 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13613 @item Www
13614 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13615 @item www
13616 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13617 @item WWWW
13618 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13619 @item Wwww
13620 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13621 @item Iww
13622 Week number: ISO 8601 week number, ``W01'' for week 1.
13623 @item d
13624 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13625 @item ddd
13626 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13627 @item bdd
13628 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13629 @item T
13630 Letter: Literal ``T''.
13631 @item h
13632 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13633 @item hh
13634 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13635 @item bh
13636 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13637 @item H
13638 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13639 @item HH
13640 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13641 @item BH
13642 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13643 @item p
13644 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13645 @item P
13646 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13647 @item pp
13648 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13649 @item PP
13650 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13651 @item pppp
13652 AM/PM: ``a.m.@:'' or ``p.m.''.
13653 @item PPPP
13654 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13655 @item m
13656 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13657 @item mm
13658 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13659 @item bm
13660 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13661 @item s
13662 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13663 @item ss
13664 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13665 @item bs
13666 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13667 @item SS
13668 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13669 @item BS
13670 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13671 @item N
13672 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13673 @item n
13674 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13675 @item J
13676 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13677 @item j
13678 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13679 @item U
13680 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13681 @item X
13682 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13683 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13684 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13685 required for algebraic entry.
13686 @end table
13687
13688 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13689 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13690
13691 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13692 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13693 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13694 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13695 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13696
13697 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13698 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13699 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13700 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13701 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13702
13703 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13704 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13705 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13706
13707 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13708 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13709
13710 @noindent
13711 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13712 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13713 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13714 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13715 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13716
13717 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13718 while interpreting dates.
13719
13720 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13721 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13722 the date.
13723
13724 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13725 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13726 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13727 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13728 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13729 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13730 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13731 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13732 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13733 recognized with no number attached. Midnight will represent the
13734 beginning of a day.
13735
13736 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13737 format.
13738
13739 When reading the date portion, Calc first checks to see if it is an
13740 ISO 8601 week-numbering date; if the string contains an integer
13741 representing the year, a ``W'' followed by two digits for the week
13742 number, and an integer from 1 to 7 representing the weekday (in that
13743 order), then all other characters are ignored and this information
13744 determines the date. Otherwise, all words and numbers are isolated
13745 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must be
13746 either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which are
13747 ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13748 abbreviations.
13749
13750 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13751 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13752 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13753 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13754 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13755 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13756 current year is taken from the system clock.
13757
13758 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13759 words, then the input is rejected.
13760
13761 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13762 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13763 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13764 date components when the date was formatted.
13765
13766 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13767 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13768 minus sign on the year value.
13769
13770 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13771 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13772
13773 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13774 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13775
13776 @noindent
13777 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13778 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13779 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13780 to select the other formats.
13781
13782 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13783 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13784 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13785 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13786 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13787 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13788
13789 @table @asis
13790 @item 0
13791 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13792 @item 1
13793 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13794 @item 2
13795 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13796 @item 3
13797 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13798 @item 4
13799 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13800 @item 5
13801 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13802 @item 6
13803 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13804 @item 7
13805 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13806 @item 8
13807 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13808 @item 9
13809 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13810 @item 10
13811 @samp{ZYYY-MM-DD Www< hh:mm>} (Org mode format)
13812 @item 11
13813 @samp{IYYY-Iww-w<Thh:mm:ss>} (ISO 8601 week numbering format)
13814 @end table
13815
13816 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13817 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13818
13819 @noindent
13820 @kindex d t
13821 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13822 @cindex Truncating the stack
13823 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13824 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13825 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13826 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13827 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13828 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13829 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13830 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13831 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13832 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13833 the stack.
13834
13835 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13836 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13837 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13838 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13839 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13840 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13841 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13842
13843 @kindex d [
13844 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13845 @kindex d ]
13846 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13847 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13848 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13849 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13850
13851 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13852 @subsection Justification
13853
13854 @noindent
13855 @kindex d <
13856 @pindex calc-left-justify
13857 @kindex d =
13858 @pindex calc-center-justify
13859 @kindex d >
13860 @pindex calc-right-justify
13861 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13862 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13863 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13864 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13865 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13866 window.
13867
13868 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13869 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13870 text.
13871
13872 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13873 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13874 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13875
13876 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13877 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13878 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13879 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13880 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13881 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13882 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13883 mode.
13884
13885 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13886 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13887 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13888 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13889 line is indented to the origin.
13890
13891 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13892 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13893 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13894 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13895 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13896 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13897
13898 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13899 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13900 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13901 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13902 line width or Calc window width is used.
13903
13904 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13905 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13906 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13907 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13908 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13909 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13910 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13911
13912 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13913 @subsection Labels
13914
13915 @noindent
13916 @kindex d @{
13917 @pindex calc-left-label
13918 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13919 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13920 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13921 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13922 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13923 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13924 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13925
13926 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13927
13928 @kindex d @}
13929 @pindex calc-right-label
13930 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13931 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13932 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13933 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13934 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13935 justified to the line width.
13936
13937 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13938 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13939 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13940 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13941 left or right as you prefer.
13942
13943 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13944 @section Language Modes
13945
13946 @noindent
13947 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13948 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13949 other common language such as Pascal or @LaTeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13950 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13951 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13952 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13953
13954 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13955 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13956 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13957 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13958
13959 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13960 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13961 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13962 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13963 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13964 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13965 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13966 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13967
13968 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13969 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13970 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13971 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13972 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13973
13974 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @LaTeX{}
13975 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13976 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @LaTeX{} mode, and yank the
13977 formula into the document in @LaTeX{} math-mode format.
13978
13979 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13980 shifted letter key.
13981
13982 @menu
13983 * Normal Language Modes::
13984 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13985 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13986 * Eqn Language Mode::
13987 * Yacas Language Mode::
13988 * Maxima Language Mode::
13989 * Giac Language Mode::
13990 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13991 * Maple Language Mode::
13992 * Compositions::
13993 * Syntax Tables::
13994 @end menu
13995
13996 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13997 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13998
13999 @noindent
14000 @kindex d N
14001 @pindex calc-normal-language
14002 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
14003 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
14004 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
14005 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
14006 keyboard.
14007
14008 @kindex d O
14009 @pindex calc-flat-language
14010 @cindex Matrix display
14011 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
14012 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
14013 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
14014 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
14015
14016 @kindex d b
14017 @pindex calc-line-breaking
14018 @cindex Line breaking
14019 @cindex Breaking up long lines
14020 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
14021 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
14022 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
14023 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
14024 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
14025 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
14026 long lines.
14027
14028 @kindex d B
14029 @pindex calc-big-language
14030 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
14031 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
14032 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
14033
14034 @example
14035 ____________
14036 | a + 1 2
14037 | ----- + c
14038 \| b
14039 @end example
14040
14041 @noindent
14042 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
14043
14044 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
14045 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
14046 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
14047 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
14048 notation.
14049
14050 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
14051
14052 @example
14053 3
14054 - -
14055 4
14056 @end example
14057
14058 @noindent
14059 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
14060 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
14061 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
14062 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
14063 typical use.
14064
14065 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
14066 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
14067 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
14068 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
14069 in Big mode.
14070
14071 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
14072 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
14073 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
14074 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
14075 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
14076
14077 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
14078 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
14079 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
14080 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
14081
14082 @kindex d U
14083 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
14084 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
14085 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
14086 shown above would be displayed:
14087
14088 @example
14089 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
14090 @end example
14091
14092 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
14093 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
14094 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
14095 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
14096 parentheses).
14097
14098 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
14099 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
14100
14101 @noindent
14102 @kindex d C
14103 @pindex calc-c-language
14104 @cindex C language
14105 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14106 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14107 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14108 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14109 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14110 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14111 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14112
14113 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14114 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14115 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14116 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14117 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14118 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14119 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14120
14121 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14122 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14123 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14124 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14125 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14126 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14127 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14128 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14129
14130 @kindex d P
14131 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14132 @cindex Pascal language
14133 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14134 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14135 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14136 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14137 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14138 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.)@: not followed by digits works the same as
14139 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14140 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14141 of handling these in Pascal.
14142
14143 @kindex d F
14144 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14145 @cindex FORTRAN language
14146 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14147 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14148 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14149 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14150 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14151 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14152 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14153 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14154 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14155 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14156 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14157 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14158 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14159 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14160 function!).
14161
14162 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14163 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14164 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14165
14166 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14167 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14168 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14169 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14170 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14171 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14172
14173 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14174 @subsection @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} Language Modes
14175
14176 @noindent
14177 @kindex d T
14178 @pindex calc-tex-language
14179 @cindex TeX language
14180 @kindex d L
14181 @pindex calc-latex-language
14182 @cindex LaTeX language
14183 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14184 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14185 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14186 conventions of ``math mode'' in @LaTeX{}, a typesetting language that
14187 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's @LaTeX{} language mode can
14188 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although @LaTeX{}
14189 mode may display it differently.
14190
14191 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14192 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14193 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14194 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14195 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in @LaTeX{} mode.
14196 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14197 @LaTeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14198 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14199 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14200
14201 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14202 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14203 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in
14204 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14205 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14206 @code{\binom} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14207 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14208 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14209 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14210 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14211 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14212 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14213 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14214
14215 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14216 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14217 and @LaTeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14218 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14219 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14220 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14221 printed result is
14222 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14223 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14224 but
14225 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14226 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14227
14228 The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14229 the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14230 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14231
14232 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14233 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14234 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14235 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14236 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14237 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14238 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14239 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in @LaTeX{} mode. The
14240 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14241 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14242 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14243 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14244 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14245 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14246 any @TeX{} mode.)
14247
14248 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14249 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14250 @code{\bmatrix}. In @LaTeX{} mode this also applies to
14251 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14252 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14253 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14254 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14255 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14256 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14257 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14258 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14259 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14260 @LaTeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14261 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14262 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14263 form, such as
14264
14265 @example
14266 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14267 a & b \\
14268 c & d
14269 \end@{pmatrix@}
14270 @end example
14271
14272 @noindent
14273 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14274 expressions being displayed like
14275
14276 @example
14277 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14278 a & b \\
14279 c & d
14280 \end@{pmatrix@}
14281 @end example
14282
14283 @noindent
14284 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect @LaTeX{}.
14285 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14286
14287 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14288 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14289 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14290 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14291 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14292 in Calc, @TeX{}, @LaTeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14293
14294 @ignore
14295 @iftex
14296 @begingroup
14297 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14298 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14299 @end iftex
14300 @starindex
14301 @end ignore
14302 @tindex acute
14303 @ignore
14304 @starindex
14305 @end ignore
14306 @tindex Acute
14307 @ignore
14308 @starindex
14309 @end ignore
14310 @tindex bar
14311 @ignore
14312 @starindex
14313 @end ignore
14314 @tindex Bar
14315 @ignore
14316 @starindex
14317 @end ignore
14318 @tindex breve
14319 @ignore
14320 @starindex
14321 @end ignore
14322 @tindex Breve
14323 @ignore
14324 @starindex
14325 @end ignore
14326 @tindex check
14327 @ignore
14328 @starindex
14329 @end ignore
14330 @tindex Check
14331 @ignore
14332 @starindex
14333 @end ignore
14334 @tindex dddot
14335 @ignore
14336 @starindex
14337 @end ignore
14338 @tindex ddddot
14339 @ignore
14340 @starindex
14341 @end ignore
14342 @tindex dot
14343 @ignore
14344 @starindex
14345 @end ignore
14346 @tindex Dot
14347 @ignore
14348 @starindex
14349 @end ignore
14350 @tindex dotdot
14351 @ignore
14352 @starindex
14353 @end ignore
14354 @tindex DotDot
14355 @ignore
14356 @starindex
14357 @end ignore
14358 @tindex dyad
14359 @ignore
14360 @starindex
14361 @end ignore
14362 @tindex grave
14363 @ignore
14364 @starindex
14365 @end ignore
14366 @tindex Grave
14367 @ignore
14368 @starindex
14369 @end ignore
14370 @tindex hat
14371 @ignore
14372 @starindex
14373 @end ignore
14374 @tindex Hat
14375 @ignore
14376 @starindex
14377 @end ignore
14378 @tindex Prime
14379 @ignore
14380 @starindex
14381 @end ignore
14382 @tindex tilde
14383 @ignore
14384 @starindex
14385 @end ignore
14386 @tindex Tilde
14387 @ignore
14388 @starindex
14389 @end ignore
14390 @tindex under
14391 @ignore
14392 @starindex
14393 @end ignore
14394 @tindex Vec
14395 @ignore
14396 @starindex
14397 @end ignore
14398 @tindex VEC
14399 @ignore
14400 @iftex
14401 @endgroup
14402 @end iftex
14403 @end ignore
14404 @example
14405 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14406 ---- --- ----- ---
14407 acute \acute \acute
14408 Acute \Acute
14409 bar \bar \bar bar
14410 Bar \Bar
14411 breve \breve \breve
14412 Breve \Breve
14413 check \check \check
14414 Check \Check
14415 dddot \dddot
14416 ddddot \ddddot
14417 dot \dot \dot dot
14418 Dot \Dot
14419 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14420 DotDot \Ddot
14421 dyad dyad
14422 grave \grave \grave
14423 Grave \Grave
14424 hat \hat \hat hat
14425 Hat \Hat
14426 Prime prime
14427 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14428 Tilde \Tilde
14429 under \underline \underline under
14430 Vec \vec \vec vec
14431 VEC \Vec
14432 @end example
14433
14434 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14435 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14436 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14437 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14438 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14439 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14440 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14441 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14442
14443 @example
14444 \def\evalto@{@}
14445 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14446 @end example
14447
14448 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14449 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14450 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14451 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14452 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14453 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14454
14455 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14456 reading is:
14457
14458 @example
14459 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14460 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14461 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14462 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14463 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14464 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14465 \evalto
14466 @end example
14467
14468 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14469 @LaTeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14470 font information.
14471
14472 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14473 the same as @samp{*}.
14474
14475 @ifnottex
14476 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14477 end of this section.
14478 @end ifnottex
14479 @iftex
14480 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14481
14482 @example
14483 @group
14484 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14485 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14486 @end group
14487 @end example
14488 @tex
14489 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14490 @end tex
14491 @sp 1
14492
14493 @example
14494 @group
14495 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14496 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14497 @end group
14498 @end example
14499 @tex
14500 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14501 @end tex
14502 @sp 1
14503
14504 @example
14505 @group
14506 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14507 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14508 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14509 @end group
14510 @end example
14511 @tex
14512 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14513 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14514 @end tex
14515 @sp 1
14516
14517 @example
14518 @group
14519 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14520 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14521 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14522 @end group
14523 @end example
14524 @tex
14525 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14526 @end tex
14527 @sp 2
14528
14529 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14530 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14531 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14532
14533 @example
14534 @group
14535 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14536 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14537 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14538 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14539 @end group
14540 @end example
14541 @tex
14542 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14543 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14544 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14545 @end tex
14546 @sp 2
14547
14548 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14549
14550 @example
14551 @group
14552 2 + 3 => 5
14553 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14554 @end group
14555 @end example
14556 @tex
14557 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14558 $$ 5 $$
14559 @end tex
14560 @sp 2
14561
14562 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14563
14564 @example
14565 @group
14566 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14567 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14568 @end group
14569 @end example
14570 @tex
14571 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14572 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14573 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14574 @end tex
14575 @sp 2
14576
14577 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14578
14579 @example
14580 @group
14581 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14582 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14583 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14584 @end group
14585 @end example
14586 @tex
14587 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14588 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14589 @end tex
14590 @sp 2
14591 @end iftex
14592
14593 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14594 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14595
14596 @noindent
14597 @kindex d E
14598 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14599 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14600 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14601 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14602 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14603
14604 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14605 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14606 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14607 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14608 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14609 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14610
14611 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14612 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14613 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14614 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14615 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14616 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14617 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14618
14619 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14620 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14621 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14622 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14623 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14624 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14625 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14626 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14627 names, too.)
14628
14629 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14630 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14631 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14632 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14633 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14634
14635 As in @LaTeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14636 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14637 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14638 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14639
14640 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14641 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14642 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14643 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14644 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14645 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14646 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14647
14648 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14649 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14650 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14651 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14652 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14653 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14654 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14655 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14656
14657 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14658 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14659 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14660 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14661 recognized for these operators during reading.
14662
14663 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14664 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14665 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14666 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14667 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14668
14669 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14670 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14671
14672 @noindent
14673 @kindex d Y
14674 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14675 @cindex Yacas language
14676 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14677 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14678 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14679 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14680 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14681 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14682 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14683 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14684 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14685 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14686 represents @code{nan}.
14687
14688 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14689 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14690 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14691 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14692
14693 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14694 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14695 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14696 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14697
14698
14699 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14700 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14701
14702 @noindent
14703 @kindex d X
14704 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14705 @cindex Maxima language
14706 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14707 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14708 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14709 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14710 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14711 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14712 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14713 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14714
14715 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14716 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14717 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14718 @samp{o'o}.
14719
14720 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14721 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14722 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14723
14724 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14725 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14726
14727 @noindent
14728 @kindex d A
14729 @pindex calc-giac-language
14730 @cindex Giac language
14731 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14732 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14733 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14734 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14735 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14736 and @code{uinf}.
14737
14738 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14739 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14740 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14741 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14742 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14743
14744 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14745 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14746 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14747 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14748
14749 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14750 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14751
14752 @noindent
14753 @kindex d M
14754 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14755 @cindex Mathematica language
14756 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14757 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14758 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14759 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14760 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14761 Mathematica mode.
14762
14763 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14764 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14765 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14766 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14767 Mathematica mode.
14768 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14769 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14770 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14771
14772 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14773 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14774
14775 @noindent
14776 @kindex d W
14777 @pindex calc-maple-language
14778 @cindex Maple language
14779 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14780 conventions of Maple.
14781
14782 Maple's language is much like C@. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14783 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14784 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14785 denote powers.
14786
14787 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14788 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14789 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14790 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14791 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14792 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14793
14794 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14795 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14796
14797 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14798 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14799 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14800 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14801
14802 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14803 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14804 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14805
14806 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14807 @subsection Compositions
14808
14809 @noindent
14810 @cindex Compositions
14811 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14812 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14813 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14814 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14815 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14816
14817 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14818 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14819 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14820 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14821 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14822 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14823 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14824 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14825
14826 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14827 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14828 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14829 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14830 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14831 the language modes.
14832
14833 @menu
14834 * Composition Basics::
14835 * Horizontal Compositions::
14836 * Vertical Compositions::
14837 * Other Compositions::
14838 * Information about Compositions::
14839 * User-Defined Compositions::
14840 @end menu
14841
14842 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14843 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14844
14845 @noindent
14846 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14847 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14848 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14849 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14850 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14851 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14852 For example, in the Big mode formula
14853
14854 @example
14855 @group
14856 2
14857 a + b
14858 17 + ------
14859 c
14860 @end group
14861 @end example
14862
14863 @noindent
14864 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14865 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14866 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14867
14868 @tex
14869 \bigskip
14870 @end tex
14871
14872 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14873 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14874 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14875 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14876 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14877
14878 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14879 following precedences:
14880
14881 @example
14882 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14883 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14884 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14885 mod 400
14886 +/- 300
14887 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14888 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14889 ^ 200
14890 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14891 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14892 / % \ 190
14893 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14894 | 170
14895 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14896 && 110
14897 || 100
14898 ? : 90
14899 !!! 85
14900 &&& 80
14901 ||| 75
14902 := 50
14903 :: 45
14904 => 40
14905 @end example
14906
14907 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14908 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14909 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14910 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14911 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14912 normally never get additional parentheses).
14913
14914 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14915 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14916 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14917 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14918 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14919 with one-higher precedence.
14920
14921 @ignore
14922 @starindex
14923 @end ignore
14924 @tindex cprec
14925 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14926 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14927 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14928 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14929 precedence than multiplication).
14930
14931 @tex
14932 \bigskip
14933 @end tex
14934
14935 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14936 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14937 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14938 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14939 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14940 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14941 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14942 view them.
14943
14944 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14945 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14946 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14947 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14948 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14949 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14950 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14951 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14952 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14953
14954 @example
14955 @group
14956 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14957 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14958 @end group
14959 @end example
14960
14961 @noindent
14962 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14963 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14964 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14965 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14966 itself been too large to fit.
14967
14968 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14969 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14970 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14971 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14972 end of the string.
14973
14974 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14975 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14976 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14977 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14978 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14979 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14980 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14981 object.
14982
14983 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14984 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14985
14986 @noindent
14987 @ignore
14988 @starindex
14989 @end ignore
14990 @tindex choriz
14991 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14992 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14993 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14994
14995 @example
14996 @group
14997 a b
14998 17---d
14999 c
15000 @end group
15001 @end example
15002
15003 @noindent
15004 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
15005 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
15006 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
15007 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
15008 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
15009 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
15010
15011 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
15012 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
15013 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
15014 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
15015 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
15016 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
15017
15018 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
15019 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
15020 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
15021 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
15022 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
15023
15024 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
15025 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
15026
15027 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
15028 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
15029
15030 @noindent
15031 @ignore
15032 @starindex
15033 @end ignore
15034 @tindex cvert
15035 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
15036 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
15037 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
15038 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
15039 formats in Big mode as
15040
15041 @example
15042 @group
15043 f( a , 2 )
15044 bb a + 1
15045 ccc 2
15046 b
15047 @end group
15048 @end example
15049
15050 @ignore
15051 @starindex
15052 @end ignore
15053 @tindex cbase
15054 There are several special composition functions that work only as
15055 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
15056 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
15057 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
15058 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
15059 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
15060
15061 @example
15062 @group
15063 2
15064 a + 1
15065 a 2
15066 f(bb , b )
15067 ccc
15068 @end group
15069 @end example
15070
15071 @ignore
15072 @starindex
15073 @end ignore
15074 @tindex ctbase
15075 @ignore
15076 @starindex
15077 @end ignore
15078 @tindex cbbase
15079 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
15080 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
15081 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
15082 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
15083 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
15084
15085 @example
15086 @group
15087 a
15088 a -
15089 - + a + b
15090 b -
15091 b
15092 @end group
15093 @end example
15094
15095 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
15096 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
15097 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
15098 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
15099 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
15100 item.
15101
15102 @ignore
15103 @starindex
15104 @end ignore
15105 @tindex crule
15106 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
15107 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
15108 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
15109 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
15110 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15111 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15112 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15113
15114 @example
15115 @group
15116 a + 1
15117 =====
15118 2
15119 b
15120 @end group
15121 @end example
15122
15123 @ignore
15124 @starindex
15125 @end ignore
15126 @tindex clvert
15127 @ignore
15128 @starindex
15129 @end ignore
15130 @tindex crvert
15131 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15132 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15133 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15134 gives:
15135
15136 @example
15137 @group
15138 a + a
15139 bb bb
15140 ccc ccc
15141 @end group
15142 @end example
15143
15144 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15145 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15146 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15147
15148 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15149 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15150
15151 @noindent
15152 @ignore
15153 @starindex
15154 @end ignore
15155 @tindex csup
15156 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15157 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15158 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15159 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15160 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15161
15162 @ignore
15163 @starindex
15164 @end ignore
15165 @tindex csub
15166 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15167 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15168 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15169 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15170 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15171
15172 @ignore
15173 @starindex
15174 @end ignore
15175 @tindex cflat
15176 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15177 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15178 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15179 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15180 to improve its readability.
15181
15182 @ignore
15183 @starindex
15184 @end ignore
15185 @tindex cspace
15186 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15187 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15188 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15189 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15190 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15191 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15192 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15193
15194 @example
15195 @group
15196 2 2 2 2
15197 a a a a
15198 @end group
15199 @end example
15200
15201 @noindent
15202 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15203
15204 @ignore
15205 @starindex
15206 @end ignore
15207 @tindex cvspace
15208 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15209 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15210 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15211 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15212 height if used in a vertical composition.
15213
15214 @ignore
15215 @starindex
15216 @end ignore
15217 @tindex ctspace
15218 @ignore
15219 @starindex
15220 @end ignore
15221 @tindex cbspace
15222 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15223 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15224 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15225 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15226 displays as:
15227
15228 @example
15229 @group
15230 a
15231 -
15232 a b
15233 - a a
15234 b + - + -
15235 a b b
15236 - a
15237 b -
15238 b
15239 @end group
15240 @end example
15241
15242 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15243 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15244
15245 @noindent
15246 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15247 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15248 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15249
15250 @ignore
15251 @starindex
15252 @end ignore
15253 @tindex cwidth
15254 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15255 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15256 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15257 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15258 the composition functions described in this section.
15259
15260 @ignore
15261 @starindex
15262 @end ignore
15263 @tindex cheight
15264 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15265 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15266
15267 @ignore
15268 @starindex
15269 @end ignore
15270 @tindex cascent
15271 @ignore
15272 @starindex
15273 @end ignore
15274 @tindex cdescent
15275 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15276 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15277 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15278 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15279 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15280 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15281 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15282 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15283
15284 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15285 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15286
15287 @noindent
15288 @kindex Z C
15289 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15290 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15291 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15292 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15293 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15294 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15295 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15296 replaced.
15297
15298 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15299 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15300 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15301 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15302 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15303 affect the display at all.
15304
15305 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15306 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15307 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15308 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15309 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15310 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15311 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15312 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15313 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15314 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15315
15316 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15317 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15318 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15319
15320 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15321 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15322
15323 @example
15324 @group
15325 n
15326 ( )
15327 m
15328 @end group
15329 @end example
15330
15331 @noindent
15332 You might prefer the notation,
15333
15334 @example
15335 @group
15336 C
15337 n m
15338 @end group
15339 @end example
15340
15341 @noindent
15342 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15343 then put the formula
15344
15345 @smallexample
15346 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15347 @end smallexample
15348
15349 @noindent
15350 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15351 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15352 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15353 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15354 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15355 as an algebraic entry.
15356
15357 @example
15358 @group
15359 C + C
15360 a b 7 3
15361 @end group
15362 @end example
15363
15364 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15365 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15366 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15367 instead of parentheses.
15368
15369 @smallexample
15370 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15371 @end smallexample
15372
15373 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15374 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15375
15376 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15377 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15378 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15379 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15380 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15381 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15382 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15383 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15384 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15385 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15386 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15387 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15388
15389 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15390 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15391 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15392 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15393 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15394 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15395 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15396 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15397 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15398 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15399 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15400 symbolic form.
15401
15402 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15403 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15404 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15405 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15406 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15407 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15408 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15409 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15410 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15411
15412 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15413 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15414
15415 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15416 @subsection Syntax Tables
15417
15418 @noindent
15419 @cindex Syntax tables
15420 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15421 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15422 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15423 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15424
15425 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15426 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15427
15428 @kindex Z S
15429 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15430 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15431 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15432 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15433 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15434 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15435 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15436 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15437
15438 @menu
15439 * Syntax Table Basics::
15440 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15441 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15442 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15443 @end menu
15444
15445 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15446 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15447
15448 @noindent
15449 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15450 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15451 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15452 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15453 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15454 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15455 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15456 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15457 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15458 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15459
15460 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15461 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15462 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15463 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15464 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15465 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15466 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15467 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15468 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15469 completely different.)
15470
15471 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15472 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15473 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15474
15475 @example
15476 foo ( ) := 2+3
15477 @end example
15478
15479 @noindent
15480 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15481 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15482 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15483 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15484 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15485 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15486 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15487 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15488 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15489 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15490 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15491 calls would no longer recognize it!
15492
15493 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15494 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15495 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15496
15497 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15498 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15499 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15500 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15501 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15502 and postfix operator, respectively:
15503
15504 @example
15505 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15506 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15507 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15508 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15509 @end example
15510
15511 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15512 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15513
15514 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15515 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15516 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15517 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15518 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15519 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15520 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15521 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15522 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15523 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15524 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15525 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15526
15527 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15528 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15529 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15530 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15531 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15532 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15533 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15534 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15535
15536 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15537 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15538 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15539 rule,
15540
15541 @example
15542 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15543 @end example
15544
15545 @noindent
15546 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15547 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15548 define these operators quite easily:
15549
15550 @example
15551 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15552 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15553 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15554 @end example
15555
15556 @noindent
15557 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15558 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15559 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15560 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15561
15562 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15563 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15564
15565 @example
15566 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15567 @end example
15568
15569 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15570 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15571 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15572 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15573 backslashes in tokens.)
15574
15575 @example
15576 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15577 @end example
15578
15579 @noindent
15580 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15581
15582 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15583 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15584 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15585 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15586 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15587 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15588 respectively).
15589
15590 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15591 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15592
15593 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15594 @subsubsection Precedence
15595
15596 @noindent
15597 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15598 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15599
15600 @example
15601 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15602 @end example
15603
15604 @noindent
15605 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15606 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15607 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15608 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15609 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15610 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15611
15612 @example
15613 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15614 @end example
15615
15616 @noindent
15617 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15618 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15619 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15620 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15621 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15622 can create a right-associative operator.
15623
15624 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15625 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15626 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15627
15628 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15629 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15630
15631 @noindent
15632 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15633 write
15634
15635 @example
15636 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15637 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15638 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15639 @end example
15640
15641 @noindent
15642 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15643 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15644 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15645
15646 @example
15647 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15648 @end example
15649
15650 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15651 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15652 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15653 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15654 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15655 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15656 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15657 several expressions separated by commas.
15658
15659 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15660 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15661 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15662 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15663 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15664 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15665
15666 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15667 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15668 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15669 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15670 always be an empty vector.
15671
15672 @example
15673 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15674 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15675 @end example
15676
15677 @noindent
15678 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15679 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15680 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15681 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15682 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15683
15684 @example
15685 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15686 @end example
15687
15688 @noindent
15689 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15690 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15691
15692 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15693 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15694 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15695
15696 @example
15697 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15698 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15699 @end example
15700
15701 @noindent
15702 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15703 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15704 empty vector is produced.
15705
15706 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15707 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15708 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15709 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15710 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15711 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15712 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15713 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15714 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15715 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15716 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15717 as optional.
15718
15719 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15720 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15721
15722 @example
15723 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15724 @end example
15725
15726 @noindent
15727 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15728 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15729 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15730 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15731 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15732 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15733 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15734
15735 @example
15736 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15737 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15738 @end example
15739
15740 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15741 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15742 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15743 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15744 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15745 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15746 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15747
15748 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15749 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15750
15751 @noindent
15752 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15753 example, the rules
15754
15755 @example
15756 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15757 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15758 @end example
15759
15760 @noindent
15761 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15762 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15763 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15764 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15765 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15766 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15767
15768 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15769 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15770 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15771 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15772 using the algebraic simplifications (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15773 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15774 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15775 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15776 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15777 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15778 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15779
15780 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15781 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15782 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15783 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15784 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15785 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15786
15787 @example
15788 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15789 @end example
15790
15791 @noindent
15792 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15793 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15794 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15795 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15796
15797 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15798 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15799 rules.
15800
15801 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15802 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15803 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15804 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15805 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15806 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15807
15808 @example
15809 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15810 @end example
15811
15812 @noindent
15813 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15814 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15815 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15816 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15817 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15818 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15819 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15820 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15821
15822 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15823 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15824
15825 @noindent
15826 @kindex m g
15827 @pindex calc-get-modes
15828 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15829 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15830 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15831 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15832 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15833 on the current mode settings.
15834
15835 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15836 @vindex Modes
15837 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15838 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15839 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15840 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15841 command will continue to work, however.)
15842
15843 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15844 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15845 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15846 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15847
15848 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15849
15850 @enumerate
15851 @item
15852 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15853
15854 @item
15855 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15856
15857 @item
15858 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15859 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15860
15861 @item
15862 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15863
15864 @item
15865 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15866 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15867 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15868 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15869 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15870 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15871 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15872 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15873 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15874 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15875
15876 @item
15877 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15878 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15879
15880 @item
15881 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15882
15883 @item
15884 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15885
15886 @item
15887 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15888 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15889
15890 @item
15891 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15892 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15893 or @var{N} for
15894 @texline @math{N\times N}
15895 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15896 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15897
15898 @item
15899 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15900 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15901 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15902
15903 @item
15904 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15905 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15906 @end enumerate
15907
15908 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15909 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15910 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15911 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15912 keyboard macro.)
15913
15914 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15915 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15916
15917 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15918 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15919 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15920 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15921 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15922 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15923
15924 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15925 @section The Calc Mode Line
15926
15927 @noindent
15928 @cindex Mode line indicators
15929 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15930 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15931 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15932
15933 The basic mode line format is:
15934
15935 @example
15936 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15937 @end example
15938
15939 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15940 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15941 as if it were text.
15942
15943 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15944 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15945 that are in effect.
15946
15947 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15948 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15949 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15950
15951 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15952 on the mode line:
15953
15954 @table @code
15955 @item Alg
15956 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15957
15958 @item Alg[(
15959 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15960
15961 @item Alg*
15962 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15963
15964 @item Symb
15965 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15966
15967 @item Matrix
15968 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15969
15970 @item Matrix@var{n}
15971 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15972
15973 @item SqMatrix
15974 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15975
15976 @item Scalar
15977 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15978
15979 @item Polar
15980 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15981
15982 @item Frac
15983 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15984
15985 @item Inf
15986 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15987
15988 @item +Inf
15989 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15990
15991 @item NoSimp
15992 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15993
15994 @item NumSimp
15995 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15996
15997 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15998 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15999
16000 @item BasicSimp
16001 Basic simplification mode (@kbd{m I}).
16002
16003 @item ExtSimp
16004 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
16005
16006 @item UnitSimp
16007 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
16008
16009 @item Bin
16010 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
16011
16012 @item Oct
16013 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
16014
16015 @item Hex
16016 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
16017
16018 @item Radix@var{n}
16019 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
16020
16021 @item Zero
16022 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
16023
16024 @item Big
16025 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16026
16027 @item Flat
16028 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
16029
16030 @item Unform
16031 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
16032
16033 @item C
16034 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
16035
16036 @item Pascal
16037 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
16038
16039 @item Fortran
16040 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
16041
16042 @item TeX
16043 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16044
16045 @item LaTeX
16046 @LaTeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16047
16048 @item Eqn
16049 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
16050
16051 @item Math
16052 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
16053
16054 @item Maple
16055 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
16056
16057 @item Norm@var{n}
16058 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
16059
16060 @item Fix@var{n}
16061 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
16062
16063 @item Sci
16064 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
16065
16066 @item Sci@var{n}
16067 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
16068
16069 @item Eng
16070 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
16071
16072 @item Eng@var{n}
16073 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
16074
16075 @item Left@var{n}
16076 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
16077
16078 @item Right
16079 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
16080
16081 @item Right@var{n}
16082 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
16083
16084 @item Center
16085 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
16086
16087 @item Center@var{n}
16088 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
16089
16090 @item Wid@var{n}
16091 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16092
16093 @item Wide
16094 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
16095
16096 @item Break
16097 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16098
16099 @item Save
16100 Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
16101
16102 @item Local
16103 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16104
16105 @item LocEdit
16106 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16107
16108 @item LocPerm
16109 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16110
16111 @item Global
16112 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16113
16114 @item Manual
16115 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16116 Recomputation}).
16117
16118 @item Graph
16119 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16120
16121 @item Sel
16122 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16123
16124 @item Dirty
16125 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16126
16127 @item Inv
16128 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16129
16130 @item Hyp
16131 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16132
16133 @item Keep
16134 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16135
16136 @item Narrow
16137 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16138 @end table
16139
16140 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16141 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16142
16143 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16144 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16145
16146 @noindent
16147 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16148 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16149 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16150 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16151 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16152 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16153 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16154
16155 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16156 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16157 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16158
16159 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16160 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16161 interpret a prefix argument.
16162
16163 @menu
16164 * Basic Arithmetic::
16165 * Integer Truncation::
16166 * Complex Number Functions::
16167 * Conversions::
16168 * Date Arithmetic::
16169 * Financial Functions::
16170 * Binary Functions::
16171 @end menu
16172
16173 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16174 @section Basic Arithmetic
16175
16176 @noindent
16177 @kindex +
16178 @pindex calc-plus
16179 @ignore
16180 @mindex @null
16181 @end ignore
16182 @tindex +
16183 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16184 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16185 onto the stack.
16186
16187 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16188 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16189 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16190 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16191 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16192 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16193 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16194 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16195 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16196 to every element of a vector.
16197
16198 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16199 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16200 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16201 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16202 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16203
16204 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16205 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16206 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16207 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16208 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16209
16210 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16211 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16212 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16213 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16214 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16215 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16216 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16217 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16218
16219 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16220 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16221 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16222 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16223 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16224 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16225 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16226 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16227
16228 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16229 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16230 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16231 the two values.
16232
16233 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16234 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16235 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16236 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16237
16238 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16239 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16240 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16241 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16242
16243 @kindex -
16244 @pindex calc-minus
16245 @ignore
16246 @mindex @null
16247 @end ignore
16248 @tindex -
16249 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16250 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16251 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16252 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16253
16254 @kindex *
16255 @pindex calc-times
16256 @ignore
16257 @mindex @null
16258 @end ignore
16259 @tindex *
16260 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16261 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16262 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16263 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16264 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16265 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16266 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16267 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16268 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16269
16270 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16271 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16272 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16273 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16274 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16275 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16276 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16277 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16278
16279 @kindex /
16280 @pindex calc-divide
16281 @ignore
16282 @mindex @null
16283 @end ignore
16284 @tindex /
16285 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16286
16287 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16288 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16289 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16290 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16291 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16292 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16293 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16294 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16295 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16296 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16297 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16298 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16299 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16300 @smallexample
16301 @group
16302 a b
16303 ---.
16304 c d
16305 @end group
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16309 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16310 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16311 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16312 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16313 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16314 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16315 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16316 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16317 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16318 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16319 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16320 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16321 transpose the result.
16322
16323 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16324 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16325 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16326 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16327 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16328 interval.
16329
16330 @kindex ^
16331 @pindex calc-power
16332 @ignore
16333 @mindex @null
16334 @end ignore
16335 @tindex ^
16336 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16337 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16338 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16339 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16340 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16341 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16342
16343 @kindex I ^
16344 @tindex nroot
16345 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16346 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16347 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16348
16349 @kindex \
16350 @pindex calc-idiv
16351 @tindex idiv
16352 @ignore
16353 @mindex @null
16354 @end ignore
16355 @tindex \
16356 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16357 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16358 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16359 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16360 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16361 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16362
16363 @kindex %
16364 @pindex calc-mod
16365 @ignore
16366 @mindex @null
16367 @end ignore
16368 @tindex %
16369 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16370 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16371 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16372 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16373 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16374 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16375 must be positive real number.
16376
16377 @kindex :
16378 @pindex calc-fdiv
16379 @tindex fdiv
16380 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16381 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16382 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16383 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16384 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16385 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16386 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16387 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16388
16389 @kindex n
16390 @pindex calc-change-sign
16391 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16392 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16393 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16394
16395 @kindex A
16396 @pindex calc-abs
16397 @tindex abs
16398 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16399 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16400 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16401 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16402 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16403 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16404 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16405 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16406 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16407
16408 @kindex f A
16409 @pindex calc-abssqr
16410 @tindex abssqr
16411 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16412 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16413
16414 @kindex f s
16415 @pindex calc-sign
16416 @tindex sign
16417 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16418 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16419 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16420 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16421 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16422
16423 @kindex &
16424 @pindex calc-inv
16425 @tindex inv
16426 @cindex Reciprocal
16427 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16428 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16429 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16430
16431 @kindex Q
16432 @pindex calc-sqrt
16433 @tindex sqrt
16434 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16435 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16436 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16437
16438 @kindex f h
16439 @pindex calc-hypot
16440 @tindex hypot
16441 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16442 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16443 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16444 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16445 magnitudes are used.
16446
16447 @kindex f Q
16448 @pindex calc-isqrt
16449 @tindex isqrt
16450 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16451 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16452 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16453 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16454 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16455 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16456 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16457
16458 @kindex f n
16459 @kindex f x
16460 @pindex calc-min
16461 @tindex min
16462 @pindex calc-max
16463 @tindex max
16464 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16465 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16466 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16467 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16468 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16469 all the arguments.)
16470
16471 @kindex f M
16472 @kindex f X
16473 @pindex calc-mant-part
16474 @tindex mant
16475 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16476 @tindex xpon
16477 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16478 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16479 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16480 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16481 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16482 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16483 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16484 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16485 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16486 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16487 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16488 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16489 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16490
16491 @kindex f S
16492 @pindex calc-scale-float
16493 @tindex scf
16494 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16495 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16496 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16497 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16498 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16499
16500 @kindex f [
16501 @kindex f ]
16502 @pindex calc-decrement
16503 @pindex calc-increment
16504 @tindex decr
16505 @tindex incr
16506 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16507 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16508 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16509 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16510 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16511 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16512 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16513 @samp{0.0} produces
16514 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16515 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16516 where @expr{p} is the current
16517 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16518 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16519
16520 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16521 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16522 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16523 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16524 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16525 way floating-point numbers work.
16526
16527 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16528 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16529
16530 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16531 @section Integer Truncation
16532
16533 @noindent
16534 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16535 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16536 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16537 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16538 to integer form.
16539
16540 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16541 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16542
16543 @cindex Integer part of a number
16544 @kindex F
16545 @pindex calc-floor
16546 @tindex floor
16547 @tindex ffloor
16548 @ignore
16549 @mindex @null
16550 @end ignore
16551 @kindex H F
16552 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16553 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16554 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16555 @mathit{-4}.
16556
16557 @kindex I F
16558 @pindex calc-ceiling
16559 @tindex ceil
16560 @tindex fceil
16561 @ignore
16562 @mindex @null
16563 @end ignore
16564 @kindex H I F
16565 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16566 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16567 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16568
16569 @kindex R
16570 @pindex calc-round
16571 @tindex round
16572 @tindex fround
16573 @ignore
16574 @mindex @null
16575 @end ignore
16576 @kindex H R
16577 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16578 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16579 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16580 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16581 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16582
16583 @kindex I R
16584 @pindex calc-trunc
16585 @tindex trunc
16586 @tindex ftrunc
16587 @ignore
16588 @mindex @null
16589 @end ignore
16590 @kindex H I R
16591 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16592 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16593 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16594 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16595
16596 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16597 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16598 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16599 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16600 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16601 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16602
16603 @ignore
16604 @starindex
16605 @end ignore
16606 @tindex rounde
16607 @ignore
16608 @starindex
16609 @end ignore
16610 @tindex roundu
16611 @ignore
16612 @starindex
16613 @end ignore
16614 @tindex frounde
16615 @ignore
16616 @starindex
16617 @end ignore
16618 @tindex froundu
16619 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16620 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16621 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16622 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16623 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16624 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16625 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16626 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16627 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16628 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16629 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16630 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16631 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16632 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16633 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16634
16635 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16636 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16637 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16638 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16639 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16640 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16641 no second argument at all.
16642
16643 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16644 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16645 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16646 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16647
16648 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16649 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16650 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16651 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16652
16653 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16654 @section Complex Number Functions
16655
16656 @noindent
16657 @kindex J
16658 @pindex calc-conj
16659 @tindex conj
16660 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16661 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16662 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16663 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16664 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16665
16666 @kindex G
16667 @pindex calc-argument
16668 @tindex arg
16669 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16670 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16671 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16672 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16673 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16674 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16675 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16676 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16677
16678 @pindex calc-imaginary
16679 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16680 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16681 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16682 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16683
16684 @kindex f r
16685 @pindex calc-re
16686 @tindex re
16687 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16688 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16689 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16690 the value part.)
16691
16692 @kindex f i
16693 @pindex calc-im
16694 @tindex im
16695 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16696 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16697 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16698
16699 @ignore
16700 @mindex v p
16701 @end ignore
16702 @kindex v p (complex)
16703 @kindex V p (complex)
16704 @pindex calc-pack
16705 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16706 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16707 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16708 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16709 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16710
16711 @ignore
16712 @mindex v u
16713 @end ignore
16714 @kindex v u (complex)
16715 @kindex V u (complex)
16716 @pindex calc-unpack
16717 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16718 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16719 into its separate components.
16720
16721 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16722 @section Conversions
16723
16724 @noindent
16725 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16726 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16727
16728 @kindex c f
16729 @pindex calc-float
16730 @tindex pfloat
16731 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16732 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16733 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16734 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16735 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16736 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16737 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16738 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16739 format may lose information.
16740
16741 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16742 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16743 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16744 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16745 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16746 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16747
16748 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16749 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16750 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16751 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16752
16753 @kindex H c f
16754 @tindex float
16755 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16756 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16757 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16758 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16759
16760 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16761 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16762 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16763 that appear right now.
16764
16765 @kindex c F
16766 @pindex calc-fraction
16767 @tindex pfrac
16768 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16769 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16770 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16771 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16772 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16773 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16774 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16775 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16776 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16777 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16778 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16779
16780 @kindex H c F
16781 @tindex frac
16782 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16783 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16784 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16785
16786 @kindex c d
16787 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16788 @tindex deg
16789 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16790 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16791 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16792 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16793
16794 @kindex c r
16795 @pindex calc-to-radians
16796 @tindex rad
16797 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16798 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16799
16800 @kindex c h
16801 @pindex calc-to-hms
16802 @tindex hms
16803 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16804 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16805 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16806 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16807 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16808
16809 @pindex calc-from-hms
16810 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16811 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16812
16813 @kindex c p
16814 @kindex I c p
16815 @pindex calc-polar
16816 @tindex polar
16817 @tindex rect
16818 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16819 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16820 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16821 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16822 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16823 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16824 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16825 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16826
16827 @kindex c c
16828 @pindex calc-clean
16829 @tindex pclean
16830 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16831 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16832 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16833 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16834 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16835 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16836 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16837 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16838 number (i.e., pervasively).
16839
16840 If the simplification mode is set below basic simplification, it is raised
16841 for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c} applies the basic
16842 simplifications even if their automatic application is disabled.
16843 @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16844
16845 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16846 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16847 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16848 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16849 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16850
16851 @kindex c 0-9
16852 @pindex calc-clean-num
16853 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16854 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16855 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16856 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16857
16858 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16859 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16860 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16861 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16862 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16863 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16864 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16865
16866 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16867 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16868 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16869 does not clip small numbers.)
16870
16871 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16872 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16873 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16874 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16875 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16876 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16877
16878 @kindex H c 0-9
16879 @kindex H c c
16880 @tindex clean
16881 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16882 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16883
16884 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16885 @section Date Arithmetic
16886
16887 @noindent
16888 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16889 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16890 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16891 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16892 letters.
16893
16894 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16895 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16896 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16897 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16898 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16899 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16900
16901 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16902 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16903 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16904
16905 @menu
16906 * Date Conversions::
16907 * Date Functions::
16908 * Time Zones::
16909 * Business Days::
16910 @end menu
16911
16912 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16913 @subsection Date Conversions
16914
16915 @noindent
16916 @kindex t D
16917 @pindex calc-date
16918 @tindex date
16919 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16920 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD@. The
16921 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16922 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16923 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16924
16925 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16926 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16927 of the following ways:
16928
16929 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16930 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16931 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16932 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16933 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16934 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16935 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16936 month will be used.
16937
16938 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16939 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16940 real-time clock.
16941
16942 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16943 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16944
16945 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16946 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16947 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16948 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16949 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16950 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16951
16952 @kindex t J
16953 @pindex calc-julian
16954 @tindex julian
16955 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16956 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16957 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16958 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC@. A pure date is converted to an
16959 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16960 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16961 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16962 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16963 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16964 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16965 are never time-zone adjusted.
16966
16967 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16968 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16969 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16970 current or specified time zone.
16971
16972 @kindex t U
16973 @pindex calc-unix-time
16974 @tindex unixtime
16975 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16976 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16977 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16978 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16979 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16980 precision, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16981 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16982 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16983 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16984 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16985 suppress the adjustment if so.
16986
16987 @kindex t C
16988 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16989 @tindex tzconv
16990 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16991 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16992 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16993 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16994 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16995 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16996 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16997 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16998 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16999
17000 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
17001 @subsection Date Functions
17002
17003 @noindent
17004 @kindex t N
17005 @pindex calc-now
17006 @tindex now
17007 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
17008 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
17009 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
17010 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
17011
17012 @kindex t P
17013 @pindex calc-date-part
17014 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
17015 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
17016 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
17017 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
17018
17019 @tindex year
17020 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
17021 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
17022 following functions will also accept a real number for an
17023 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
17024 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
17025 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
17026
17027 @tindex month
17028 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
17029 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
17030
17031 @tindex day
17032 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
17033 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
17034
17035 @tindex hour
17036 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
17037 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
17038 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
17039 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
17040 HMS forms as input.
17041
17042 @tindex minute
17043 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
17044 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
17045
17046 @tindex second
17047 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
17048 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
17049 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
17050 precision, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
17051
17052 @tindex weekday
17053 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
17054 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
17055 to 6 (Saturday).
17056
17057 @tindex yearday
17058 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
17059 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
17060 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
17061
17062 @tindex time
17063 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
17064 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
17065 for a pure date form.
17066
17067 @kindex t M
17068 @pindex calc-new-month
17069 @tindex newmonth
17070 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
17071 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
17072 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
17073 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
17074 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
17075 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
17076 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
17077 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
17078
17079 @kindex t Y
17080 @pindex calc-new-year
17081 @tindex newyear
17082 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
17083 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
17084 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
17085 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
17086 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
17087 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
17088 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
17089 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
17090 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
17091
17092 @kindex t W
17093 @pindex calc-new-week
17094 @tindex newweek
17095 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
17096 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
17097 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
17098 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
17099 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
17100 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
17101
17102 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
17103 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
17104 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
17105 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
17106 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
17107 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
17108 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
17109 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
17110 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
17111 the time to midnight; hint: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
17112 of the @code{weekday} function?).
17113
17114 @ignore
17115 @starindex
17116 @end ignore
17117 @tindex pwday
17118 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
17119 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
17120 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
17121 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
17122 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
17123 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
17124 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
17125 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17126 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17127 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17128 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17129
17130 @kindex t I
17131 @pindex calc-inc-month
17132 @tindex incmonth
17133 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17134 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17135 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17136 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17137 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17138 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17139 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17140 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17141 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17142 in this case).
17143
17144 @ignore
17145 @starindex
17146 @end ignore
17147 @tindex incyear
17148 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17149 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17150 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17151 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17152 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17153 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17154 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17155 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17156
17157 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17158 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17159 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17160
17161 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17162 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17163
17164 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17165 @subsection Business Days
17166
17167 @noindent
17168 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17169 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17170 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17171 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17172 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17173 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17174
17175 @kindex t +
17176 @kindex t -
17177 @tindex badd
17178 @tindex bsub
17179 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17180 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17181 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17182 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17183 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17184 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17185 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17186 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17187 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17188 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17189 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17190 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17191 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17192 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17193 dates.
17194
17195 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17196 @vindex Holidays
17197 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17198 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17199 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17200 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17201 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17202 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17203 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17204
17205 @itemize @bullet
17206 @item
17207 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17208 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17209
17210 @item
17211 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17212 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17213
17214 @item
17215 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17216 considered to be a holiday.
17217
17218 @item
17219 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17220 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17221 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17222 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17223 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17224 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17225 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17226 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17227 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17228
17229 @item
17230 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17231 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17232
17233 @item
17234 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17235 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17236 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17237 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17238 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17239 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17240 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17241 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17242 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17243 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17244
17245 @item
17246 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17247 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17248 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17249 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17250 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17251 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17252 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17253 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17254 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17255 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17256 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17257 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17258 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17259 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17260 @end itemize
17261
17262 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17263 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17264 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17265
17266 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17267 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17268 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17269 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17270 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17271 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17272
17273 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17274 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17275 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17276 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17277 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17278 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17279 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17280 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17281
17282 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17283 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17284 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17285 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17286 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17287 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17288 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17289 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17290 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17291 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17292 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17293 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17294 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17295 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17296 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17297
17298 @ignore
17299 @starindex
17300 @end ignore
17301 @tindex holiday
17302 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17303 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17304 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17305 business day.
17306
17307 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17308 @subsection Time Zones
17309
17310 @noindent
17311 @cindex Time zones
17312 @cindex Daylight saving time
17313 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17314 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17315 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17316 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17317 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17318 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17319 can't determine the right correction to use.
17320
17321 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17322 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17323 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17324 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17325 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17326 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17327 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17328 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17329 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17330 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17331 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17332 April 7, 1991.
17333
17334 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17335 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17336 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17337 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17338
17339 @pindex calc-time-zone
17340 @ignore
17341 @starindex
17342 @end ignore
17343 @tindex tzone
17344 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17345 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17346 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17347 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17348 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17349 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17350 the normal difference.
17351
17352 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17353 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17354 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17355 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17356 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17357 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17358 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17359 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17360 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17361
17362 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17363 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17364 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17365 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17366
17367 @smallexample
17368 @group
17369 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17370 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17371
17372 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17373 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17374
17375 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17376 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17377 @end group
17378 @end smallexample
17379
17380 @vindex math-tzone-names
17381 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17382 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17383 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17384 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17385 Pacific Time look like this:
17386
17387 @smallexample
17388 @group
17389 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17390 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17391 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17392 @end group
17393 @end smallexample
17394
17395 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17396 @vindex TimeZone
17397 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17398 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17399 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17400 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17401 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17402 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17403 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17404 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17405 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17406 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17407 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17408 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17409 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17410 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17411 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17412 The special time zone name @code{local}
17413 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17414 from the calendar.
17415
17416 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17417 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17418 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17419 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17420
17421 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17422 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17423 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17424 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17425 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17426 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17427 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17428 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17429 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17430 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17431 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17432 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17433 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17434 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17435 the conversion functions.
17436
17437 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17438 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17439 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17440 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17441 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17442
17443 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17444 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17445 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17446 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17447 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17448 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17449 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17450
17451 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17452 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17453 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17454 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17455 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17456 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17457 and the weekday number (0--6).
17458
17459 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17460 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17461 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17462 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17463 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17464 daylight saving hook:
17465
17466 @smallexample
17467 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17468 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17469 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17470 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17471 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17472 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17473 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17474 (t -1))))
17475 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17476 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17477 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17478 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17479 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17480 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17481 (t 0))))
17482 (t 0))
17483 )
17484 @end smallexample
17485
17486 @noindent
17487 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17488 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17489 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17490 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17491 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17492
17493 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17494 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17495 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17496 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17497 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17498 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17499 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17500 later).
17501
17502 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17503 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17504
17505 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17506 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17507 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17508 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17509 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17510 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17511 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17512 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17513 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17514 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17515 is typically represented in.
17516
17517 @ignore
17518 @starindex
17519 @end ignore
17520 @tindex dsadj
17521 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17522 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17523 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17524 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17525 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17526 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17527 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17528
17529 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17530 @section Financial Functions
17531
17532 @noindent
17533 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17534 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17535 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17536
17537 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17538 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17539 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17540 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17541
17542 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17543 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17544 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17545 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17546
17547 @menu
17548 * Percentages::
17549 * Future Value::
17550 * Present Value::
17551 * Related Financial Functions::
17552 * Depreciation Functions::
17553 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17554 @end menu
17555
17556 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17557 @subsection Percentages
17558
17559 @kindex M-%
17560 @pindex calc-percent
17561 @tindex %
17562 @tindex percent
17563 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17564 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17565 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17566 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17567
17568 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17569 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17570 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17571 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17572 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17573 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17574 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17575 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17576
17577 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17578 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17579 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17580 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17581 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17582 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17583
17584 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17585 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17586 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17587 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17588
17589 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17590 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17591 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17592
17593 @kindex c %
17594 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17595 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17596 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17597 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17598 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17599 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17600 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17601 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17602
17603 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17604 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17605 @samp{25%}.
17606
17607 @kindex b %
17608 @pindex calc-percent-change
17609 @tindex relch
17610 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17611 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17612 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17613 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17614 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17615 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17616 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17617 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17618 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17619 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17620
17621 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17622 @subsection Future Value
17623
17624 @noindent
17625 @kindex b F
17626 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17627 @tindex fv
17628 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17629 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17630 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17631 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17632 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17633 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17634 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17635 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17636 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17637 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17638
17639 @kindex I b F
17640 @tindex fvb
17641 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17642 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17643 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17644 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17645 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17646 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17647 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17648 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17649 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17650
17651 @kindex H b F
17652 @tindex fvl
17653 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17654 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17655 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17656 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17657
17658 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17659 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17660 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17661 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17662 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17663
17664 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17665 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17666 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17667 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17668 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17669 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17670 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17671 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17672 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17673 by @code{fvb} directly.
17674
17675 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17676 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17677 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17678 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17679 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17680 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17681 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17682
17683 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17684 @subsection Present Value
17685
17686 @noindent
17687 @kindex b P
17688 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17689 @tindex pv
17690 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17691 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17692 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17693 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17694 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17695 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17696 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17697 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17698 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17699 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17700 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17701 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17702 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17703
17704 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17705 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17706 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17707 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17708 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17709 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17710 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17711 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17712 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17713
17714 @kindex I b P
17715 @tindex pvb
17716 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17717 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17718 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17719 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17720 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17721 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17722
17723 @kindex H b P
17724 @tindex pvl
17725 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17726 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17727 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17728 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17729 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17730 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17731 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17732
17733 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17734 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17735 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17736
17737 @kindex b N
17738 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17739 @tindex npv
17740 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17741 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17742 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17743 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17744 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17745 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17746 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17747
17748 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17749 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17750 not all the same!
17751
17752 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17753 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17754 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17755 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17756 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17757 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17758 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17759 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17760
17761 @kindex I b N
17762 @tindex npvb
17763 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17764 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17765 rather than at the end.
17766
17767 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17768 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17769
17770 @noindent
17771 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17772 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17773
17774 @kindex b M
17775 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17776 @tindex pmt
17777 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17778 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17779 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17780 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17781 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17782
17783 @kindex I b M
17784 @tindex pmtb
17785 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17786 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17787 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17788 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17789
17790 @kindex H b M
17791 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17792 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17793
17794 @kindex b #
17795 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17796 @tindex nper
17797 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17798 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17799 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17800 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17801 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17802 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17803 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17804
17805 @kindex I b #
17806 @tindex nperb
17807 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17808 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17809 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17810 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17811
17812 @kindex H b #
17813 @tindex nperl
17814 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17815 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17816 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17817 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17818 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17819
17820 @kindex b T
17821 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17822 @tindex rate
17823 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17824 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17825 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17826 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17827 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17828
17829 @kindex I b T
17830 @kindex H b T
17831 @tindex rateb
17832 @tindex ratel
17833 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17834 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17835 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17836 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17837 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17838 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17839 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17840
17841 @kindex b I
17842 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17843 @tindex irr
17844 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17845 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17846 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17847 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17848 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17849
17850 @kindex I b I
17851 @tindex irrb
17852 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17853 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17854
17855 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17856 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17857
17858 @noindent
17859 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17860 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17861 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17862 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17863 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17864 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17865
17866 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17867 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17868
17869 @kindex b S
17870 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17871 @tindex sln
17872 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17873 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17874 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17875 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17876 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17877 per year.
17878
17879 @kindex b Y
17880 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17881 @tindex syd
17882 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17883 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17884 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17885 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17886 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17887 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17888 return zero.
17889
17890 @kindex b D
17891 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17892 @tindex ddb
17893 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17894 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17895 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17896
17897 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17898 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17899 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17900
17901 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17902 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17903 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17904 the three depreciation methods:
17905
17906 @example
17907 @group
17908 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17909 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17910 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17911 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17912 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17913 @end group
17914 @end example
17915
17916 @noindent
17917 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17918 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17919 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17920 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17921
17922 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17923 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17924 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17925
17926 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17927 @subsection Definitions
17928
17929 @noindent
17930 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17931 Calc's financial functions.
17932
17933 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17934 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17935 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17936 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17937 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17938 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17939
17940 @ifnottex
17941 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17942 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17943 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17944
17945 @example
17946 n
17947 (1 + rate) - 1
17948 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17949 rate
17950
17951 n
17952 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17953 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17954 rate
17955
17956 n
17957 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17958
17959 -n
17960 1 - (1 + rate)
17961 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17962 rate
17963
17964 -n
17965 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17966 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17967 rate
17968
17969 -n
17970 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17971
17972 -1 -2 -3
17973 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17974
17975 -1 -2
17976 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17977
17978 -n
17979 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17980 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17981 -n
17982 1 - (1 + rate)
17983
17984 -n
17985 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17986 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17987 -n
17988 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17989
17990 amt * rate
17991 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17992 pmt
17993
17994 amt * rate
17995 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17996 pmt * (1 + rate)
17997
17998 amt
17999 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
18000 pmt
18001
18002 1/n
18003 pmt
18004 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
18005 1/n
18006 amt
18007
18008 cost - salv
18009 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
18010 life
18011
18012 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
18013 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
18014 life * (life + 1) / 2
18015
18016 book * 2
18017 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
18018 life
18019 @end example
18020 @end ifnottex
18021 @tex
18022 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
18023 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18024 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
18025 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
18026 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18027 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
18028 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
18029 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
18030 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
18031 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
18032 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
18033 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
18034 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
18035 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
18036 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
18037 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
18038 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
18039 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
18040 @end tex
18041
18042 @noindent
18043 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
18044
18045 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
18046 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
18047 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
18048 all sorts of inputs.
18049
18050 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
18051 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
18052 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
18053
18054 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
18055 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
18056 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
18057 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
18058 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
18059 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
18060
18061 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
18062 for @samp{rate}.
18063
18064 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
18065 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
18066 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
18067
18068 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
18069 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
18070 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
18071
18072 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
18073 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
18074 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
18075 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
18076 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
18077 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
18078 period.
18079
18080 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
18081 @section Binary Number Functions
18082
18083 @noindent
18084 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
18085 the @kbd{b} prefix.
18086
18087 @cindex Binary numbers
18088 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
18089 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
18090 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
18091 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
18092 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
18093
18094 @cindex Word size for binary operations
18095 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
18096 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
18097 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
18098 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
18099 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
18100
18101 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
18102 integers from
18103 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
18104 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
18105 to
18106 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
18107 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
18108 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
18109 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
18110
18111 @kindex b c
18112 @pindex calc-clip
18113 @tindex clip
18114 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18115 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18116 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18117 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18118 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18119 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18120 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18121 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18122 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18123
18124 @kindex b w
18125 @pindex calc-word-size
18126 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18127 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18128 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18129 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18130 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18131 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18132 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18133
18134 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18135 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18136 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18137 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18138 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18139 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18140 integer-valued floats.
18141
18142 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18143 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18144 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18145 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18146
18147 @kindex b a
18148 @pindex calc-and
18149 @tindex and
18150 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18151 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18152 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18153 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18154 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18155
18156 @kindex b o
18157 @pindex calc-or
18158 @tindex or
18159 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18160 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18161 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18162
18163 @kindex b x
18164 @pindex calc-xor
18165 @tindex xor
18166 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18167 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18168 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18169
18170 @kindex b d
18171 @pindex calc-diff
18172 @tindex diff
18173 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18174 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18175 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18176
18177 @kindex b n
18178 @pindex calc-not
18179 @tindex not
18180 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18181 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18182
18183 @kindex b l
18184 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18185 @tindex lsh
18186 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18187 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18188 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18189 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18190 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18191 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18192
18193 @kindex H b l
18194 @kindex H b r
18195 @ignore
18196 @mindex @idots
18197 @end ignore
18198 @kindex H b L
18199 @ignore
18200 @mindex @null
18201 @end ignore
18202 @kindex H b R
18203 @ignore
18204 @mindex @null
18205 @end ignore
18206 @kindex H b t
18207 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18208 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18209 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18210 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18211 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18212
18213 @kindex b r
18214 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18215 @tindex rsh
18216 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18217 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18218 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18219
18220 @kindex b L
18221 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18222 @tindex ash
18223 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18224 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18225 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18226 is performed as described below.
18227
18228 @kindex b R
18229 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18230 @tindex rash
18231 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18232 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18233 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18234 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18235 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18236 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18237 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18238 performs a standard left shift.
18239
18240 @kindex b t
18241 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18242 @tindex rot
18243 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18244 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18245 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18246 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18247 or right.
18248
18249 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18250 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18251 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18252 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18253 bits in a binary integer.
18254
18255 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18256 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18257 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18258 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18259 into a binary integer.
18260
18261 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18262 @chapter Scientific Functions
18263
18264 @noindent
18265 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18266 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18267 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18268 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18269
18270 @kindex P
18271 @pindex calc-pi
18272 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18273 @vindex pi
18274 @kindex H P
18275 @cindex @code{e} variable
18276 @vindex e
18277 @kindex I P
18278 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18279 @vindex gamma
18280 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18281 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18282 @kindex H I P
18283 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18284 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18285 @cindex Golden ratio
18286 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18287 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18288 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18289 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18290 @texline @math{\gamma}
18291 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18292 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18293 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18294 @texline @math{\phi}
18295 @infoline @expr{phi}
18296 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18297 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18298 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18299 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18300 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18301
18302 @ignore
18303 @mindex Q
18304 @end ignore
18305 @ignore
18306 @mindex I Q
18307 @end ignore
18308 @kindex I Q
18309 @tindex sqr
18310 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18311 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18312 computes the square of the argument.
18313
18314 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18315 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18316 interpret a prefix argument.
18317
18318 @menu
18319 * Logarithmic Functions::
18320 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18321 * Advanced Math Functions::
18322 * Branch Cuts::
18323 * Random Numbers::
18324 * Combinatorial Functions::
18325 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18326 @end menu
18327
18328 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18329 @section Logarithmic Functions
18330
18331 @noindent
18332 @kindex L
18333 @pindex calc-ln
18334 @tindex ln
18335 @ignore
18336 @mindex @null
18337 @end ignore
18338 @kindex I E
18339 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18340 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18341 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18342 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18343
18344 @kindex E
18345 @pindex calc-exp
18346 @tindex exp
18347 @ignore
18348 @mindex @null
18349 @end ignore
18350 @kindex I L
18351 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18352 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18353 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18354 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18355
18356 @kindex H L
18357 @kindex H E
18358 @pindex calc-log10
18359 @tindex log10
18360 @tindex exp10
18361 @ignore
18362 @mindex @null
18363 @end ignore
18364 @kindex H I L
18365 @ignore
18366 @mindex @null
18367 @end ignore
18368 @kindex H I E
18369 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18370 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18371 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18372 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18373 by
18374 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18375 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18376
18377 @kindex B
18378 @kindex I B
18379 @pindex calc-log
18380 @tindex log
18381 @tindex alog
18382 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18383 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18384 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18385 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18386 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18387 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18388 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18389 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18390
18391 @kindex f I
18392 @pindex calc-ilog
18393 @tindex ilog
18394 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18395 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18396 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18397 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18398 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18399 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18400 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18401
18402 @kindex f E
18403 @pindex calc-expm1
18404 @tindex expm1
18405 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18406 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18407 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18408 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18409 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18410 @texline @math{e^x}
18411 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18412 is close to one.
18413
18414 @kindex f L
18415 @pindex calc-lnp1
18416 @tindex lnp1
18417 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18418 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18419 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18420 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18421
18422 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18423 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18424
18425 @noindent
18426 @kindex S
18427 @pindex calc-sin
18428 @tindex sin
18429 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18430 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18431 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18432 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18433 on complex numbers.
18434
18435 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18436 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18437 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18438 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18439 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18440
18441 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18442 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18443 the default algebraic simplifications recognize many such
18444 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18445 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18446 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18447 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18448 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18449 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18450 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18451
18452 Calc's algebraic simplifications know all angles which are integer multiples of
18453 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18454 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18455 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18456
18457 @kindex I S
18458 @pindex calc-arcsin
18459 @tindex arcsin
18460 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18461 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18462 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18463 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18464
18465 @kindex H S
18466 @pindex calc-sinh
18467 @tindex sinh
18468 @kindex H I S
18469 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18470 @tindex arcsinh
18471 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18472 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18473 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18474 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18475
18476 @kindex C
18477 @pindex calc-cos
18478 @tindex cos
18479 @ignore
18480 @mindex @idots
18481 @end ignore
18482 @kindex I C
18483 @pindex calc-arccos
18484 @ignore
18485 @mindex @null
18486 @end ignore
18487 @tindex arccos
18488 @ignore
18489 @mindex @null
18490 @end ignore
18491 @kindex H C
18492 @pindex calc-cosh
18493 @ignore
18494 @mindex @null
18495 @end ignore
18496 @tindex cosh
18497 @ignore
18498 @mindex @null
18499 @end ignore
18500 @kindex H I C
18501 @pindex calc-arccosh
18502 @ignore
18503 @mindex @null
18504 @end ignore
18505 @tindex arccosh
18506 @ignore
18507 @mindex @null
18508 @end ignore
18509 @kindex T
18510 @pindex calc-tan
18511 @ignore
18512 @mindex @null
18513 @end ignore
18514 @tindex tan
18515 @ignore
18516 @mindex @null
18517 @end ignore
18518 @kindex I T
18519 @pindex calc-arctan
18520 @ignore
18521 @mindex @null
18522 @end ignore
18523 @tindex arctan
18524 @ignore
18525 @mindex @null
18526 @end ignore
18527 @kindex H T
18528 @pindex calc-tanh
18529 @ignore
18530 @mindex @null
18531 @end ignore
18532 @tindex tanh
18533 @ignore
18534 @mindex @null
18535 @end ignore
18536 @kindex H I T
18537 @pindex calc-arctanh
18538 @ignore
18539 @mindex @null
18540 @end ignore
18541 @tindex arctanh
18542 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18543 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18544 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18545 variants of these functions.
18546
18547 @kindex f T
18548 @pindex calc-arctan2
18549 @tindex arctan2
18550 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18551 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18552 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18553 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18554 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18555 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18556 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18557 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18558 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18559 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18560
18561 @pindex calc-sincos
18562 @ignore
18563 @starindex
18564 @end ignore
18565 @tindex sincos
18566 @ignore
18567 @starindex
18568 @end ignore
18569 @ignore
18570 @mindex arc@idots
18571 @end ignore
18572 @tindex arcsincos
18573 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18574 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18575 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18576 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18577 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18578 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18579
18580 @pindex calc-sec
18581 @tindex sec
18582 @pindex calc-csc
18583 @tindex csc
18584 @pindex calc-cot
18585 @tindex cot
18586 @pindex calc-sech
18587 @tindex sech
18588 @pindex calc-csch
18589 @tindex csch
18590 @pindex calc-coth
18591 @tindex coth
18592 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18593 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18594 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18595 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18596 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18597 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18598
18599 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18600 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18601
18602 @noindent
18603 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18604 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18605 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18606 will work to arbitrarily large precision. They can not at present
18607 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18608
18609 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18610 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18611 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18612 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18613 slow for some values of the arguments.
18614
18615 @kindex f g
18616 @pindex calc-gamma
18617 @tindex gamma
18618 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18619 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18620 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18621 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18622 integral:
18623 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18624 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18625 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18626
18627 @kindex f G
18628 @tindex gammaP
18629 @ignore
18630 @mindex @idots
18631 @end ignore
18632 @kindex I f G
18633 @ignore
18634 @mindex @null
18635 @end ignore
18636 @kindex H f G
18637 @ignore
18638 @mindex @null
18639 @end ignore
18640 @kindex H I f G
18641 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18642 @ignore
18643 @mindex @null
18644 @end ignore
18645 @tindex gammaQ
18646 @ignore
18647 @mindex @null
18648 @end ignore
18649 @tindex gammag
18650 @ignore
18651 @mindex @null
18652 @end ignore
18653 @tindex gammaG
18654 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18655 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18656 the integral,
18657 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18658 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18659 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18660 definition of the normal gamma function).
18661
18662 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18663 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18664 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18665 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18666 @expr{x} to infinity.
18667
18668 @ifnottex
18669 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18670 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18671 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18672 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18673 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18674 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18675 @end ifnottex
18676 @tex
18677 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18678 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18679 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18680 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18681 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18682 @end tex
18683
18684 @kindex f b
18685 @pindex calc-beta
18686 @tindex beta
18687 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18688 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18689 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18690 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18691 or by
18692 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18693 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18694
18695 @kindex f B
18696 @kindex H f B
18697 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18698 @tindex betaI
18699 @tindex betaB
18700 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18701 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18702 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18703 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18704 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18705 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18706
18707 @kindex f e
18708 @kindex I f e
18709 @pindex calc-erf
18710 @tindex erf
18711 @tindex erfc
18712 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18713 error function
18714 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18715 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18716 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18717 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18718 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18719 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18720
18721 @kindex f j
18722 @kindex f y
18723 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18724 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18725 @tindex besJ
18726 @tindex besY
18727 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18728 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18729 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18730 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18731 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18732 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18733 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18734 Use with care!
18735
18736 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18737 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18738
18739 @noindent
18740 @cindex Branch cuts
18741 @cindex Principal values
18742 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18743 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18744 This section describes the values
18745 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18746 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18747 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18748 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18749 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18750
18751 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18752 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18753 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18754
18755 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18756 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18757 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18758 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18759 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18760 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18761
18762 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18763 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18764 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18765 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18766
18767 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18768 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18769 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18770 in the right half of the complex plane.
18771
18772 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18773 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18774 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18775 negative real axis.
18776
18777 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18778 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18779 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18780 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18781 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18782
18783 @smallexample
18784 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18785 ----------------------------------------
18786 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18787 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18788 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18789 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18790 @end smallexample
18791
18792 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18793 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18794 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18795 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18796 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18797 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18798
18799 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18800 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18801
18802 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18803 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18804 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18805
18806 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18807 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18808 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18809
18810 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18811 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18812 above @expr{i}.
18813
18814 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18815 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18816 real axis less than 1.
18817
18818 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18819 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18820
18821 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18822 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18823 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18824
18825 @smallexample
18826 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18827 -------------------------------------------------------
18828 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18829 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18830 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18831 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18832 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18833 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18834 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18835 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18836 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18837 @end smallexample
18838
18839 @smallexample
18840 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18841 -----------------------------------------------------
18842 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18843 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18844 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18845 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18846 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18847 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18848 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18849 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18850 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 @smallexample
18854 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18855 -----------------------------------------------------
18856 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18857 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18858 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18859 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18860 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18861 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18862 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18863 @end smallexample
18864
18865 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18866 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18867 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18868
18869 @smallexample
18870 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18871 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18872 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18873 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18874 @end smallexample
18875
18876 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18877 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18878 are not rigorously specified at present.
18879
18880 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18881 @section Random Numbers
18882
18883 @noindent
18884 @kindex k r
18885 @pindex calc-random
18886 @tindex random
18887 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18888 random numbers of various sorts.
18889
18890 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18891 integer @expr{N} in the range
18892 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18893 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18894 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18895
18896 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18897 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18898 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18899 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18900 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18901 the result is a random integer in the range
18902 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18903 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18904
18905 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18906 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18907 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18908 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18909 or
18910 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18911 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18912 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18913
18914 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18915 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18916 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18917 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18918
18919 If @expr{M} is an error form
18920 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18921 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18922 where @var{m} and
18923 @texline @math{\sigma}
18924 @infoline @var{s}
18925 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18926 @var{m} and standard deviation
18927 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18928 @infoline @var{s}.
18929
18930 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18931 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18932 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18933 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18934 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18935 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18936 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18937 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18938 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18939 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18940 extremely small.)
18941
18942 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18943 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18944
18945 @vindex RandSeed
18946 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18947 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18948 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18949 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18950 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18951 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18952 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18953 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18954 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18955 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18956 of random numbers as before.
18957
18958 @pindex calc-rrandom
18959 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18960 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18961
18962 @kindex k a
18963 @pindex calc-random-again
18964 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18965 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18966 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18967 that value of @expr{M}.
18968
18969 @kindex k h
18970 @pindex calc-shuffle
18971 @tindex shuffle
18972 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18973 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18974 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18975 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18976 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18977 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18978 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18979
18980 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18981 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18982 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18983 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18984 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18985 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18986 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18987 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18988 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18989 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18990 each make it into the result vector.)
18991
18992 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18993 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18994 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18995 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18996 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18997 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18998 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18999
19000 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
19001 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
19002 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
19003 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
19004 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
19005
19006 @menu
19007 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
19008 @end menu
19009
19010 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
19011 @subsection Random Number Generator
19012
19013 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
19014 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
19015 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
19016 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
19017 characterization.
19018
19019 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs's built-in
19020 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
19021 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
19022 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
19023
19024 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
19025 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
19026 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
19027
19028 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
19029 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
19030 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
19031 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
19032 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
19033 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
19034 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
19035 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
19036
19037 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
19038 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
19039 computing
19040 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
19041 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
19042 This method expands the seed
19043 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
19044 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
19045 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
19046 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
19047 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
19048 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
19049 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
19050 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
19051 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
19052 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
19053 to reseed the generator with that number.
19054
19055 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
19056 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
19057 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
19058 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
19059 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
19060 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
19061 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
19062 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
19063 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
19064 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
19065 damage its randomness.
19066
19067 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
19068 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
19069 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
19070 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
19071 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
19072 value.
19073
19074 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
19075 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
19076 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
19077 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
19078 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
19079 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
19080 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
19081 numbers on the order of
19082 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
19083 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
19084 or
19085 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
19086 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
19087 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
19088 correspond to small integers times
19089 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
19090 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
19091
19092 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
19093 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
19094 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
19095 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
19096 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
19097 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
19098 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
19099 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
19100 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
19101 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
19102
19103 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
19104 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C@. This method
19105 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
19106 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
19107
19108 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
19109 @section Combinatorial Functions
19110
19111 @noindent
19112 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
19113 @kbd{k} key prefix.
19114
19115 @kindex k g
19116 @pindex calc-gcd
19117 @tindex gcd
19118 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19119 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19120 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19121 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19122 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19123 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19124 the operation is left in symbolic form.
19125
19126 @kindex k l
19127 @pindex calc-lcm
19128 @tindex lcm
19129 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19130 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19131 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19132 numbers.
19133
19134 @kindex k E
19135 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19136 @tindex egcd
19137 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19138 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19139 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19140 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19141 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19142
19143 @kindex !
19144 @pindex calc-factorial
19145 @tindex fact
19146 @ignore
19147 @mindex @null
19148 @end ignore
19149 @tindex !
19150 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19151 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19152 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19153 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19154 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19155 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19156 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19157 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19158 the commands in this section.
19159
19160 @kindex k d
19161 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19162 @tindex dfact
19163 @ignore
19164 @mindex @null
19165 @end ignore
19166 @tindex !!
19167 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19168 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19169 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19170 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19171 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19172 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19173 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19174
19175 @kindex k c
19176 @pindex calc-choose
19177 @tindex choose
19178 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19179 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19180 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19181 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19182 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19183 real numbers by
19184 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19185 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19186
19187 @kindex H k c
19188 @pindex calc-perm
19189 @tindex perm
19190 @ifnottex
19191 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19192 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19193 @end ifnottex
19194 @tex
19195 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19196 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19197 @end tex
19198
19199 @kindex k b
19200 @kindex H k b
19201 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19202 @tindex bern
19203 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19204 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19205 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19206 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19207 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19208 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19209 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19210
19211 @kindex k e
19212 @kindex H k e
19213 @pindex calc-euler-number
19214 @tindex euler
19215 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19216 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19217 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19218 functions.
19219
19220 @kindex k s
19221 @kindex H k s
19222 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19223 @tindex stir1
19224 @tindex stir2
19225 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19226 computes a Stirling number of the first
19227 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19228 @infoline kind,
19229 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19230 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19231 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19232 @infoline kind.
19233 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19234 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19235 non-empty sets, respectively.
19236
19237 @kindex k p
19238 @pindex calc-prime-test
19239 @cindex Primes
19240 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19241 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19242 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19243 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19244 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19245 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19246 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19247 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19248 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19249 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19250 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19251 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19252 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19253
19254 @ignore
19255 @starindex
19256 @end ignore
19257 @tindex prime
19258 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19259 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19260 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19261 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19262 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19263 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19264
19265 @kindex k f
19266 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19267 @tindex prfac
19268 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19269 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19270 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19271 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19272 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19273 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19274 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19275 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19276 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19277
19278 @kindex k n
19279 @pindex calc-next-prime
19280 @ignore
19281 @mindex nextpr@idots
19282 @end ignore
19283 @tindex nextprime
19284 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19285 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19286 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19287 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19288 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19289 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19290 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19291 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19292 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19293 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19294 prime.
19295
19296 @kindex I k n
19297 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19298 @ignore
19299 @mindex prevpr@idots
19300 @end ignore
19301 @tindex prevprime
19302 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19303 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19304
19305 @kindex k t
19306 @pindex calc-totient
19307 @tindex totient
19308 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19309 Euler ``totient''
19310 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19311 @infoline function,
19312 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19313 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19314
19315 @kindex k m
19316 @pindex calc-moebius
19317 @tindex moebius
19318 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19319 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19320 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19321 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19322 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19323 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19324 the result is zero.
19325
19326 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19327 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19328
19329 @noindent
19330 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19331 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19332 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19333 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19334 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19335 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19336 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19337 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19338
19339 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19340 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19341 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19342 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19343 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19344 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19345
19346 @kindex k B
19347 @kindex I k B
19348 @pindex calc-utpb
19349 @tindex utpb
19350 @tindex ltpb
19351 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19352 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19353 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19354 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19355 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19356 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19357 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19358
19359 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19360 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19361 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19362 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19363 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19364 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19365 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19366 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19367 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19368 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19369 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19370
19371 @kindex k C
19372 @pindex calc-utpc
19373 @tindex utpc
19374 @ignore
19375 @mindex @idots
19376 @end ignore
19377 @kindex I k C
19378 @ignore
19379 @mindex @null
19380 @end ignore
19381 @tindex ltpc
19382 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19383 @texline @math{\nu}
19384 @infoline @expr{v}
19385 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19386 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19387
19388 @kindex k F
19389 @pindex calc-utpf
19390 @tindex utpf
19391 @ignore
19392 @mindex @idots
19393 @end ignore
19394 @kindex I k F
19395 @ignore
19396 @mindex @null
19397 @end ignore
19398 @tindex ltpf
19399 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19400 various statistical tests. The parameters
19401 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19402 @infoline @expr{v1}
19403 and
19404 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19405 @infoline @expr{v2}
19406 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19407 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19408
19409 @kindex k N
19410 @pindex calc-utpn
19411 @tindex utpn
19412 @ignore
19413 @mindex @idots
19414 @end ignore
19415 @kindex I k N
19416 @ignore
19417 @mindex @null
19418 @end ignore
19419 @tindex ltpn
19420 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19421 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19422 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19423 @infoline @expr{s}.
19424 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19425 would exceed @expr{x}.
19426
19427 @kindex k P
19428 @pindex calc-utpp
19429 @tindex utpp
19430 @ignore
19431 @mindex @idots
19432 @end ignore
19433 @kindex I k P
19434 @ignore
19435 @mindex @null
19436 @end ignore
19437 @tindex ltpp
19438 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19439 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19440 Poisson random events will occur.
19441
19442 @kindex k T
19443 @pindex calc-ltpt
19444 @tindex utpt
19445 @ignore
19446 @mindex @idots
19447 @end ignore
19448 @kindex I k T
19449 @ignore
19450 @mindex @null
19451 @end ignore
19452 @tindex ltpt
19453 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19454 with
19455 @texline @math{\nu}
19456 @infoline @expr{v}
19457 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19458 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19459 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19460 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19461 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19462 where
19463 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19464 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19465 and
19466 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19467 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19468 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19469 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19470
19471 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19472 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19473 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19474 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19475 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19476
19477 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19478 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19479
19480 @noindent
19481 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19482 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19483 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19484 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19485 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19486
19487 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19488 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19489 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19490 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19491 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19492
19493 @menu
19494 * Packing and Unpacking::
19495 * Building Vectors::
19496 * Extracting Elements::
19497 * Manipulating Vectors::
19498 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19499 * Set Operations::
19500 * Statistical Operations::
19501 * Reducing and Mapping::
19502 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19503 @end menu
19504
19505 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19506 @section Packing and Unpacking
19507
19508 @noindent
19509 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19510 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19511 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19512 vectors.
19513
19514 @kindex v p
19515 @kindex V p
19516 @pindex calc-pack
19517 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19518 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19519 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19520 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19521 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19522 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19523 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19524 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19525
19526 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19527 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19528 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19529 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19530
19531 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19532
19533 @table @cite
19534 @item -1
19535 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19536 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19537 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19538 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19539 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19540 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19541 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19542 components are not suitable.)
19543
19544 @item -2
19545 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19546 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19547 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19548 mode.
19549
19550 @item -3
19551 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19552 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19553 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19554 number.
19555
19556 @item -4
19557 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19558 may be real numbers or formulas.
19559
19560 @item -5
19561 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19562 must be real numbers.
19563
19564 @item -6
19565 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19566 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19567
19568 @item -7
19569 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19570
19571 @item -8
19572 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19573
19574 @item -9
19575 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19576
19577 @item -10
19578 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19579
19580 @item -11
19581 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19582 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19583 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19584 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19585
19586 @item -12
19587 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19588 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19589 is desired.
19590
19591 @item -13
19592 A real number is converted into a date form.
19593
19594 @item -14
19595 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19596
19597 @item -15
19598 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19599 @end table
19600
19601 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19602 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19603 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19604 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19605 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19606 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19607 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19608 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19609 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19610 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19611
19612 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19613 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19614 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19615 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19616 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19617
19618 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19619 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19620 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19621 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19622 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19623
19624 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19625 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19626 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19627 @texline @math{2\times3}
19628 @infoline 2x3
19629 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19630 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19631 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19632
19633 @ignore
19634 @starindex
19635 @end ignore
19636 @tindex pack
19637 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19638 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19639 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19640 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19641 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19642 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19643 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19644 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19645 by the mode.
19646
19647 @kindex v u
19648 @kindex V u
19649 @pindex calc-unpack
19650 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19651 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19652 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19653 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19654 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19655 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19656
19657 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19658 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19659 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19660 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19661 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19662 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19663 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19664
19665 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19666 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19667 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19668 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19669 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19670 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19671 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19672 is not a composite object.
19673
19674 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19675 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19676 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19677 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19678 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19679 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19680 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19681 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19682
19683 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19684 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19685 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19686 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19687 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19688 original object.
19689
19690 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19691 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19692 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19693 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19694
19695 @ignore
19696 @starindex
19697 @end ignore
19698 @tindex unpack
19699 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19700 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19701 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19702 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19703 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19704 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19705
19706 @ignore
19707 @starindex
19708 @end ignore
19709 @tindex unpackt
19710 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19711 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19712 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19713 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19714 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19715 The identity for re-building the original object is
19716 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19717 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19718 name and a vector of arguments.)
19719
19720 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19721 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19722 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19723 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19724
19725 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19726 @section Building Vectors
19727
19728 @noindent
19729 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19730 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19731
19732 @kindex |
19733 @pindex calc-concat
19734 @ignore
19735 @mindex @null
19736 @end ignore
19737 @tindex |
19738 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19739 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19740 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19741 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19742 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19743 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19744
19745 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19746 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19747 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19748 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19749 one-row matrix.
19750
19751 @kindex H |
19752 @tindex append
19753 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19754 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19755 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19756 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19757 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19758
19759 @kindex I |
19760 @kindex H I |
19761 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19762 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19763 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19764
19765 @kindex v d
19766 @kindex V d
19767 @pindex calc-diag
19768 @tindex diag
19769 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19770 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19771 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19772 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19773 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19774 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19775 the prefix argument is required.
19776
19777 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19778 @texline @math{3\times3}
19779 @infoline 3x3
19780 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19781 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19782 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19783
19784 @kindex v i
19785 @kindex V i
19786 @pindex calc-ident
19787 @tindex idn
19788 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19789 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19790 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19791 this command prompts for one.
19792
19793 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19794 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19795 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19796 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19797 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19798 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19799 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19800 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19801 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19802 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19803 dimensions.
19804
19805 @kindex v x
19806 @kindex V x
19807 @pindex calc-index
19808 @tindex index
19809 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19810 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19811 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19812 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19813 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19814
19815 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19816 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19817 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19818 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19819 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19820 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19821 of numbers or formulas.
19822
19823 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19824 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19825 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19826 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19827 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19828 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19829
19830 @kindex v b
19831 @kindex V b
19832 @pindex calc-build-vector
19833 @tindex cvec
19834 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19835 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19836 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19837 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19838 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19839 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19840
19841 @kindex v h
19842 @kindex V h
19843 @kindex I v h
19844 @kindex I V h
19845 @pindex calc-head
19846 @pindex calc-tail
19847 @tindex head
19848 @tindex tail
19849 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19850 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19851 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19852 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19853
19854 @kindex v k
19855 @kindex V k
19856 @pindex calc-cons
19857 @tindex cons
19858 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19859 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19860 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19861 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19862 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19863
19864 @kindex H v h
19865 @kindex H V h
19866 @tindex rhead
19867 @ignore
19868 @mindex @idots
19869 @end ignore
19870 @kindex H I v h
19871 @kindex H I V h
19872 @ignore
19873 @mindex @null
19874 @end ignore
19875 @kindex H v k
19876 @kindex H V k
19877 @ignore
19878 @mindex @null
19879 @end ignore
19880 @tindex rtail
19881 @ignore
19882 @mindex @null
19883 @end ignore
19884 @tindex rcons
19885 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19886 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19887 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19888 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19889 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19890 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19891 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19892
19893 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19894 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19895
19896 @noindent
19897 @kindex v r
19898 @kindex V r
19899 @pindex calc-mrow
19900 @tindex mrow
19901 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19902 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19903 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19904 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19905 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19906 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19907
19908 @cindex Permutations, applying
19909 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19910 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19911 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19912 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19913 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19914 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19915
19916 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19917 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19918 submatrix is returned.
19919
19920 @cindex Subscript notation
19921 @kindex a _
19922 @pindex calc-subscript
19923 @tindex subscr
19924 @tindex _
19925 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19926 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19927 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19928 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19929 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19930 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19931 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19932 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19933 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19934 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19935
19936 @tindex mrrow
19937 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19938 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19939 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19940 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19941 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19942
19943 @tindex getdiag
19944 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19945 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19946 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19947
19948 @kindex v c
19949 @kindex V c
19950 @pindex calc-mcol
19951 @tindex mcol
19952 @tindex mrcol
19953 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19954 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19955 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19956 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19957 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19958 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19959
19960 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19961 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19962 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19963 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19964 of matrix @expr{m}.
19965
19966 @kindex v s
19967 @kindex V s
19968 @pindex calc-subvector
19969 @tindex subvec
19970 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19971 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19972 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19973 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19974 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19975 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19976 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19977 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19978
19979 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19980 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19981 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19982 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19983 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19984 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19985 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19986
19987 @kindex I v s
19988 @kindex I V s
19989 @tindex rsubvec
19990 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19991 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19992 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19993 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19994 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19995
19996 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19997 vectors one element at a time.
19998
19999 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
20000 @section Manipulating Vectors
20001
20002 @noindent
20003 @kindex v l
20004 @kindex V l
20005 @pindex calc-vlength
20006 @tindex vlen
20007 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
20008 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
20009 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
20010 command.
20011
20012 @kindex H v l
20013 @kindex H V l
20014 @tindex mdims
20015 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
20016 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
20017 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
20018 its argument is a
20019 @texline @math{2\times3}
20020 @infoline 2x3
20021 matrix.
20022
20023 @kindex v f
20024 @kindex V f
20025 @pindex calc-vector-find
20026 @tindex find
20027 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
20028 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
20029 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
20030 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
20031 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
20032 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
20033
20034 @kindex v a
20035 @kindex V a
20036 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
20037 @tindex arrange
20038 @cindex Arranging a matrix
20039 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
20040 @cindex Flattening a matrix
20041 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
20042 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
20043 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
20044 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
20045 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
20046 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
20047 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
20048 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
20049 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
20050 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
20051 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
20052 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
20053 @texline @math{1\times4}
20054 @infoline 1x4
20055 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
20056 @texline @math{4\times1}
20057 @infoline 4x1
20058 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
20059 @texline @math{2\times2}
20060 @infoline 2x2
20061 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
20062 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
20063 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
20064
20065 @cindex Sorting data
20066 @kindex v S
20067 @kindex V S
20068 @kindex I v S
20069 @kindex I V S
20070 @pindex calc-sort
20071 @tindex sort
20072 @tindex rsort
20073 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
20074 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
20075 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
20076 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
20077 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
20078 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
20079 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
20080 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
20081 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
20082 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
20083 alphabetical order by this command.
20084
20085 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
20086
20087 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
20088 @cindex Inverse of permutation
20089 @cindex Index tables
20090 @cindex Rank tables
20091 @kindex v G
20092 @kindex V G
20093 @kindex I v G
20094 @kindex I V G
20095 @pindex calc-grade
20096 @tindex grade
20097 @tindex rgrade
20098 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
20099 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
20100 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
20101 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
20102 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
20103 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
20104 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
20105 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
20106 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
20107 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
20108 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
20109 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
20110 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
20111
20112 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
20113 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
20114 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
20115 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
20116 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
20117 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
20118 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
20119 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
20120 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
20121 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
20122 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
20123
20124 @cindex Histograms
20125 @kindex v H
20126 @kindex V H
20127 @pindex calc-histogram
20128 @ignore
20129 @mindex histo@idots
20130 @end ignore
20131 @tindex histogram
20132 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20133 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20134 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20135 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20136 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20137 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20138 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20139 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20140 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20141 input vector.)
20142
20143 If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20144 will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20145 this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20146 prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20147 the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20148 @expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20149 @expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20150 this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20151 original vector are in each bin.
20152
20153 The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20154 each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20155 elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20156
20157 @kindex H v H
20158 @kindex H V H
20159 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20160 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20161 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20162 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20163 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20164 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20165
20166 @kindex v t
20167 @kindex V t
20168 @pindex calc-transpose
20169 @tindex trn
20170 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20171 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20172 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20173 a one-column matrix.
20174
20175 @kindex v v
20176 @kindex V v
20177 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20178 @tindex rev
20179 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20180 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20181 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20182 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20183 a matrix.)
20184
20185 @kindex v m
20186 @kindex V m
20187 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20188 @tindex vmask
20189 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20190 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20191 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20192 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20193 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20194 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20195 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20196 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20197
20198 @kindex v e
20199 @kindex V e
20200 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20201 @tindex vexp
20202 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20203 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20204 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20205 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20206 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20207 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20208 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20209 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20210 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20211
20212 @kindex H v e
20213 @kindex H V e
20214 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20215 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20216 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20217 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20218 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20219 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20220 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20221 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20222 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20223
20224 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20225 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20226 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20227 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20228 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20229 masking using vectors.
20230
20231 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20232 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20233
20234 @noindent
20235 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20236 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20237 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20238 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20239 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20240
20241 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20242 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20243 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20244 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20245
20246 @kindex v J
20247 @kindex V J
20248 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20249 @tindex ctrn
20250 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20251 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20252
20253 @ignore
20254 @mindex A
20255 @end ignore
20256 @kindex A (vectors)
20257 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20258 @ignore
20259 @mindex abs
20260 @end ignore
20261 @tindex abs (vectors)
20262 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20263 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20264 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20265 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20266 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20267 from that point to the origin.
20268
20269 @kindex v n
20270 @kindex V n
20271 @pindex calc-rnorm
20272 @tindex rnorm
20273 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20274 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20275 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20276 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20277 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20278
20279 @kindex v N
20280 @kindex V N
20281 @pindex calc-cnorm
20282 @tindex cnorm
20283 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20284 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20285 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20286 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20287 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20288 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20289 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20290
20291 @kindex v C
20292 @kindex V C
20293 @pindex calc-cross
20294 @tindex cross
20295 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20296 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20297 exactly three elements.
20298
20299 @ignore
20300 @mindex &
20301 @end ignore
20302 @kindex & (matrices)
20303 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20304 @ignore
20305 @mindex inv
20306 @end ignore
20307 @tindex inv (matrices)
20308 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20309 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20310 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20311 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20312 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20313 quickly in the future.
20314
20315 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20316 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20317 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20318 by a matrix.
20319
20320 @kindex v D
20321 @kindex V D
20322 @pindex calc-mdet
20323 @tindex det
20324 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20325 determinant of a square matrix.
20326
20327 @kindex v L
20328 @kindex V L
20329 @pindex calc-mlud
20330 @tindex lud
20331 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20332 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20333 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20334 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20335 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20336 and the third is upper-triangular.
20337
20338 @kindex v T
20339 @kindex V T
20340 @pindex calc-mtrace
20341 @tindex tr
20342 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20343 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20344 elements of the matrix.
20345
20346 @kindex v K
20347 @kindex V K
20348 @pindex calc-kron
20349 @tindex kron
20350 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20351 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20352
20353 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20354 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20355
20356 @noindent
20357 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20358 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20359 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20360 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20361 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20362 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20363 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20364 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20365 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20366 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20367 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20368 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20369 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20370
20371 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20372 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20373 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20374 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20375 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20376 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20377
20378 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20379 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20380 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20381 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20382
20383 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20384 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20385 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20386
20387 @kindex v +
20388 @kindex V +
20389 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20390 @tindex rdup
20391 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20392 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20393 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20394 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20395 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20396 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20397 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20398 them.
20399
20400 @kindex v V
20401 @kindex V V
20402 @pindex calc-set-union
20403 @tindex vunion
20404 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20405 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20406 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20407 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20408 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20409
20410 @kindex v ^
20411 @kindex V ^
20412 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20413 @tindex vint
20414 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20415 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20416 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20417 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20418 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20419 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20420 notation for set
20421 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20422 @infoline union
20423 and
20424 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20425 @infoline intersection.
20426
20427 @kindex v -
20428 @kindex V -
20429 @pindex calc-set-difference
20430 @tindex vdiff
20431 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20432 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20433 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20434 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20435 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20436 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20437 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20438 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20439 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20440 enough to express in a few intervals).
20441
20442 @kindex v X
20443 @kindex V X
20444 @pindex calc-set-xor
20445 @tindex vxor
20446 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20447 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20448 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20449 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20450 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20451
20452 @kindex v ~
20453 @kindex V ~
20454 @pindex calc-set-complement
20455 @tindex vcompl
20456 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20457 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20458 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20459 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20460 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20461
20462 @kindex v F
20463 @kindex V F
20464 @pindex calc-set-floor
20465 @tindex vfloor
20466 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20467 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20468 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20469 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20470 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20471 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20472 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20473 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20474
20475 @kindex v E
20476 @kindex V E
20477 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20478 @tindex venum
20479 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20480 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20481 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20482 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20483 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20484
20485 @kindex v :
20486 @kindex V :
20487 @pindex calc-set-span
20488 @tindex vspan
20489 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20490 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20491 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20492 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20493 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20494
20495 @kindex v #
20496 @kindex V #
20497 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20498 @tindex vcard
20499 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20500 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20501 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20502 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20503
20504 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20505 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20506 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20507 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20508 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20509 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20510 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20511 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20512 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20513 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20514 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20515 convenient to you.
20516
20517 @kindex b p
20518 @kindex b u
20519 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20520 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20521 @tindex vpack
20522 @tindex vunpack
20523 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20524 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20525 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20526 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20527 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20528 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20529 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20530 (binary) prefix key.
20531
20532 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20533 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20534 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20535 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20536 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20537 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20538 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20539 representation
20540 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20541 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20542
20543 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20544 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20545
20546 @noindent
20547 @cindex Statistical functions
20548 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20549 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20550 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20551 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20552 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20553 Vetterling.
20554
20555 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20556 a shifted letter or other character.
20557
20558 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20559 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20560
20561 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20562 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20563
20564 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20565 probability distribution functions.
20566
20567 @menu
20568 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20569 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20570 @end menu
20571
20572 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20573 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20574
20575 @noindent
20576 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20577 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20578 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20579 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20580 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20581 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20582 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20583
20584 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20585 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20586 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20587 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20588
20589 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20590 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20591 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20592 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20593 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20594 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20595 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20596
20597 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20598 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20599 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20600 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20601 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20602 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20603 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20604 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20605 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20606 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20607
20608 @kindex u #
20609 @pindex calc-vector-count
20610 @tindex vcount
20611 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20612 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20613 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20614 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20615 simply computes the length of the vector.
20616
20617 @kindex u +
20618 @kindex u *
20619 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20620 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20621 @tindex vsum
20622 @tindex vprod
20623 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20624 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20625 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20626 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20627 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20628 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20629 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20630
20631 @kindex u X
20632 @kindex u N
20633 @pindex calc-vector-max
20634 @pindex calc-vector-min
20635 @tindex vmax
20636 @tindex vmin
20637 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20638 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20639 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20640 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20641 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20642 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20643 plus or minus infinity.
20644
20645 @kindex u M
20646 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20647 @tindex vmean
20648 @cindex Mean of data values
20649 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20650 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20651 If the inputs are error forms
20652 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20653 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20654 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20655 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20656 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20657 @tex
20658 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20659 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20660 @end tex
20661 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20662 values divided by the count of the values.
20663
20664 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20665 error
20666 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20667 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20668 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20669 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20670 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20671 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20672 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20673 weight is completely negligible.)
20674
20675 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20676 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20677 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20678 and maximum values of the interval.
20679
20680 @kindex I u M
20681 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20682 @tindex vmeane
20683 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20684 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20685 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20686 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20687 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20688 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20689 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20690 @tex
20691 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20692 @end tex
20693 If the inputs are plain
20694 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20695 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20696 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20697 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20698 deviation.)
20699 @tex
20700 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20701 @end tex
20702
20703 @kindex H u M
20704 @pindex calc-vector-median
20705 @tindex vmedian
20706 @cindex Median of data values
20707 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20708 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20709 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20710 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20711 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20712 The median function is different from the other functions in
20713 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20714 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20715 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20716 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20717 ignored.
20718
20719 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20720 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20721 the same as the mean.
20722
20723 @kindex H I u M
20724 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20725 @tindex vhmean
20726 @cindex Harmonic mean
20727 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20728 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20729 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20730 of the values.
20731 @tex
20732 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20733 @end tex
20734
20735 @kindex u G
20736 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20737 @tindex vgmean
20738 @cindex Geometric mean
20739 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20740 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20741 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20742 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20743 of the data values.
20744 @tex
20745 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20746 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20747 @end tex
20748
20749 @kindex H u G
20750 @tindex agmean
20751 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20752 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20753 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20754 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20755 @tex
20756 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20757 @end tex
20758
20759 @c @cindex Root-mean-square
20760 @c Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20761 @c for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20762
20763 @kindex u S
20764 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20765 @tindex vsdev
20766 @cindex Standard deviation
20767 @cindex Sample statistics
20768 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20769 computes the standard
20770 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20771 @infoline deviation
20772 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20773 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20774 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20775 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20776 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20777 @tex
20778 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20779 @end tex
20780
20781 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20782 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20783 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20784 limits, divided by
20785 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20786 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20787 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20788 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20789
20790 @kindex I u S
20791 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20792 @tindex vpsdev
20793 @cindex Population statistics
20794 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20795 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20796 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20797 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20798 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20799 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20800 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20801 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20802 only an estimate of the true mean.
20803 @tex
20804 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20805 @end tex
20806
20807 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20808 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20809 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20810
20811 @kindex H u S
20812 @kindex H I u S
20813 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20814 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20815 @tindex vvar
20816 @tindex vpvar
20817 @cindex Variance of data values
20818 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20819 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20820 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20821 is the
20822 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20823 @infoline square
20824 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20825 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20826 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20827
20828 @ignore
20829 @starindex
20830 @end ignore
20831 @tindex vflat
20832 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20833 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20834 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20835 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20836
20837 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20838 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20839
20840 @noindent
20841 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20842 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20843 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20844 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20845 the stack, which must be an
20846 @texline @math{N\times2}
20847 @infoline Nx2
20848 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20849 of actual vectors and matrices.
20850
20851 @kindex u C
20852 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20853 @tindex vcov
20854 @cindex Covariance
20855 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20856 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20857 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20858 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20859 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20860 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20861 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20862 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20863 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20864 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20865 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20866 input errors.
20867 @tex
20868 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20869 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20870 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20871 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20872 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20873 $$
20874 @end tex
20875
20876 @kindex I u C
20877 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20878 @tindex vpcov
20879 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20880 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20881 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20882 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20883
20884 @kindex H u C
20885 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20886 @tindex vcorr
20887 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20888 @cindex Linear correlation
20889 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20890 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20891 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20892 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20893 between sample or population statistics here.)
20894 @tex
20895 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20896 @end tex
20897
20898 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20899 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20900
20901 @noindent
20902 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20903 elements of vectors.
20904
20905 @kindex v A
20906 @kindex V A
20907 @pindex calc-apply
20908 @tindex apply
20909 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20910 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20911 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20912 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20913 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20914 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20915 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20916
20917 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20918 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20919
20920 @menu
20921 * Specifying Operators::
20922 * Mapping::
20923 * Reducing::
20924 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20925 * Generalized Products::
20926 @end menu
20927
20928 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20929 @subsection Specifying Operators
20930
20931 @noindent
20932 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20933 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20934 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20935 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20936 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20937 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20938 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20939 element as its argument.)
20940
20941 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20942 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20943 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20944 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20945 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20946 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20947 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20948 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20949 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20950 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20951 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20952 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20953 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20954 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20955 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20956
20957 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20958 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20959 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20960 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20961 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20962 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20963 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20964 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20965 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20966 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20967
20968 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20969 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20970 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20971 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20972 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20973 entry interacts with the stack.)
20974
20975 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20976 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20977 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20978 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20979 prompted for an argument list.
20980
20981 @cindex Nameless functions
20982 @cindex Generic functions
20983 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20984 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20985 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20986 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20987 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20988 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20989 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20990 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20991 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20992 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20993 can get it back later if you wish.
20994
20995 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20996 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20997 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20998 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20999 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
21000
21001 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
21002 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
21003 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
21004 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
21005 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
21006 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
21007 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
21008
21009 @cindex Lambda expressions
21010 @ignore
21011 @starindex
21012 @end ignore
21013 @tindex lambda
21014 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
21015 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
21016 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
21017 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
21018 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
21019 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
21020 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
21021
21022 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
21023 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
21024 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
21025 called.)
21026
21027 @tindex add
21028 @tindex sub
21029 @ignore
21030 @mindex @idots
21031 @end ignore
21032 @tindex mul
21033 @ignore
21034 @mindex @null
21035 @end ignore
21036 @tindex div
21037 @ignore
21038 @mindex @null
21039 @end ignore
21040 @tindex pow
21041 @ignore
21042 @mindex @null
21043 @end ignore
21044 @tindex neg
21045 @ignore
21046 @mindex @null
21047 @end ignore
21048 @tindex mod
21049 @ignore
21050 @mindex @null
21051 @end ignore
21052 @tindex vconcat
21053 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
21054 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
21055 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
21056 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
21057 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
21058 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
21059 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
21060 @code{vconcat}.
21061
21062 @ignore
21063 @starindex
21064 @end ignore
21065 @tindex call
21066 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
21067 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
21068 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
21069 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
21070 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
21071 as @samp{x + 2y}).
21072
21073 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
21074 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
21075 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
21076 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
21077 about it.)
21078
21079 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
21080 @subsection Mapping
21081
21082 @noindent
21083 @kindex v M
21084 @kindex V M
21085 @pindex calc-map
21086 @tindex map
21087 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
21088 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
21089 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
21090 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
21091 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
21092 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
21093 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
21094 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
21095 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
21096 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
21097 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
21098 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
21099
21100 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
21101 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
21102 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
21103 produce another
21104 @texline @math{3\times2}
21105 @infoline 3x2
21106 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
21107
21108 @tindex mapr
21109 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
21110 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
21111 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
21112 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
21113 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
21114 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
21115 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
21116 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
21117 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
21118
21119 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
21120 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
21121 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
21122 their individual elements.
21123
21124 @tindex mapc
21125 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21126 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21127 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21128 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21129 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21130 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21131
21132 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21133 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21134 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21135 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21136
21137 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21138 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21139 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21140 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21141 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21142 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21143
21144 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21145 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21146 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21147 column.
21148
21149 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21150 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21151 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21152 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21153 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21154 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21155 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21156 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21157 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21158 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21159
21160 @tindex mapa
21161 @tindex mapd
21162 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21163 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21164 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21165 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21166 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21167 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21168 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21169 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21170
21171 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21172 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21173 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21174 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21175
21176 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21177 @subsection Reducing
21178
21179 @noindent
21180 @kindex v R
21181 @kindex V R
21182 @pindex calc-reduce
21183 @tindex reduce
21184 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21185 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21186 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21187 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21188 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21189 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21190 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21191 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21192
21193 @kindex I v R
21194 @kindex I V R
21195 @tindex rreduce
21196 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21197 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21198 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21199 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21200 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21201 in power series expansions.
21202
21203 @kindex v U
21204 @kindex V U
21205 @tindex accum
21206 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21207 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21208 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21209 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21210 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21211 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21212
21213 @kindex I v U
21214 @kindex I V U
21215 @tindex raccum
21216 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21217 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21218 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21219
21220 @tindex reducea
21221 @tindex rreducea
21222 @tindex reduced
21223 @tindex rreduced
21224 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21225 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21226 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21227 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21228 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21229 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21230 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21231 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21232 b + e, c + f]}.
21233
21234 @tindex reducer
21235 @tindex rreducer
21236 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21237 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21238 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21239 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21240 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21241 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21242 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21243
21244 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21245 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21246
21247 @tindex reducec
21248 @tindex rreducec
21249 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21250 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21251
21252 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21253 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21254 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21255 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21256
21257 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21258 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21259
21260 @noindent
21261 @kindex H v R
21262 @kindex H V R
21263 @tindex nest
21264 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21265 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21266 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21267 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21268 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21269 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21270 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21271
21272 @kindex H v U
21273 @kindex H V U
21274 @tindex anest
21275 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21276 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21277 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21278 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21279 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21280
21281 @kindex H I v R
21282 @kindex H I V R
21283 @tindex fixp
21284 @cindex Fixed points
21285 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21286 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21287 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21288 no longer changes.
21289
21290 @kindex H I v U
21291 @kindex H I V U
21292 @tindex afixp
21293 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21294 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21295 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21296 by @code{fixp}.
21297
21298 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21299 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21300 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21301 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21302 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21303 to converge to 0.739085.)
21304
21305 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21306 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21307 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21308 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21309 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21310 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21311 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21312
21313 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21314 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21315 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21316 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21317 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21318 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21319 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21320 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21321
21322 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21323 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21324 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21325 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21326 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21327 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21328 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21329 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21330 exactly equal.)
21331
21332 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21333 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21334 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21335 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21336
21337 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21338 @subsection Generalized Products
21339
21340 @kindex v O
21341 @kindex V O
21342 @pindex calc-outer-product
21343 @tindex outer
21344 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21345 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21346 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21347 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21348 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21349 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21350 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21351
21352 @kindex v I
21353 @kindex V I
21354 @pindex calc-inner-product
21355 @tindex inner
21356 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21357 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21358 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21359 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21360 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21361 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21362 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21363 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21364 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21365 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21366 generalized dot product.
21367
21368 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21369 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21370 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21371 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21372 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21373
21374 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21375 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21376
21377 @noindent
21378 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21379 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21380 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21381 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21382 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21383 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21384
21385 @kindex v <
21386 @kindex V <
21387 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21388 @kindex v =
21389 @kindex V =
21390 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21391 @kindex v >
21392 @kindex V >
21393 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21394 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21395 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21396 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21397 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21398
21399 @kindex v [
21400 @kindex V [
21401 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21402 @kindex v @{
21403 @kindex V @{
21404 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21405 @kindex v (
21406 @kindex V (
21407 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21408 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21409 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21410 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21411 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21412 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21413 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21414 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21415 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21416 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21417 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21418
21419 @kindex V ]
21420 @kindex v ]
21421 @kindex V )
21422 @kindex v )
21423 @kindex V @}
21424 @kindex v @}
21425 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21426 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21427 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21428 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21429 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21430 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21431 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21432 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21433 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21434 Here are some example matrices:
21435
21436 @example
21437 @group
21438 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21439 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21440 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21441
21442 RO ROC
21443
21444 @end group
21445 @end example
21446 @noindent
21447 @example
21448 @group
21449 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21450 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21451 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21452
21453 O OC
21454
21455 @end group
21456 @end example
21457 @noindent
21458 @example
21459 @group
21460 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21461 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21462 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21463
21464 R @r{blank}
21465 @end group
21466 @end example
21467
21468 @noindent
21469 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21470 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21471 the others are useful for display only.
21472
21473 @kindex v ,
21474 @kindex V ,
21475 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21476 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21477 off in vector and matrix display.
21478
21479 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21480 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21481 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21482 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21483 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21484 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21485 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21486 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21487 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21488
21489 @kindex v .
21490 @kindex V .
21491 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21492 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21493 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21494 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21495 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21496 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21497 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21498 improve Calc's display speed.
21499
21500 @kindex t .
21501 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21502 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21503 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21504 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21505 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21506 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21507 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21508 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21509 that involve the trail.
21510
21511 @kindex v /
21512 @kindex V /
21513 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21514 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21515 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21516 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21517 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21518 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21519 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21520
21521 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21522 @chapter Algebra
21523
21524 @noindent
21525 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21526 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21527 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21528 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21529 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21530 is discussed.
21531
21532 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21533 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21534 for anything else'') prefix.
21535
21536 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21537 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21538
21539 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21540 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21541 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21542 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21543 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21544 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21545 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21546
21547 @menu
21548 * Selecting Subformulas::
21549 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21550 * Simplifying Formulas::
21551 * Polynomials::
21552 * Calculus::
21553 * Solving Equations::
21554 * Numerical Solutions::
21555 * Curve Fitting::
21556 * Summations::
21557 * Logical Operations::
21558 * Rewrite Rules::
21559 @end menu
21560
21561 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21562 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21563
21564 @noindent
21565 @cindex Selections
21566 @cindex Sub-formulas
21567 @cindex Parts of formulas
21568 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21569 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21570 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21571 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21572 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21573 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21574
21575 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21576 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21577 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21578
21579 @menu
21580 * Making Selections::
21581 * Changing Selections::
21582 * Displaying Selections::
21583 * Operating on Selections::
21584 * Rearranging with Selections::
21585 @end menu
21586
21587 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21588 @subsection Making Selections
21589
21590 @noindent
21591 @kindex j s
21592 @pindex calc-select-here
21593 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21594 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21595 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21596 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21597 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21598 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21599 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21600
21601 @smallexample
21602 @group
21603 3 ___
21604 (a + b) + V c
21605 1: ---------------
21606 2 x + 1
21607 @end group
21608 @end smallexample
21609
21610 @noindent
21611 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21612 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21613 to
21614
21615 @smallexample
21616 @group
21617 . ...
21618 .. . b. . . .
21619 1* ...............
21620 . . . .
21621 @end group
21622 @end smallexample
21623
21624 @noindent
21625 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21626 to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21627 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-@code{nil}, then the characters
21628 not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21629 noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21630 The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21631 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21632 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21633 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21634 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21635
21636 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21637 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21638
21639 @smallexample
21640 @group
21641 . ...
21642 (a + b) . . .
21643 1* ...............
21644 . . . .
21645 @end group
21646 @end smallexample
21647
21648 @noindent
21649 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21650 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21651 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21652 would have had the same effect.
21653
21654 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21655 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21656 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21657 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21658
21659 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21660 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21661 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21662 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21663 and so on.
21664
21665 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21666 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21667
21668 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21669 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21670 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21671 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21672 cursor on any stack entry.
21673
21674 @kindex j a
21675 @pindex calc-select-additional
21676 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21677 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21678 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21679 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21680 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21681 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21682
21683 @kindex j o
21684 @pindex calc-select-once
21685 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21686 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21687 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21688 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21689 by the cursor.
21690
21691 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21692 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21693 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21694 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21695
21696 @kindex j S
21697 @kindex j O
21698 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21699 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21700 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21701 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21702 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21703 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21704 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21705 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21706 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21707 commands.
21708
21709 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21710 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21711 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21712 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21713 entire four-term sum.
21714
21715 @kindex j b
21716 @pindex calc-break-selections
21717 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21718 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21719 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21720 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21721 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21722 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21723 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21724 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21725 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21726 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21727 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21728 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21729 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21730
21731 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21732 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21733 you get.
21734
21735 @kindex j u
21736 @pindex calc-unselect
21737 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21738 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21739 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21740 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21741 position.
21742
21743 @kindex j c
21744 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21745 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21746 stack elements.
21747
21748 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21749 @subsection Changing Selections
21750
21751 @noindent
21752 @kindex j m
21753 @pindex calc-select-more
21754 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21755 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21756 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21757
21758 @smallexample
21759 @group
21760 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21761 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21762 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21763 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21764 @end group
21765 @end smallexample
21766
21767 @noindent
21768 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21769 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21770 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21771
21772 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21773 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21774 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21775 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21776 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21777
21778 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21779 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21780 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21781 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21782
21783 @kindex j l
21784 @pindex calc-select-less
21785 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21786 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21787 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21788 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21789 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21790
21791 @kindex j 1-9
21792 @pindex calc-select-part
21793 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21794 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21795 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21796 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21797 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21798 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21799 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21800 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21801
21802 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21803 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21804 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21805 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21806 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21807
21808 @kindex j n
21809 @kindex j p
21810 @pindex calc-select-next
21811 @pindex calc-select-previous
21812 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21813 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21814 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21815 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21816 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21817 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21818 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21819 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21820 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21821 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21822
21823 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21824 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21825 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21826
21827 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21828 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21829 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21830 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21831 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21832 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21833 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21834 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21835 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21836
21837 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21838 @subsection Displaying Selections
21839
21840 @noindent
21841 @kindex j d
21842 @pindex calc-show-selections
21843 @vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21844 @vindex calc-selected-face
21845 @vindex calc-nonselected-face
21846 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21847 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21848 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21849 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21850 by @samp{#} signs:
21851
21852 @smallexample
21853 @group
21854 3 ... # ___
21855 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21856 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21857 . . . . 2 x + 1
21858 @end group
21859 @end smallexample
21860 If the customizable variable
21861 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-@code{nil}, then the
21862 non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21863 less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21864 and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21865 noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21866 signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
21867
21868 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21869 @subsection Operating on Selections
21870
21871 @noindent
21872 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21873 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21874 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21875 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21876 given stack element.)
21877
21878 @kindex j e
21879 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21880 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21881 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21882 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21883 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21884 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21885 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21886
21887 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21888 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21889 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21890 element.
21891
21892 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21893 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21894 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21895 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21896 portion to the top of the stack.
21897
21898 @smallexample
21899 @group
21900 3 ... ... ___
21901 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21902 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21903 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21904
21905 3 3
21906 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21907 @end group
21908 @end smallexample
21909
21910 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21911 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21912 the complete, edited formula.
21913
21914 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21915 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21916
21917 @kindex j '
21918 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21919 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21920 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21921 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21922 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21923 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21924 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21925 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21926 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21927 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21928
21929 @kindex j `
21930 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21931 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21932 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21933 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21934 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21935
21936 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21937 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21938 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21939 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21940
21941 @smallexample
21942 @group
21943 ###
21944 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21945 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21946 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21947 @end group
21948 @end smallexample
21949
21950 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21951 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21952 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21953 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21954 and resimplifies.
21955
21956 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21957 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21958 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21959
21960 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21961 @pindex calc-del-selection
21962 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21963 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21964 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21965 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21966 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21967
21968 @kindex j @key{RET}
21969 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21970 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21971 command.)
21972
21973 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21974 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21975 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21976 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21977
21978 @smallexample
21979 @group
21980 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21981 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21982 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21983 V 4 - 2 x
21984 @end group
21985 @end smallexample
21986
21987 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21988 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21989 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21990 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21991 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21992 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21993 the command will abort with an error message.
21994
21995 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21996 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21997 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21998 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21999
22000 @smallexample
22001 @group
22002 .. . .. .
22003 1* .......... 1* ...........
22004 ......... ..........
22005 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
22006 @end group
22007 @end smallexample
22008
22009 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
22010 normally have canceled out with the subtraction automatically, has
22011 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
22012 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
22013 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
22014 to be simplified.
22015
22016 @smallexample
22017 @group
22018 17 y 17 y
22019 1: ----------- 1: ----------
22020 __________ _________
22021 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
22022 @end group
22023 @end smallexample
22024
22025 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
22026 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
22027
22028 @noindent
22029 @kindex j R
22030 @pindex calc-commute-right
22031 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
22032 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
22033 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
22034 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
22035
22036 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
22037 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
22038 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
22039 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
22040
22041 @smallexample
22042 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
22043 @end smallexample
22044
22045 @noindent
22046 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
22047 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
22048 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
22049 mathematical meaning of the formula.
22050
22051 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
22052 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
22053 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
22054 course be drastically changed.
22055
22056 @smallexample
22057 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
22058
22059 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
22060 @end smallexample
22061
22062 @kindex j L
22063 @pindex calc-commute-left
22064 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
22065 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
22066
22067 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
22068 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
22069 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
22070 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
22071 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
22072
22073 @kindex j D
22074 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
22075 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
22076 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
22077 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
22078 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
22079 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
22080 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
22081 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
22082 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
22083
22084 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
22085 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
22086 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
22087 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
22088 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
22089 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
22090
22091 @vindex DistribRules
22092 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
22093 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
22094 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
22095 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
22096 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
22097 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
22098 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
22099
22100 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
22101 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
22102 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
22103 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
22104
22105 @kindex j M
22106 @pindex calc-sel-merge
22107 @vindex MergeRules
22108 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
22109 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
22110 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
22111 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
22112 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
22113 the relevant rules.
22114
22115 @kindex j C
22116 @pindex calc-sel-commute
22117 @vindex CommuteRules
22118 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
22119 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
22120 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
22121 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
22122 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
22123 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
22124 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
22125 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22126 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22127
22128 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22129 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22130 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22131 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22132 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22133 manipulations described in this section.
22134
22135 @kindex j N
22136 @pindex calc-sel-negate
22137 @vindex NegateRules
22138 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22139 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22140 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22141 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22142 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22143 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22144 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22145 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22146
22147 @kindex j &
22148 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22149 @vindex InvertRules
22150 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22151 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22152 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22153 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22154
22155 @kindex j E
22156 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22157 @vindex JumpRules
22158 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22159 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22160 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22161 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22162 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22163 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22164
22165 @kindex j I
22166 @kindex H j I
22167 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22168 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22169 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22170 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22171 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22172 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22173 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22174 as well as equations.
22175
22176 @kindex j *
22177 @kindex j /
22178 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22179 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22180 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22181 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22182 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It performs the
22183 default algebraic simplifications before re-forming the
22184 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22185 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22186 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22187 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22188
22189 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22190 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22191 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22192 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22193 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22194 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22195 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22196 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22197 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22198 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22199
22200 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22201 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22202 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22203 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22204 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22205 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22206 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22207 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22208 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22209 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22210 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22211 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22212
22213 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22214 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22215 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22216 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22217 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22218 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22219 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22220 message.
22221
22222 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22223 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22224 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22225 back by the formula.
22226
22227 @kindex j +
22228 @kindex j -
22229 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22230 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22231 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22232 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22233 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22234 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22235 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22236 results.
22237
22238 @kindex j U
22239 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22240 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22241 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22242 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22243 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22244 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22245 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22246
22247 @kindex j v
22248 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22249 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22250 basic simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22251 These simplifications would normally be done automatically
22252 on all results, but may have been partially inhibited by
22253 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22254 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22255 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22256
22257 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22258 the default algebraic simplifications to the selected
22259 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22260 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22261 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22262 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22263 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22264 sub-formula.
22265
22266 @kindex j "
22267 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22268 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22269 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22270
22271 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22272 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22273
22274 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22275 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22276
22277 @noindent
22278 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22279 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22280 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22281 formula).
22282
22283 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22284 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22285 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22286 from the second-to-top stack level.
22287
22288 @kindex a v
22289 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22290 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22291 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22292 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22293 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22294 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22295 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22296
22297 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22298 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22299 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22300
22301 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22302 using Calc's algebraic simplifications; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}.
22303 If you give a numeric prefix of 3 or more, it uses Extended
22304 Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22305
22306 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22307 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22308 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22309 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22310 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22311 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22312 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22313 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22314 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22315
22316 @tindex evalv
22317 @tindex evalvn
22318 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22319 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22320 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22321 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22322 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22323 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22324 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22325
22326 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22327 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22328 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22329 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22330 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22331 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22332 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22333 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22334 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22335 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22336 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22337 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22338
22339 @kindex a "
22340 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22341 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22342 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22343 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22344 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22345 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22346 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22347 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22348 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22349 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22350 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22351 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22352 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22353 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22354 top-level function call.
22355
22356 @kindex a M
22357 @pindex calc-map-equation
22358 @tindex mapeq
22359 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22360 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22361 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22362 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22363 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22364 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22365 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22366 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22367 respective sides of a new equation.
22368
22369 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22370 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22371 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22372 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22373 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22374 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22375 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22376 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22377 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the algebraic simplifications
22378 can reduce to @samp{2 < b}.
22379
22380 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22381 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22382 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22383 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22384 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22385
22386 @kindex H a M
22387 @tindex mapeqp
22388 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22389 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22390 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22391 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22392 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22393
22394 @kindex I a M
22395 @tindex mapeqr
22396 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22397 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22398 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22399 working with small positive angles.
22400
22401 @kindex a b
22402 @pindex calc-substitute
22403 @tindex subst
22404 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22405 all occurrences
22406 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22407 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22408 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22409 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22410 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22411 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22412 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22413 doing substitutions.
22414
22415 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22416 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22417 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22418 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22419 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22420 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22421 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22422
22423 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22424 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22425 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22426 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22427 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22428 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22429 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22430 these limitations.
22431
22432 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22433 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22434 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22435 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22436 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22437
22438 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22439 @section Simplifying Formulas
22440
22441 @noindent
22442 @kindex a s
22443 @kindex I a s
22444 @kindex H a s
22445 @pindex calc-simplify
22446 @tindex simplify
22447
22448 The sections below describe all the various kinds of
22449 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22450 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22451 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22452 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22453 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22454 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22455 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22456
22457 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22458 simplification occurs automatically. Normally the algebraic
22459 simplifications described below occur. If you have turned on a
22460 simplification mode which does not do these algebraic simplifications,
22461 you can still apply them to a formula with the @kbd{a s}
22462 (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command.
22463
22464 There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22465 done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22466 @kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22467 function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22468 before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22469 complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while the algebraic
22470 simplifications can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, they will not
22471 simplify @samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22472 simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
22473 csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22474 some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22475 will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22476 Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
22477 replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22478 combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22479
22480
22481 @menu
22482 * Basic Simplifications::
22483 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22484 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22485 * Simplification of Units::
22486 @end menu
22487
22488 @node Basic Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22489 @subsection Basic Simplifications
22490
22491 @noindent
22492 @cindex Basic simplifications
22493 This section describes basic simplifications which Calc performs in many
22494 situations. For example, both binary simplifications and algebraic
22495 simplifications begin by performing these basic simplifications. You
22496 can type @kbd{m I} to restrict the simplifications done on the stack to
22497 these simplifications.
22498
22499 The most basic simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22500 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22501 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22502 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22503 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22504 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22505 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22506 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22507
22508 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22509 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22510 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22511 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22512 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22513 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22514 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22515 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22516
22517 Most commands apply at least these basic simplifications to all
22518 arguments they take from the stack, perform a particular operation,
22519 then simplify the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the
22520 common special case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and
22521 @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}], the arguments are simply popped from the stack
22522 and collected into a suitable function call, which is then simplified
22523 (the arguments being simplified first as part of the process, as
22524 described above).
22525
22526 Even the basic set of simplifications are too numerous to describe
22527 completely here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22528 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22529 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22530 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22531
22532 @tex
22533 \bigskip
22534 @end tex
22535
22536 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22537 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22538 will also be applied before any of the basic simplifications.
22539 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22540
22541 @tex
22542 \bigskip
22543 @end tex
22544
22545 And now, on with the basic simplifications:
22546
22547 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22548 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22549 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22550 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22551 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22552 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22553 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22554 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22555 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22556 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22557 below.
22558
22559 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22560 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22561 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22562 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22563 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22564 If you are using Basic Simplification mode, Calc assumes you have put
22565 the terms into the order you want and generally leaves that order alone,
22566 with the consequence that formulas like the above will only be
22567 simplified if you explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command.
22568 @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
22569
22570 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22571 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22572 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22573 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22574 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22575 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22576 negative-looking.
22577
22578 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22579 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22580 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22581 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22582 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22583 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22584 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22585 simplifications.)
22586
22587 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22588 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22589 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22590 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22591 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22592 using the distributive law.
22593
22594 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22595 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22596 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22597 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22598 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22599 square of the number of terms; Calc omits potentially slow
22600 operations like this in basic simplification mode.
22601
22602 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22603 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22604 to @expr{-a}.
22605
22606 @tex
22607 \bigskip
22608 @end tex
22609
22610 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22611 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22612 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22613 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22614 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22615 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22616
22617 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22618 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22619 numbers.
22620
22621 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22622 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22623
22624 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22625 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22626 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22627 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22628 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22629
22630 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22631 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22632 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22633 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22634 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22635 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22636 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22637 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22638 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22639 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22640
22641 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22642 power is changed to use division:
22643 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22644 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22645 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22646 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22647 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22648
22649 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22650 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22651
22652 @tex
22653 \bigskip
22654 @end tex
22655
22656 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22657 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22658 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22659 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22660 respectively.
22661
22662 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22663 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22664 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22665
22666 The expression
22667 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22668 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22669 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22670 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22671 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22672 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22673 for any power @expr{c}.
22674
22675 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22676 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22677 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22678 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22679 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22680
22681 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22682 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22683 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22684 described for multiplication.
22685
22686 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22687 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22688 is canceled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22689 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22690 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22691
22692 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22693 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22694 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22695
22696 @tex
22697 \bigskip
22698 @end tex
22699
22700 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22701 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22702 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22703 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22704 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22705 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22706
22707 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22708 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22709 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22710 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22711 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22712 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22713 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22714 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22715 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22716 (In other words,
22717 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22718 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22719 is safe to simplify, but
22720 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22721 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22722 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22723 variables satisfy these requirements.
22724
22725 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22726 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22727 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22728 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22729
22730 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22731 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22732 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22733
22734 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22735 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22736 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22737
22738 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22739 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22740 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22741 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22742
22743 Also, note that
22744 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22745 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22746 is changed to
22747 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22748 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22749 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22750
22751 @tex
22752 \bigskip
22753 @end tex
22754
22755 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22756 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22757 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22758 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22759 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22760 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22761 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22762 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22763 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22764 @expr{n} is an integer.
22765
22766 @tex
22767 \bigskip
22768 @end tex
22769
22770 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22771 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22772 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22773 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22774 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22775 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22776
22777 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22778 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22779 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22780 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22781 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22782
22783 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22784 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22785 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22786
22787 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22788 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22789 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22790 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22791 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22792 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22793 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22794
22795 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22796 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22797 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The algebraic
22798 simplifications described in the next section do provide some
22799 simplifications for these functions, though.
22800
22801 One important simplification that does occur is that
22802 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22803 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22804 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22805 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22806
22807 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22808 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22809 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22810 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22811 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22812 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22813
22814 Most other Calc functions have few if any basic simplifications
22815 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22816 suitable numbers.
22817
22818 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Basic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22819 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22820
22821 @noindent
22822 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22823 @kindex a s
22824 @kindex m A
22825 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22826 the algebraic simplification mode, which is the default simplification
22827 mode. If you have switched to a different simplification mode, you can
22828 switch back with the @kbd{m A} command. Even in other simplification
22829 modes, the @kbd{a s} command will use these algebraic simplifications to
22830 simplify the formula.
22831
22832 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22833 to be applied. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22834 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22835 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22836 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22837 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22838 the original expression, the process repeats with the basic
22839 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22840 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22841
22842 @tex
22843 \bigskip
22844 @end tex
22845
22846 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22847 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22848 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22849 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22850 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22851
22852 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22853 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22854 adjacent terms, but Calc's algebraic simplifications compare all pairs
22855 of terms including non-adjacent ones.
22856
22857 @tex
22858 \bigskip
22859 @end tex
22860
22861 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22862 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22863 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the basic
22864 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22865 but the algebraic simplifications; it first rewrites the sum to
22866 @expr{x y + x y} which can then be recognized as a sum of identical
22867 terms.
22868
22869 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22870 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22871 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22872 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22873
22874 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22875 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22876 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22877
22878 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22879 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22880 use for adjacent terms of products.
22881
22882 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22883 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22884 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22885 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22886 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22887 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22888 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22889
22890 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22891 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22892 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22893 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22894 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22895
22896 @tex
22897 \bigskip
22898 @end tex
22899
22900 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22901 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22902 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22903 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22904 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22905 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22906 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is canceled out;
22907 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22908
22909 Non-constant common factors are not found even by algebraic
22910 simplifications. To cancel the factor @expr{a} in
22911 @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first use @kbd{j M} on the product
22912 @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be
22913 simplified successfully.
22914
22915 @tex
22916 \bigskip
22917 @end tex
22918
22919 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22920 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22921 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22922 will no longer occur. This is not done by the basic
22923 simplifications; in case someone (unwisely) wants to use the name
22924 @code{i} for a variable unrelated to complex numbers, they can use
22925 basic simplification mode.
22926
22927 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22928 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22929 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22930 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22931 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22932 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22933 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22934 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22935 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22936
22937 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22938 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22939 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22940 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22941
22942 @tex
22943 \bigskip
22944 @end tex
22945
22946 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22947 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22948 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22949 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22950 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22951
22952 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22953 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22954 canceled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22955 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22956 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22957 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22958 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22959
22960 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22961 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22962 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22963 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22964 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22965 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22966 declared to be an integer.
22967
22968 @tex
22969 \bigskip
22970 @end tex
22971
22972 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22973 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22974 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22975 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22976 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22977 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22978 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22979 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22980
22981 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22982 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22983 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22984 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22985 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22986 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22987
22988 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22989 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22990 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22991 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22992
22993 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22994 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22995 hyperbolic functions.
22996
22997 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22998 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22999 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
23000 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
23001 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
23002 @texline @math{2 \pi}
23003 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
23004 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
23005 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
23006
23007 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
23008 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
23009 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
23010 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
23011 and
23012 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
23013 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
23014 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
23015 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
23016 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
23017 is a suitable multiple of
23018 @texline @math{\pi i}
23019 @infoline @expr{pi i}
23020 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
23021 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
23022 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
23023 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
23024 negative imaginary.
23025
23026 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
23027 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
23028 function.
23029
23030 @tex
23031 \bigskip
23032 @end tex
23033
23034 Equations and inequalities are simplified by canceling factors
23035 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
23036 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is canceled.
23037 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
23038 canceled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
23039 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
23040 are canceled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
23041 sign is known.
23042
23043 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
23044 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
23045 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
23046 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
23047 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
23048 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
23049 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
23050
23051 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23052 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
23053
23054 @noindent
23055 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
23056 @cindex Extended simplification
23057 @kindex a e
23058 @kindex m E
23059 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
23060 @ignore
23061 @mindex esimpl@idots
23062 @end ignore
23063 @tindex esimplify
23064 Calc is capable of performing some simplifications which may sometimes
23065 be desired but which are not ``safe'' in all cases. The @kbd{a e}
23066 (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
23067 applies the algebraic simplifications as well as these extended, or
23068 ``unsafe'', simplifications. Use this only if you know the values in
23069 your formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these
23070 simplifications are valid. You can use Extended Simplification mode
23071 (@kbd{m E}) to have these simplifications done automatically.
23072
23073 The symbolic integrator uses these extended simplifications; one effect
23074 of this is that the integrator's results must be used with caution.
23075 Where an integral table will often attach conditions like ``for positive
23076 @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic integration programs)
23077 will simply produce an unqualified result.
23078
23079 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
23080 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
23081 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
23082 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
23083 to any specific part of a formula.
23084
23085 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied when
23086 the extended simplifications are used. These are applied in addition to
23087 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
23088 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
23089
23090 Following is a complete list of the ``unsafe'' simplifications.
23091
23092 @tex
23093 \bigskip
23094 @end tex
23095
23096 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
23097 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified.
23098 For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
23099 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
23100 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
23101 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
23102 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
23103 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
23104 functions always produce.
23105
23106 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
23107 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
23108 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
23109 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
23110 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
23111 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
23112 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
23113 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
23114 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
23115
23116 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
23117 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
23118 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
23119 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
23120
23121 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
23122 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
23123 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
23124
23125 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23126 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23127 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23128 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23129
23130 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23131 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23132 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23133 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23134
23135 Common factors are canceled from products on both sides of an
23136 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23137 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never canceled from
23138 inequalities: Even the extended simplifications are not bold enough to
23139 reduce @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23140 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23141 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23142 both sides of an inequality.
23143
23144 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23145 @subsection Simplification of Units
23146
23147 @noindent
23148 The simplifications described in this section (as well as the algebraic
23149 simplifications) are applied when units need to be simplified. They can
23150 be applied using the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command, or
23151 will be done automatically in Units Simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
23152 @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23153
23154 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23155 units simplifications. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23156 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23157
23158 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23159 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23160
23161 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23162 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23163 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23164 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23165 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23166 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23167
23168 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23169 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23170 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23171
23172 When canceling and combining units in products and quotients,
23173 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23174 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23175 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23176 are not combined in this way.
23177
23178 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23179 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23180 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23181
23182 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23183 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23184 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23185 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23186 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23187
23188 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23189 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23190 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23191
23192 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23193 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23194 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23195 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23196 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23197 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23198 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23199 real.)
23200
23201 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23202 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23203 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23204 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23205 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23206 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23207 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23208 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23209 replaced by approximately
23210 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23211 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23212 which is then changed to
23213 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23214 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23215 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23216
23217 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23218 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23219 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23220 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23221 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23222 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23223
23224 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23225 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23226 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23227 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23228
23229 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23230 @section Polynomials
23231
23232 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23233 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23234 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23235 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23236 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23237 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23238 involving the base variable.
23239
23240 @kindex a f
23241 @pindex calc-factor
23242 @tindex factor
23243 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23244 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23245 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23246 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23247 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23248
23249 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23250 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23251 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23252 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23253 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23254 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23255 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23256 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23257 rewrite mechanism.
23258
23259 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23260 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23261 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23262 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23263 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23264 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23265 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23266 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23267 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23268 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23269 version of Calc.)
23270
23271 @vindex FactorRules
23272 @ignore
23273 @starindex
23274 @end ignore
23275 @tindex thecoefs
23276 @ignore
23277 @starindex
23278 @end ignore
23279 @ignore
23280 @mindex @idots
23281 @end ignore
23282 @tindex thefactors
23283 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23284 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23285 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23286 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23287 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23288 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23289 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23290 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23291 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23292 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23293 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23294 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23295 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23296 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23297 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23298 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23299 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23300 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23301
23302 @kindex H a f
23303 @tindex factors
23304 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23305 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23306 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23307 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23308 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23309 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23310 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23311 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23312 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23313 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23314 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23315
23316 @kindex a c
23317 @pindex calc-collect
23318 @tindex collect
23319 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23320 formula as a
23321 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23322 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23323 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23324 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23325 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23326 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23327 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23328 not be expanded.
23329
23330 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23331 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23332 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23333 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23334 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23335
23336 @kindex a x
23337 @pindex calc-expand
23338 @tindex expand
23339 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23340 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23341 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23342 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23343 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23344 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23345
23346 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23347 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23348 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23349 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23350 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23351 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23352 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23353 do not do.)
23354
23355 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23356 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23357 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23358 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23359 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23360 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23361 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23362 the way in one step.
23363
23364 @kindex a a
23365 @pindex calc-apart
23366 @tindex apart
23367 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23368 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23369 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23370 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23371 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23372 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23373 chooses the base variable automatically.
23374
23375 @kindex a n
23376 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23377 @tindex nrat
23378 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23379 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23380 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23381 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23382 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23383 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23384
23385 @kindex a \
23386 @pindex calc-poly-div
23387 @tindex pdiv
23388 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23389 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23390 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23391 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23392 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23393 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23394 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23395 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23396 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23397
23398 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23399 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23400 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23401 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23402 above.
23403
23404 @kindex a %
23405 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23406 @tindex prem
23407 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23408 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23409 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23410 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23411 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23412 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23413
23414 @kindex a /
23415 @kindex H a /
23416 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23417 @tindex pdivrem
23418 @tindex pdivide
23419 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23420 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23421 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23422 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23423 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23424 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23425
23426 @kindex a g
23427 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23428 @tindex pgcd
23429 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23430 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23431 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23432 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23433 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23434 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23435 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23436 leaving a remainder.)
23437
23438 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23439 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23440 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23441 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23442 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23443 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23444 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23445
23446 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23447 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23448 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23449
23450 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23451 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23452
23453 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23454 @section Calculus
23455
23456 @noindent
23457 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23458 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23459 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23460 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23461 readable way.
23462
23463 @menu
23464 * Differentiation::
23465 * Integration::
23466 * Customizing the Integrator::
23467 * Numerical Integration::
23468 * Taylor Series::
23469 @end menu
23470
23471 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23472 @subsection Differentiation
23473
23474 @noindent
23475 @kindex a d
23476 @kindex H a d
23477 @pindex calc-derivative
23478 @tindex deriv
23479 @tindex tderiv
23480 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23481 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23482 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23483 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23484 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23485 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23486 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23487 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23488 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23489 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23490 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23491
23492 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23493 @var{n}th derivative.
23494
23495 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23496 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23497 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23498 answer!
23499
23500 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23501 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23502 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23503 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23504 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23505
23506 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23507 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23508 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23509 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23510 derivative of @code{f}.
23511
23512 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23513 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23514 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23515 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23516 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23517 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23518 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23519 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23520
23521 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23522 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23523 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23524 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23525 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23526 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23527 argument once).
23528
23529 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23530 @subsection Integration
23531
23532 @noindent
23533 @kindex a i
23534 @pindex calc-integral
23535 @tindex integ
23536 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23537 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23538 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23539 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23540 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23541 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23542 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23543 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23544 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23545 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23546 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23547 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23548 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23549 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23550
23551 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23552 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23553 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23554 lower limit and an upper limit.
23555
23556 @ifnottex
23557 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23558 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23559 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23560 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23561 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23562 @end ifnottex
23563 @tex
23564 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23565 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23566 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23567 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23568 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23569 @end tex
23570
23571 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23572 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23573 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23574 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23575 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23576 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23577 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23578 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23579 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23580 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23581 Calc's solution for
23582 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23583 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23584 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23585 constant factor of
23586 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23587 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23588 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23589
23590 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23591 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23592 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23593 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23594 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23595
23596 @vindex IntegLimit
23597 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23598 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23599 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23600 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23601 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23602 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23603 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23604 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23605 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23606 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23607 by creating an Emacs buffer called @file{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23608 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23609
23610 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23611 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23612 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23613 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23614 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23615
23616 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23617 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23618
23619 @noindent
23620 @vindex IntegRules
23621 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23622 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23623 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23624 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23625 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23626 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23627 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23628 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23629 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23630 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23631 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23632 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23633 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23634 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23635 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23636 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23637
23638 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23639 @ignore
23640 @starindex
23641 @end ignore
23642 @tindex Ei
23643 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23644 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23645 integral'' function
23646 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23647 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23648 was invented to describe it.
23649 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23650 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23651 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23652 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23653 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23654 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23655 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23656 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23657 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23658
23659 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23660 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23661 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23662 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23663 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23664 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23665 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23666 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23667 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23668 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23669 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23670 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23671 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23672
23673 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23674 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23675 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23676 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23677 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23678 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23679 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23680 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23681 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23682 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23683 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23684 it need not be.
23685
23686 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23687 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23688 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23689 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23690 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23691 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23692 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23693 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23694 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23695 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23696 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23697 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23698 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23699 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23700
23701 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23702 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23703 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23704 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23705 forever!)
23706
23707 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23708 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23709 every time the integrator uses algebraic simplifications to simplify an
23710 intermediate result. For example, putting the rule
23711 @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to
23712 convert the @code{twice} function into a form it knows whenever
23713 integration is attempted.
23714
23715 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23716 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23717 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23718 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23719 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23720 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23721 do this.)
23722
23723 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23724 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23725 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23726 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23727 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23728 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23729 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23730 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23731 (It also does algebraic simplifications, without @code{IntegSimpRules},
23732 after that to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23733 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23734 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23735 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23736 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23737 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23738 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23739 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23740 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23741
23742 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23743 @subsection Numerical Integration
23744
23745 @noindent
23746 @kindex a I
23747 @pindex calc-num-integral
23748 @tindex ninteg
23749 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23750 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23751 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23752 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23753 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23754 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23755
23756 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23757 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23758 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23759 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23760 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23761 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23762 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23763 determine the value of the integral.
23764
23765 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23766 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23767 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23768 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23769 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23770 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23771
23772 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23773 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23774 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23775 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23776 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23777 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23778 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23779
23780 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23781 @subsection Taylor Series
23782
23783 @noindent
23784 @kindex a t
23785 @pindex calc-taylor
23786 @tindex taylor
23787 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23788 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23789 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23790 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23791 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23792 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23793 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23794 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23795 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23796
23797 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23798 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23799 Taylor series.
23800
23801 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23802 @section Solving Equations
23803
23804 @noindent
23805 @kindex a S
23806 @pindex calc-solve-for
23807 @tindex solve
23808 @cindex Equations, solving
23809 @cindex Solving equations
23810 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23811 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23812 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23813 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23814 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23815 form @expr{X = 0}.
23816
23817 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23818 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23819 be; for example, solving
23820 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23821 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23822 for @expr{b} is impossible
23823 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23824 produce the result
23825 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23826 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23827 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23828 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23829 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23830 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23831 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23832 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23833
23834 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23835 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23836 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23837 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23838
23839 @menu
23840 * Multiple Solutions::
23841 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23842 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23843 @end menu
23844
23845 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23846 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23847
23848 @noindent
23849 @kindex H a S
23850 @tindex fsolve
23851 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23852 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23853 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23854 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23855 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23856 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23857 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23858 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23859 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23860 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23861 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23862 of these variables.
23863
23864 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23865 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23866 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23867 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23868 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23869 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23870 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23871 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23872
23873 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23874 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23875 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23876 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23877 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23878 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23879 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23880 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23881
23882 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23883 @vindex GenCount
23884 @ignore
23885 @starindex
23886 @end ignore
23887 @tindex an
23888 @ignore
23889 @starindex
23890 @end ignore
23891 @tindex as
23892 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23893 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23894 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23895 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23896 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23897 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23898 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23899 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23900 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23901 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23902 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23903 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23904 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23905 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23906
23907 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23908 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23909
23910 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23911 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23912 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23913
23914 @kindex I a S
23915 @kindex H I a S
23916 @tindex finv
23917 @tindex ffinv
23918 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23919 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23920 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23921 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23922 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23923 fully general inverse, as described above.
23924
23925 @kindex a P
23926 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23927 @tindex roots
23928 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23929 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23930 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23931 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23932 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23933 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23934 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23935 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23936 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23937 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23938 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23939 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23940 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23941
23942 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23943 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23944 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23945 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23946 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23947 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23948 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23949 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23950 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23951 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23952 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23953 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23954 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23955 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23956 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23957 are all numbers (real or complex).
23958
23959 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23960 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23961
23962 @noindent
23963 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23964 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23965 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23966 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23967 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23968 at the prompt.)
23969
23970 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23971 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23972 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23973 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23974 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23975 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23976 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23977 command.
23978
23979 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23980 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23981 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23982 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23983 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23984 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23985 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23986 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23987 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23988 nonlinear systems.
23989
23990 @ignore
23991 @starindex
23992 @end ignore
23993 @tindex elim
23994 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23995 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23996 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23997 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23998 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23999 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
24000 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
24001 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
24002 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
24003 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
24004 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
24005 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
24006
24007 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
24008 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
24009 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
24010 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
24011 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
24012 by one.
24013
24014 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
24015 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
24016 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
24017 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
24018 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
24019 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
24020 variables you requested.)
24021
24022 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
24023 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
24024 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
24025
24026 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
24027 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
24028
24029 @noindent
24030 @ignore
24031 @starindex
24032 @end ignore
24033 @tindex poly
24034 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
24035 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
24036 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
24037 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
24038 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
24039 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
24040 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
24041 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
24042 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
24043 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
24044 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
24045 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
24046
24047 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
24048 @cindex Degree of polynomial
24049 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
24050 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
24051 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
24052 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
24053 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
24054
24055 @ignore
24056 @starindex
24057 @end ignore
24058 @tindex gpoly
24059 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
24060 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
24061 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
24062 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
24063 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
24064 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
24065 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
24066 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
24067 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
24068 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
24069 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
24070 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
24071 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
24072 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
24073 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
24074 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
24075 is considered trivial.
24076
24077 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
24078 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
24079
24080 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
24081 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
24082 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
24083 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
24084 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
24085
24086 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
24087 discover:
24088
24089 @smallexample
24090 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
24091 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
24092 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
24093 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
24094 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
24095 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
24096 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
24097 @end smallexample
24098
24099 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
24100 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
24101 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
24102 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
24103 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
24104 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
24105 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
24106 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
24107
24108 @ignore
24109 @starindex
24110 @end ignore
24111 @tindex pdeg
24112 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
24113 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
24114 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
24115 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
24116 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
24117 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
24118 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
24119 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
24120 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
24121 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
24122 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
24123 (minus infinity).
24124
24125 @ignore
24126 @starindex
24127 @end ignore
24128 @tindex plead
24129 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24130 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24131 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24132 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24133 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24134
24135 @ignore
24136 @starindex
24137 @end ignore
24138 @tindex pcont
24139 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24140 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24141 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24142 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24143 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24144 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24145 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24146 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24147 coefficient.
24148
24149 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24150 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24151 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24152 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24153 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24154 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24155 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24156 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24157 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24158 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24159
24160 @ignore
24161 @starindex
24162 @end ignore
24163 @tindex pprim
24164 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24165 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24166 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24167 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24168 terms.
24169
24170 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24171 @section Numerical Solutions
24172
24173 @noindent
24174 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24175 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24176 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24177 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24178 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24179
24180 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24181 on numerical data.)
24182
24183 @menu
24184 * Root Finding::
24185 * Minimization::
24186 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24187 @end menu
24188
24189 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24190 @subsection Root Finding
24191
24192 @noindent
24193 @kindex a R
24194 @pindex calc-find-root
24195 @tindex root
24196 @cindex Newton's method
24197 @cindex Roots of equations
24198 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24199 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24200 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24201 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24202 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24203
24204 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24205 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24206 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24207 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24208 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24209 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24210 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24211 this command.
24212
24213 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24214 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24215 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24216 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24217 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24218 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24219 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24220 the equation yourself.)
24221
24222 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24223 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24224
24225 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24226 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24227 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24228 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24229 to real numbers inside that interval.
24230
24231 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24232 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24233 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24234 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24235 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24236 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24237 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24238
24239 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24240 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24241 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24242 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24243 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24244 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24245
24246 @kindex H a R
24247 @tindex wroot
24248 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24249 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24250 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24251 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24252 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24253
24254 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24255 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24256 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24257 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24258 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24259
24260 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24261 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24262 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24263 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24264
24265 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24266 @subsection Minimization
24267
24268 @noindent
24269 @kindex a N
24270 @kindex H a N
24271 @kindex a X
24272 @kindex H a X
24273 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24274 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24275 @tindex minimize
24276 @tindex maximize
24277 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24278 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24279 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24280 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24281 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24282 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24283 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24284 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24285 with the minimum value itself.
24286
24287 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24288 have more than one minimum; some, like
24289 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24290 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24291 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24292 ``global'' minimum of
24293 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24294 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24295 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24296 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24297 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24298 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24299
24300 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24301 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24302 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24303 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24304 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24305 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24306 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24307 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24308
24309 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24310 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24311 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24312 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24313 answer.
24314
24315 @ignore
24316 @mindex wmin@idots
24317 @end ignore
24318 @tindex wminimize
24319 @ignore
24320 @mindex wmax@idots
24321 @end ignore
24322 @tindex wmaximize
24323 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24324 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24325 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24326
24327 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24328 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24329 negative of the formula you supply.
24330
24331 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24332 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24333 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24334 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24335 be minimized over the reals.
24336
24337 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24338 @subsection Systems of Equations
24339
24340 @noindent
24341 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24342 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24343 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24344 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24345 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24346 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24347 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24348 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24349 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24350 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24351 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24352 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24353 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24354
24355 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24356 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24357 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24358 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24359 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24360 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24361 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24362
24363 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24364 @section Curve Fitting
24365
24366 @noindent
24367 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24368 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24369 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24370 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24371 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24372 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24373 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24374
24375 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24376 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24377 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24378 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24379
24380 @menu
24381 * Linear Fits::
24382 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24383 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24384 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24385 * Curve Fitting Details::
24386 * Interpolation::
24387 @end menu
24388
24389 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24390 @subsection Linear Fits
24391
24392 @noindent
24393 @kindex a F
24394 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24395 @tindex fit
24396 @cindex Linear regression
24397 @cindex Least-squares fits
24398 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24399 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24400 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24401 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24402 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24403 fit for the data.
24404
24405 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24406 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24407 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24408 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24409 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24410 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24411 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24412 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24413
24414 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24415 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24416 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24417 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24418
24419 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24420 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24421 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24422 @texline @math{2\times N}
24423 @infoline 2xN
24424 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24425 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24426 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24427 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24428
24429 If you happen to have an
24430 @texline @math{N\times2}
24431 @infoline Nx2
24432 matrix instead of a
24433 @texline @math{2\times N}
24434 @infoline 2xN
24435 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24436
24437 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24438 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24439
24440 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24441 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24442 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24443 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24444 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24445 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24446 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24447
24448 For example, suppose the data matrix
24449
24450 @ifnottex
24451 @example
24452 @group
24453 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24454 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24455 @end group
24456 @end example
24457 @end ifnottex
24458 @tex
24459 \beforedisplay
24460 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24461 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24462 $$
24463 \afterdisplay
24464 @end tex
24465
24466 @noindent
24467 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24468 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24469 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24470 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24471 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24472 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24473 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24474 formula.
24475
24476 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24477 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24478 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24479 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24480 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24481 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24482
24483 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24484 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24485 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24486 the equations that go into the trail.
24487
24488 @tex
24489 \bigskip
24490 @end tex
24491
24492 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24493 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24494 The result is:
24495
24496 @example
24497 2.6 + 2.2 x
24498 @end example
24499
24500 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24501 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24502
24503 @example
24504 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24505 @end example
24506
24507 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24508 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24509 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24510 error measure
24511
24512 @ifnottex
24513 @example
24514 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24515 @end example
24516 @end ifnottex
24517 @tex
24518 \beforedisplay
24519 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24520 \afterdisplay
24521 @end tex
24522
24523 @noindent
24524 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24525 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24526 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24527 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24528 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24529 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24530 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24531 for which the error
24532 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24533 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24534 is as small as possible.
24535
24536 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24537 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24538
24539 @tex
24540 \bigskip
24541 @end tex
24542
24543 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24544 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24545 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24546 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24547 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24548
24549 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24550 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24551 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24552 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24553 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24554
24555 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24556 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24557
24558 @noindent
24559 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24560 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24561 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24562 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24563 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24564
24565 @example
24566 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24567 @end example
24568
24569 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24570 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24571 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24572 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24573 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24574 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24575 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24576 won't help.)
24577
24578 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24579 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24580 line slightly to improve the fit.
24581
24582 @example
24583 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24584 @end example
24585
24586 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24587 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24588 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24589 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24590 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24591
24592 @example
24593 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24594 @end example
24595
24596 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24597 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24598 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24599 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24600 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24601 results.
24602
24603 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24604 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24605 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24606 automatically.
24607
24608 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24609 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24610 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24611 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24612 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24613 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24614
24615 @tex
24616 \bigskip
24617 @end tex
24618
24619 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24620 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24621 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24622 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24623 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24624
24625 Given the data matrix,
24626
24627 @example
24628 @group
24629 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24630 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24631 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24632 @end group
24633 @end example
24634
24635 @noindent
24636 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24637 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24638 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24639
24640 @example
24641 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24642 @end example
24643
24644 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24645 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24646
24647 @tex
24648 \bigskip
24649 @end tex
24650
24651 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24652 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24653 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24654 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24655 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24656 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24657 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24658 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24659 message.
24660
24661 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24662 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24663 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24664 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24665 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24666
24667 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24668 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24669
24670 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24671 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24672
24673 @noindent
24674 @kindex H a F
24675 @tindex efit
24676 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24677 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24678 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24679 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24680
24681 @example
24682 3. + 2. x
24683 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24684 @end example
24685
24686 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24687 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24688 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24689
24690 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24691 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24692 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24693 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24694 row contains error forms
24695 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24696 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24697 then the
24698 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24699 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24700 statistic is now,
24701
24702 @ifnottex
24703 @example
24704 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24705 @end example
24706 @end ifnottex
24707 @tex
24708 \beforedisplay
24709 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24710 \afterdisplay
24711 @end tex
24712
24713 @noindent
24714 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24715 the fitting operation.
24716
24717 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24718 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24719 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24720 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24721 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24722 used for the data point.
24723
24724 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24725 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24726 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24727 estimates.
24728
24729 If the input contains error forms but all the
24730 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24731 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24732 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24733 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24734 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24735 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24736 is simply scaled uniformly by
24737 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24738 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24739 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24740 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24741 @kbd{H a F}.
24742
24743 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24744 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24745 interpreted.
24746
24747 @tex
24748 \bigskip
24749 @end tex
24750
24751 @kindex I a F
24752 @tindex xfit
24753 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24754 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24755
24756 @enumerate
24757 @item
24758 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24759 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24760 produced.
24761
24762 @item
24763 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24764 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24765 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24766 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24767 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24768
24769 @item
24770 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24771 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24772 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24773 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24774 are the variances
24775 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24776 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24777 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24778 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24779 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24780 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24781 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24782 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24783 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24784 are defined as
24785 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24786 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24787
24788 @item
24789 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24790 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24791 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24792 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24793
24794 @item
24795 The value of
24796 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24797 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24798 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24799 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24800 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24801 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24802 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24803 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24804
24805 @item
24806 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24807 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24808 function using
24809 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24810 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24811 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24812 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24813 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24814 particular,
24815 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24816 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24817 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24818 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24819 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24820
24821 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24822 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24823 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24824 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24825 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24826 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24827 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24828 over to use for a confidence test.
24829 @end enumerate
24830
24831 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24832 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24833
24834 @noindent
24835 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24836 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24837 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24838
24839 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24840
24841 @table @kbd
24842 @item 1
24843 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24844 @item 2-9
24845 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24846 @item e
24847 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24848 @item E
24849 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24850 @item x
24851 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24852 @item X
24853 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24854 @item l
24855 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24856 @item L
24857 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24858 @item ^
24859 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24860 @item p
24861 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24862 @item q
24863 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24864 @item g
24865 Gaussian.
24866 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24867 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24868 @item s
24869 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24870 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24871 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24872 @item b
24873 Logistic bell curve.
24874 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24875 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24876 @item o
24877 Hubbert linearization.
24878 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24879 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24880 @end table
24881
24882 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24883 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24884 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24885 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24886 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24887
24888 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24889 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24890 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24891 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24892 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24893 before the model key.
24894
24895 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24896 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24897 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24898 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24899 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24900 matches the problem.
24901
24902 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24903 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24904 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24905 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24906 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24907 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24908
24909 @tex
24910 \bigskip
24911 @end tex
24912
24913 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24914 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24915 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24916 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24917
24918 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24919 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24920 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24921 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24922 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24923 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24924 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24925 model.
24926
24927 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24928 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24929 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24930 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24931 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24932 and thus does not need a name.
24933
24934 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24935 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24936 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24937 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24938 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24939 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24940 variables.
24941
24942 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24943 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24944 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24945 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24946 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24947 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24948 in the model formula will become parameters.
24949
24950 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24951 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24952 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24953 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24954 a linear model.
24955
24956 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24957 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24958 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24959 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24960 which are parameters.
24961
24962 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24963 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24964 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24965 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24966 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24967 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24968
24969 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24970 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24971
24972 @tex
24973 \bigskip
24974 @end tex
24975
24976 @vindex Model1
24977 @vindex Model2
24978 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24979 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24980 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24981 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24982 accept for a model on the stack.
24983
24984 @tex
24985 \bigskip
24986 @end tex
24987
24988 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24989 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24990 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24991 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24992 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24993 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24994 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24995 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24996 @texline @math{3\times360}
24997 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24998 degrees.
24999 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
25000 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
25001 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
25002 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
25003 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
25004 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
25005 even approximately.
25006
25007 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
25008 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
25009 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
25010 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
25011 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
25012 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
25013 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
25014
25015 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
25016 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
25017
25018 @noindent
25019 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
25020 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
25021 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
25022 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
25023 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
25024
25025 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
25026 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
25027 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
25028 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
25029
25030 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
25031 to try to put the problem into the form
25032
25033 @smallexample
25034 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
25035 @end smallexample
25036
25037 @noindent
25038 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
25039 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
25040 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
25041 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
25042 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
25043
25044 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
25045 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
25046 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
25047 can be rewritten as follows:
25048
25049 @example
25050 y = a x^b
25051 y = a exp(b ln(x))
25052 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
25053 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
25054 @end example
25055
25056 @noindent
25057 which matches the desired form with
25058 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
25059 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
25060 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
25061 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
25062 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
25063 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
25064 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
25065 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
25066 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
25067 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
25068 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
25069 and @expr{b = B}.
25070
25071 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
25072 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
25073
25074 @example
25075 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
25076 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
25077 @end example
25078
25079 @noindent
25080 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
25081 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
25082 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
25083 @expr{H = x^2}.
25084
25085 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
25086 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
25087 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
25088
25089 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
25090 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
25091 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
25092 iterative method to refine the approximations.
25093
25094 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
25095 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
25096 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
25097 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
25098 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
25099 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
25100 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
25101 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
25102 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
25103 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
25104 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
25105 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
25106
25107 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
25108 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
25109 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
25110
25111 @tex
25112 \bigskip
25113 @end tex
25114
25115 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
25116 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
25117 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
25118 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25119 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25120 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
25121 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
25122 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
25123 command can do the same thing by brute force.
25124
25125 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25126 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25127 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25128 to be minimized would be the value of
25129 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25130 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25131 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25132
25133 @smallexample
25134 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25135 @end smallexample
25136
25137 @noindent
25138 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25139 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25140 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25141 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25142 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25143 were used by itself to solve the problem).
25144
25145 @tex
25146 \bigskip
25147 @end tex
25148
25149 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25150 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25151 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25152 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25153 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25154 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25155 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25156 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25157 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25158 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25159 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25160 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25161 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25162 and so on.
25163
25164 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25165 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25166 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25167 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25168 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25169 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25170 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25171 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25172 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25173
25174 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25175 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25176 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25177 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25178 nontrivial filter functions.
25179
25180 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25181 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25182 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25183 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25184 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25185 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25186 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25187 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25188 form. The error part of that result is used for
25189 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25190 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25191 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25192 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25193 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25194 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25195 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25196 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25197 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25198 arithmetic with no error forms.
25199
25200 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25201 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25202 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25203 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25204 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25205 @texline @math{\sigma}
25206 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25207 for the data point with no further ado.)
25208
25209 @tex
25210 \bigskip
25211 @end tex
25212
25213 @vindex FitRules
25214 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25215 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25216 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25217 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25218 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25219 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25220 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25221
25222 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25223
25224 @ignore
25225 @starindex
25226 @end ignore
25227 @tindex fitvar
25228 @ignore
25229 @starindex
25230 @end ignore
25231 @ignore
25232 @mindex @idots
25233 @end ignore
25234 @tindex fitparam
25235 @ignore
25236 @starindex
25237 @end ignore
25238 @ignore
25239 @mindex @null
25240 @end ignore
25241 @tindex fitmodel
25242 @ignore
25243 @starindex
25244 @end ignore
25245 @ignore
25246 @mindex @null
25247 @end ignore
25248 @tindex fitsystem
25249 @ignore
25250 @starindex
25251 @end ignore
25252 @ignore
25253 @mindex @null
25254 @end ignore
25255 @tindex fitdummy
25256 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25257 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25258 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25259 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25260 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25261 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25262 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25263 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25264 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25265
25266 @smallexample
25267 @group
25268 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25269 @end group
25270 @end smallexample
25271
25272 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25273 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25274 changes are possible.)
25275
25276 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25277 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25278
25279 @example
25280 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25281 @end example
25282
25283 @noindent
25284 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25285 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25286 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25287 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25288 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25289 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25290 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25291
25292 The power law model eventually boils down to
25293
25294 @smallexample
25295 @group
25296 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25297 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25298 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25299 @end group
25300 @end smallexample
25301
25302 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25303 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25304 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25305 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25306 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25307 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25308 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25309 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25310 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25311 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25312 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25313 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25314 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25315
25316 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25317 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25318 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25319 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25320 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25321 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25322 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25323 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25324 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25325 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25326 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25327 raw parameters, for now.)
25328
25329 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25330 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25331 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25332 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25333 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25334 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25335 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25336 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25337 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25338 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25339 raw parameters needed.
25340
25341 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25342 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25343 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25344 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25345 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25346 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25347 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25348 least-squares solver wants to see.
25349
25350 @ignore
25351 @starindex
25352 @end ignore
25353 @ignore
25354 @mindex hasfit@idots
25355 @end ignore
25356 @tindex hasfitparams
25357 @ignore
25358 @starindex
25359 @end ignore
25360 @ignore
25361 @mindex @null
25362 @end ignore
25363 @tindex hasfitvars
25364 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25365 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25366 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25367 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25368 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25369 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25370 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25371 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25372 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25373
25374 @tex
25375 \bigskip
25376 @end tex
25377
25378 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25379 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25380 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25381 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25382 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25383 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25384 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25385 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25386 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25387 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25388
25389 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25390 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25391 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25392 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25393 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25394
25395 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25396 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25397 and variables, as discussed previously.
25398
25399 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25400 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25401 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25402 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25403
25404 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25405 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25406
25407 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25408 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25409
25410 @kindex a p
25411 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25412 @tindex polint
25413 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25414 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25415 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25416 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25417 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25418 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25419 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25420 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25421 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25422
25423 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25424 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25425 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25426 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25427 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25428 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25429
25430 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25431 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25432
25433 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25434 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25435 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25436 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25437 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25438 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25439
25440 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25441 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25442
25443 @kindex H a p
25444 @tindex ratint
25445 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25446 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25447 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25448 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25449 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25450 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25451
25452 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25453 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25454 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25455 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25456 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25457 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25458
25459 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25460 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25461 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25462 capabilities to fit.)
25463
25464 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25465 @section Summations
25466
25467 @noindent
25468 @cindex Summation of a series
25469 @kindex a +
25470 @pindex calc-summation
25471 @tindex sum
25472 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25473 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25474 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25475 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25476 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25477 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25478 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25479 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25480 produces the result 55.
25481 @tex
25482 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25483 @end tex
25484
25485 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25486 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25487 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25488 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25489 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25490 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25491 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25492 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25493 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25494
25495 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25496 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25497 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25498 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25499 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25500 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25501 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25502 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25503 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25504
25505 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25506 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25507 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25508 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25509 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25510 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25511 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25512 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25513 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25514 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25515
25516 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25517 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25518 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25519 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25520 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25521 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25522
25523 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25524 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25525 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25526 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25527 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25528 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25529 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25530 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25531
25532 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25533 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25534 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25535 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25536 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25537 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25538
25539 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25540 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25541 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25542 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25543 after algebraic simplification, evaluate to an integer.
25544
25545 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25546 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25547 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25548 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25549 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25550 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25551 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25552 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25553
25554 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25555 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25556 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25557 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25558 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25559 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25560 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25561
25562 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25563 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25564 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25565 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25566 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25567 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25568 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25569 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25570 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25571 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25572 closed form.
25573
25574 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25575 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25576 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25577 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25578 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25579 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25580 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25581 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25582 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25583 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25584 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25585 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25586 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25587 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25588
25589 @cindex Alternating sums
25590 @kindex a -
25591 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25592 @tindex asum
25593 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25594 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25595 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25596 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25597 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25598 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25599 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25600 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25601 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25602 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25603 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25604 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25605
25606 @cindex Product of a sequence
25607 @kindex a *
25608 @pindex calc-product
25609 @tindex prod
25610 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25611 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25612 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25613 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25614 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25615
25616 @kindex a T
25617 @pindex calc-tabulate
25618 @tindex table
25619 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25620 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25621 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25622 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25623 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25624
25625 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25626 @section Logical Operations
25627
25628 @noindent
25629 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25630 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25631 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25632 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25633 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25634 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25635 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25636 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25637 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25638 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25639 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25640 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25641 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25642 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25643
25644 @kindex a =
25645 @pindex calc-equal-to
25646 @tindex eq
25647 @tindex =
25648 @tindex ==
25649 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25650 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25651 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25652 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25653 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25654 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25655 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25656 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25657 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25658
25659 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25660 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25661 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25662 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25663 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25664 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25665 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25666 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25667 zero if not.
25668
25669 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25670 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25671 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25672 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25673 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25674 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25675 variables).
25676
25677 @kindex a #
25678 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25679 @tindex neq
25680 @tindex !=
25681 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25682 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25683 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25684 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25685 distinct numbers.
25686
25687 @kindex a <
25688 @tindex lt
25689 @ignore
25690 @mindex @idots
25691 @end ignore
25692 @kindex a >
25693 @ignore
25694 @mindex @null
25695 @end ignore
25696 @kindex a [
25697 @ignore
25698 @mindex @null
25699 @end ignore
25700 @kindex a ]
25701 @pindex calc-less-than
25702 @pindex calc-greater-than
25703 @pindex calc-less-equal
25704 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25705 @ignore
25706 @mindex @null
25707 @end ignore
25708 @tindex gt
25709 @ignore
25710 @mindex @null
25711 @end ignore
25712 @tindex leq
25713 @ignore
25714 @mindex @null
25715 @end ignore
25716 @tindex geq
25717 @ignore
25718 @mindex @null
25719 @end ignore
25720 @tindex <
25721 @ignore
25722 @mindex @null
25723 @end ignore
25724 @tindex >
25725 @ignore
25726 @mindex @null
25727 @end ignore
25728 @tindex <=
25729 @ignore
25730 @mindex @null
25731 @end ignore
25732 @tindex >=
25733 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25734 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25735 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25736 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25737 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25738
25739 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25740 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25741 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25742 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25743 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25744 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25745 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25746 involve both equations and inequalities, are not allowed.
25747
25748 @kindex a .
25749 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25750 @tindex rmeq
25751 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25752 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25753 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25754 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25755 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25756 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25757 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25758 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25759 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25760 taking the lefthand side.
25761
25762 @kindex a &
25763 @pindex calc-logical-and
25764 @tindex land
25765 @tindex &&
25766 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25767 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25768 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25769 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25770 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25771
25772 @kindex a |
25773 @pindex calc-logical-or
25774 @tindex lor
25775 @tindex ||
25776 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25777 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25778 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25779 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25780 zero.
25781
25782 @kindex a !
25783 @pindex calc-logical-not
25784 @tindex lnot
25785 @tindex !
25786 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25787 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25788 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25789 number.
25790
25791 @kindex a :
25792 @pindex calc-logical-if
25793 @tindex if
25794 @ignore
25795 @mindex ? :
25796 @end ignore
25797 @tindex ?
25798 @ignore
25799 @mindex @null
25800 @end ignore
25801 @tindex :
25802 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25803 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25804 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25805 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25806 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25807 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25808 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25809 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25810 @code{condition}.
25811
25812 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25813 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25814 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25815 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25816
25817 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25818 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25819 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25820 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25821 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25822 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25823 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25824
25825 @kindex a @{
25826 @pindex calc-in-set
25827 @tindex in
25828 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25829 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25830 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25831 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25832 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25833 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25834 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25835 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25836 of this sort.
25837
25838 @ignore
25839 @starindex
25840 @end ignore
25841 @tindex typeof
25842 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25843 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25844 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25845
25846 @example
25847 1 Integer
25848 2 Fraction
25849 3 Floating-point number
25850 4 HMS form
25851 5 Rectangular complex number
25852 6 Polar complex number
25853 7 Error form
25854 8 Interval form
25855 9 Modulo form
25856 10 Date-only form
25857 11 Date/time form
25858 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25859 100 Variable
25860 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25861 102 Matrix
25862 @end example
25863
25864 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25865 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25866
25867 @ignore
25868 @starindex
25869 @end ignore
25870 @tindex integer
25871 @ignore
25872 @starindex
25873 @end ignore
25874 @tindex real
25875 @ignore
25876 @starindex
25877 @end ignore
25878 @tindex constant
25879 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25880 The @samp{real(a)} function
25881 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25882 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25883 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25884 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25885 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25886 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25887 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25888
25889 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25890 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25891 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25892 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25893 literally an integer constant.
25894
25895 @ignore
25896 @starindex
25897 @end ignore
25898 @tindex refers
25899 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25900 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25901 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25902 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25903 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25904 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25905
25906 @ignore
25907 @starindex
25908 @end ignore
25909 @tindex negative
25910 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25911 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25912 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25913 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25914 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25915 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25916 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25917 as a rewrite rule condition).
25918
25919 @ignore
25920 @starindex
25921 @end ignore
25922 @tindex variable
25923 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25924 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25925 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25926 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25927
25928 @ignore
25929 @starindex
25930 @end ignore
25931 @tindex nonvar
25932 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25933 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25934 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25935 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25936 often good enough.
25937
25938 @ignore
25939 @starindex
25940 @end ignore
25941 @tindex lin
25942 @ignore
25943 @starindex
25944 @end ignore
25945 @tindex linnt
25946 @ignore
25947 @starindex
25948 @end ignore
25949 @tindex islin
25950 @ignore
25951 @starindex
25952 @end ignore
25953 @tindex islinnt
25954 @cindex Linearity testing
25955 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25956 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25957 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25958 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25959 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25960 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25961 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25962 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25963 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25964 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25965 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25966 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25967 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25968 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25969 returns true.
25970
25971 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25972 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25973 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25974 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25975 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25976 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25977 linear in @expr{x}).
25978
25979 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25980 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25981 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25982 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25983 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25984 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25985 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25986 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25987 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25988 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25989
25990 @ignore
25991 @starindex
25992 @end ignore
25993 @tindex istrue
25994 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25995 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25996 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25997 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25998 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25999 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
26000 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
26001 in symbolic form.)
26002
26003 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
26004 @section Rewrite Rules
26005
26006 @noindent
26007 @cindex Rewrite rules
26008 @cindex Transformations
26009 @cindex Pattern matching
26010 @kindex a r
26011 @pindex calc-rewrite
26012 @tindex rewrite
26013 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
26014 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
26015 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
26016 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
26017 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
26018 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
26019 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
26020 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
26021 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
26022
26023 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
26024 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
26025 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
26026 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
26027 Calc formulas.
26028
26029 @menu
26030 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
26031 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
26032 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
26033 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
26034 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
26035 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
26036 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
26037 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
26038 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
26039 * Matching Commands::
26040 * Automatic Rewrites::
26041 * Debugging Rewrites::
26042 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
26043 @end menu
26044
26045 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26046 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
26047
26048 @noindent
26049 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
26050 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
26051 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
26052 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
26053 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
26054 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
26055 assignments in special ways.
26056
26057 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
26058 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
26059 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
26060 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
26061 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
26062
26063 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
26064 rules.
26065
26066 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
26067 in several ways:
26068
26069 @enumerate
26070 @item
26071 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
26072 @item
26073 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
26074 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
26075 @item
26076 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
26077 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
26078 @item
26079 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
26080 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
26081 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
26082 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
26083 @item
26084 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
26085 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
26086 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
26087 @end enumerate
26088
26089 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
26090 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
26091 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
26092
26093 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
26094 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
26095 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
26096 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
26097 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
26098 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
26099
26100 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
26101 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
26102 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
26103 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
26104 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
26105 reason to store your rules in a variable.
26106
26107 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
26108 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
26109 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
26110
26111 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26112 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
26113
26114 @noindent
26115 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
26116 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
26117 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
26118 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
26119 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
26120 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
26121 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
26122 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
26123 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
26124 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
26125 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26126
26127 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26128 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26129 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26130 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26131 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26132
26133 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26134 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26135 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26136 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26137 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
26138
26139 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26140 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26141 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26142 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26143
26144 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26145 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26146 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26147 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26148 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26149
26150 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26151 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26152 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26153 change at a time.
26154
26155 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26156 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26157
26158 @noindent
26159 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26160 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26161 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26162 is present in the
26163 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26164 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26165 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26166 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26167 with Calc's algebraic simplifications. If the result is a nonzero
26168 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26169 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26170 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26171 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26172 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26173
26174 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26175 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26176 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26177 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26178 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26179 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26180 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26181 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26182 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26183
26184 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26185 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26186 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26187 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26188 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26189 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26190 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26191 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26192 the condition.
26193
26194 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26195 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26196 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26197
26198 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26199 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26200
26201 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26202 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26203 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26204 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26205 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26206 matched.
26207
26208 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26209 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26210 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26211 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26212 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26213 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26214 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26215 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26216 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26217
26218 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26219 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26220 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26221 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26222 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26223 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26224 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26225 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26226 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26227
26228 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26229 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26230 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26231 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26232 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26233 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26234 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26235 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26236 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26237
26238 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26239 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26240
26241 @noindent
26242 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26243 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26244 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26245 account:
26246
26247 @smallexample
26248 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26249 @end smallexample
26250
26251 For example, the rewrite rule:
26252
26253 @example
26254 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26255 @end example
26256
26257 @noindent
26258 will match formulas of the form,
26259
26260 @example
26261 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26262 @end example
26263
26264 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26265 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26266
26267 @example
26268 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26269 @end example
26270
26271 @noindent
26272 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26273
26274 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26275 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26276 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26277
26278 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26279 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26280 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26281 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26282 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26283 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26284 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26285 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26286
26287 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26288 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26289 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26290 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26291 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26292 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26293 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26294 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26295 from occurring.
26296
26297 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26298 the rule
26299
26300 @example
26301 f(-x) := -f(x)
26302 @end example
26303
26304 @noindent
26305 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26306 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26307 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26308 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26309 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26310 condition is:
26311
26312 @example
26313 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26314 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26315 @end example
26316
26317 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26318 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26319
26320 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26321 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26322 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26323 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26324
26325 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26326 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26327 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26328 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26329 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26330 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26331 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26332 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26333 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26334 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26335
26336 Even more subtle is the rule set
26337
26338 @example
26339 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26340 @end example
26341
26342 @noindent
26343 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26344 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26345 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26346 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26347 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26348 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26349 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26350 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26351 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26352 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26353 rule will have to be added.
26354
26355 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26356 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26357 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26358 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26359 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26360
26361 @example
26362 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26363 @end example
26364
26365 @noindent
26366 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26367 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26368 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26369 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26370 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26371 conjugate of a real number.)
26372
26373 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26374
26375 @example
26376 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26377 @end example
26378
26379 @noindent
26380 will match the formula
26381
26382 @example
26383 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26384 @end example
26385
26386 @noindent
26387 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26388 formulas like
26389
26390 @example
26391 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26392 @end example
26393
26394 @noindent
26395 producing, respectively,
26396
26397 @example
26398 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26399 @end example
26400
26401 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26402 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26403
26404 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26405 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26406 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26407 with @samp{a = -1}.
26408
26409 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26410
26411 @example
26412 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26413 @end example
26414
26415 @noindent
26416 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26417
26418 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26419 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26420 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26421 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26422 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26423 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26424 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26425 for a multiplication, not a division.
26426
26427 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26428 by 1,
26429
26430 @example
26431 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26432 @end example
26433
26434 @noindent
26435 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26436 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26437
26438 @example
26439 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26440 @end example
26441
26442 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26443 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26444
26445 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26446
26447 @example
26448 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26449 @end example
26450
26451 @noindent
26452 into the form
26453
26454 @example
26455 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26456 @end example
26457
26458 @noindent
26459 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26460 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26461 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26462 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26463 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26464
26465 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26466 following rule,
26467
26468 @example
26469 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26470 @end example
26471
26472 @noindent
26473 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26474 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26475 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26476 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26477 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26478 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26479 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26480
26481 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26482 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26483 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26484
26485 @example
26486 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26487 @end example
26488
26489 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26490 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26491 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26492 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26493 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26494 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26495 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26496 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26497
26498 @smallexample
26499 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26500 max min re im conj arg
26501 @end smallexample
26502
26503 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26504 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26505 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26506 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26507 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26508 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26509 For example,
26510
26511 @example
26512 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26513 @end example
26514
26515 @noindent
26516 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26517 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26518 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26519 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26520 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26521 further and use
26522
26523 @example
26524 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26525 @end example
26526
26527 @noindent
26528 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26529
26530 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26531 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26532 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26533
26534 @example
26535 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26536 @end example
26537
26538 @noindent
26539 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26540
26541 @example
26542 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26543 @end example
26544
26545 @noindent
26546 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26547 effect!
26548
26549 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26550 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26551 in the rule
26552
26553 @example
26554 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26555 @end example
26556
26557 @noindent
26558 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26559 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26560 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26561 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26562 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26563 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26564 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26565 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26566 marker on the righthand side:
26567
26568 @example
26569 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26570 @end example
26571
26572 @noindent
26573 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26574 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26575 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26576
26577 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26578 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26579
26580 @noindent
26581 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26582 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26583 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26584 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26585
26586 @ignore
26587 @starindex
26588 @end ignore
26589 @tindex import
26590 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26591 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26592 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26593 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26594 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26595 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26596 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26597 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26598 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26599 @texline @math{v_1},
26600 @infoline @expr{v1},
26601 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26602 @texline @math{x_1}
26603 @infoline @expr{x1}
26604 and so on. (If
26605 @texline @math{v_1}
26606 @infoline @expr{v1}
26607 is used as a function name, then
26608 @texline @math{x_1}
26609 @infoline @expr{x1}
26610 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26611 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26612 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26613 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26614 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26615
26616 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26617
26618 @table @samp
26619 @item quote(x)
26620 @ignore
26621 @starindex
26622 @end ignore
26623 @tindex quote
26624 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26625 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26626 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26627 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26628 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26629 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26630 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26631 as a result in this case.)
26632
26633 @item plain(x)
26634 @ignore
26635 @starindex
26636 @end ignore
26637 @tindex plain
26638 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26639 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26640 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26641 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26642 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26643 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26644 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26645 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26646
26647 @item opt(x,def)
26648 @ignore
26649 @starindex
26650 @end ignore
26651 @tindex opt
26652 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26653 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26654 the argument or element is optional.
26655 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26656 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26657 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26658 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26659 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26660 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26661
26662 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26663 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26664 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26665 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26666 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26667 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26668 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26669 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26670 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26671
26672 @item condition(x,c)
26673 @ignore
26674 @starindex
26675 @end ignore
26676 @tindex condition
26677 @tindex ::
26678 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26679 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26680
26681 @item pand(x,y)
26682 @ignore
26683 @starindex
26684 @end ignore
26685 @tindex pand
26686 @tindex &&&
26687 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26688 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26689 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26690
26691 @item por(x,y)
26692 @ignore
26693 @starindex
26694 @end ignore
26695 @tindex por
26696 @tindex |||
26697 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26698 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26699
26700 @item pnot(x)
26701 @ignore
26702 @starindex
26703 @end ignore
26704 @tindex pnot
26705 @tindex !!!
26706 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26707 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26708
26709 @item cons(h,t)
26710 @ignore
26711 @mindex cons
26712 @end ignore
26713 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26714 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26715 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26716 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26717 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26718 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26719 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26720
26721 @item rcons(t,h)
26722 @ignore
26723 @mindex rcons
26724 @end ignore
26725 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26726 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26727 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26728 to @expr{t}.
26729
26730 @item apply(f,args)
26731 @ignore
26732 @mindex apply
26733 @end ignore
26734 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26735 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26736 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26737 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26738 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26739 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26740 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26741 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26742 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26743 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26744 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26745 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26746 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26747 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26748 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26749
26750 @example
26751 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26752 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26753 @end example
26754
26755 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26756 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26757 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26758 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26759 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26760 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26761 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26762
26763 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26764 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26765 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26766
26767 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26768 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26769 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26770 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26771 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26772 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26773 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26774 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26775 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26776 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26777
26778 @item select(x)
26779 @ignore
26780 @starindex
26781 @end ignore
26782 @tindex select
26783 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26784 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26785 @end table
26786
26787 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26788
26789 @table @samp
26790 @item quote(x)
26791 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26792 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26793 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26794 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26795 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26796 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26797 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26798 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26799 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26800 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26801
26802 @item plain(x)
26803 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26804 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26805 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26806 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26807 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26808 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26809 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26810
26811 @item cons(h,t)
26812 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26813 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26814 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26815 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26816 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26817 have been turned off.
26818
26819 @item rcons(t,h)
26820 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26821 the vector @expr{t}.
26822
26823 @item apply(f,args)
26824 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26825 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26826 is also a regular Calc function.
26827
26828 @item eval(x)
26829 @ignore
26830 @starindex
26831 @end ignore
26832 @tindex eval
26833 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26834 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26835 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26836 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26837 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26838 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26839 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26840
26841 @item evalsimp(x)
26842 @ignore
26843 @starindex
26844 @end ignore
26845 @tindex evalsimp
26846 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26847 way, then algebraically simplified.
26848
26849 @item evalextsimp(x)
26850 @ignore
26851 @starindex
26852 @end ignore
26853 @tindex evalextsimp
26854 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26855 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26856
26857 @item select(x)
26858 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26859 @end table
26860
26861 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26862
26863 @table @samp
26864 @item let(v := x)
26865 @ignore
26866 @starindex
26867 @end ignore
26868 @tindex let
26869 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26870 The algebraic simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26871 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26872 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26873 of simplification. The result of @expr{x} is then bound to the
26874 meta-variable @expr{v}. As usual, if this meta-variable has already
26875 been matched to something else the two values must be equal; if the
26876 meta-variable is new then it is bound to the result of the expression.
26877 This variable can then appear in later conditions, and on the righthand
26878 side of the rule.
26879 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26880 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26881 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26882 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26883 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26884 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26885
26886 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26887 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26888 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26889 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26890
26891 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26892 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26893 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26894 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26895 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26896 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26897 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26898 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26899 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26900 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26901 be bound to @code{ia}.
26902
26903 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26904 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26905 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26906 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26907 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26908 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26909 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26910 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26911 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26912 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26913
26914 @ignore
26915 @starindex
26916 @end ignore
26917 @tindex ierf
26918 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26919 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26920 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26921 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26922 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26923 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26924
26925 @example
26926 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26927 @end example
26928
26929 @item matches(v,p)
26930 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26931 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26932 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26933 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26934 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26935 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26936 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26937 rule.
26938
26939 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26940 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26941 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26942
26943 @item remember
26944 @vindex remember
26945 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26946 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26947 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26948 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26949 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26950 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26951 contains any variables.
26952
26953 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26954 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26955 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26956 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26957 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26958 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26959
26960 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26961 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26962 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26963 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26964 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26965 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26966 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26967
26968 @item remember(c)
26969 @ignore
26970 @starindex
26971 @end ignore
26972 @tindex remember
26973 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26974 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26975 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26976 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26977 @end table
26978
26979 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26980 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26981
26982 @noindent
26983 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26984 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26985 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26986 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26987 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26988
26989 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26990 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26991 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26992
26993 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26994 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26995 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26996 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26997
26998 @example
26999 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
27000 @end example
27001
27002 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
27003
27004 @example
27005 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
27006 @end example
27007
27008 @ignore
27009 @starindex
27010 @end ignore
27011 @tindex ends
27012 Here's another interesting example:
27013
27014 @example
27015 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
27016 @end example
27017
27018 @noindent
27019 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
27020 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
27021 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
27022
27023 @example
27024 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
27025 @end example
27026
27027 @noindent
27028 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
27029 one-element vector.
27030
27031 @tex
27032 \bigskip
27033 @end tex
27034
27035 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
27036 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
27037 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
27038
27039 @ignore
27040 @starindex
27041 @end ignore
27042 @tindex curve
27043 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
27044
27045 @example
27046 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
27047 @end example
27048
27049 @noindent
27050 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
27051
27052 Here is a larger example:
27053
27054 @example
27055 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
27056 @end example
27057
27058 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
27059 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
27060 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
27061
27062 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
27063 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
27064
27065 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
27066 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
27067 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
27068 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
27069 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
27070 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
27071 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
27072 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
27073
27074 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
27075 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
27076 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
27077 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
27078
27079 @example
27080 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
27081 @end example
27082
27083 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
27084 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
27085
27086 @tex
27087 \bigskip
27088 @end tex
27089
27090 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
27091 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
27092 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
27093
27094 For example,
27095
27096 @example
27097 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
27098 @end example
27099
27100 @noindent
27101 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
27102 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
27103 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
27104
27105 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
27106 then an equivalent rule would be:
27107
27108 @example
27109 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
27110 @end example
27111
27112 @noindent
27113 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
27114 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
27115 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
27116 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
27117 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
27118 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
27119 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
27120
27121 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
27122 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
27123
27124 @example
27125 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27126 @end example
27127
27128 @noindent
27129 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27130 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27131
27132 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27133 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27134 matched last. Thus
27135
27136 @example
27137 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27138 @end example
27139
27140 @noindent
27141 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27142 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27143 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27144 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27145 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27146 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27147
27148 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27149 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27150
27151 @noindent
27152 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27153 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27154 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27155 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27156 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27157 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27158 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27159 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27160
27161 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27162 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27163 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27164 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27165 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27166 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27167 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27168 anywhere in the formula.
27169
27170 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27171 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27172 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27173 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27174 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27175 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27176 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27177 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27178 forms.
27179
27180 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27181 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27182 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27183 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27184 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27185
27186 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27187 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27188 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27189 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27190
27191 @ignore
27192 @starindex
27193 @end ignore
27194 @ignore
27195 @mindex iter@idots
27196 @end ignore
27197 @tindex iterations
27198 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27199 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27200 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27201 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27202 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27203 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27204 rule set.
27205
27206 @example
27207 [ iterations(1),
27208 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27209 @end example
27210
27211 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27212 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27213 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27214 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27215 that was matched.
27216
27217 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27218
27219 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27220 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27221 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27222
27223 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27224 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27225 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27226 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27227 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27228 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27229 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27230 are omitted, 100 is used.
27231
27232 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27233 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27234
27235 @noindent
27236 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27237 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27238 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27239 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27240
27241 @ignore
27242 @starindex
27243 @end ignore
27244 @tindex phase
27245 @vindex all
27246 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27247 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27248 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27249 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27250 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27251 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27252
27253 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27254 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27255 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27256
27257 @example
27258 @group
27259 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27260 phase(1),
27261 f1(x) := g1(x),
27262 phase(2),
27263 f2(x) := g2(x),
27264 phase(3),
27265 f3(x) := g3(x),
27266 phase(1,2),
27267 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27268 @end group
27269 @end example
27270
27271 @noindent
27272 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27273 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27274 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27275 and @code{f3}.
27276
27277 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27278 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27279 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27280 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27281 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27282 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27283 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27284 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27285 100 by default, is reached.)
27286
27287 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27288 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27289 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27290 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27291 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27292 in the formula.
27293
27294 @ignore
27295 @starindex
27296 @end ignore
27297 @tindex schedule
27298 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27299 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27300 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27301 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27302 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27303 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27304 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27305 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27306 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27307 moving on to phase 3.
27308
27309 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27310 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27311 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27312 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27313 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27314 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27315 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27316 touches.
27317
27318 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27319 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27320 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27321 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27322 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27323 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27324 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27325
27326 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27327 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27328 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27329 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27330 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27331 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27332
27333 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27334 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27335 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27336 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27337 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27338 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27339 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27340 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27341 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27342 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27343 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27344
27345 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27346 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27347 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27348 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27349 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27350 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27351 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27352
27353 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27354 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27355
27356 @noindent
27357 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27358 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27359 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27360 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27361 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27362
27363 @kindex j r
27364 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27365 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27366 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27367 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27368 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27369 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27370 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27371 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27372 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27373
27374 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27375 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27376 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27377 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27378 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27379 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27380
27381 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27382 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27383 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27384 formula will be unselected.
27385
27386 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27387 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27388 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27389 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27390 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27391 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27392 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27393 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27394
27395 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27396 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27397 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27398 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27399
27400 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27401 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27402 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27403 at stack level 1.)
27404
27405 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27406 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27407 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27408 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27409 target and the rewrite rules).
27410
27411 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27412 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27413 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27414 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27415 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27416 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27417
27418 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27419 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27420 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27421 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27422 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27423 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27424 both with and without selections.
27425
27426 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27427 @subsection Matching Commands
27428
27429 @noindent
27430 @kindex a m
27431 @pindex calc-match
27432 @tindex match
27433 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27434 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27435 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27436 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27437 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27438 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27439 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27440 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27441 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27442 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27443 of the patterns.
27444
27445 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27446 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27447
27448 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27449
27450 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27451 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27452 all the positive vector elements.
27453
27454 @kindex I a m
27455 @tindex matchnot
27456 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27457 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27458
27459 @ignore
27460 @starindex
27461 @end ignore
27462 @tindex matches
27463 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27464 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27465 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27466 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27467
27468 @ignore
27469 @starindex
27470 @end ignore
27471 @tindex vmatches
27472 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27473 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27474 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27475 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27476 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27477
27478 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27479 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27480
27481 @noindent
27482 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27483 @vindex EvalRules
27484 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27485 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27486 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27487 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27488 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27489
27490 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27491 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27492 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27493 set would be,
27494
27495 @smallexample
27496 @group
27497 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27498 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27499 @end group
27500 @end smallexample
27501
27502 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27503 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27504 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27505 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27506 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27507 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27508 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27509
27510 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27511 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27512 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27513 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27514 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27515 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27516 applies rules from the top down.
27517
27518 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27519 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27520
27521 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27522 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27523 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27524 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27525 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27526 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27527 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27528 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27529 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27530 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27531 or ran too long'' message.
27532
27533 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27534 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27535 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27536 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27537 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27538 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27539 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27540 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27541 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27542 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27543 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27544 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27545 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27546
27547 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27548 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27549 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27550 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27551 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27552 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27553 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27554 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27555 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27556 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27557 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27558 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27559 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27560
27561 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27562 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27563 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27564 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27565
27566 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27567 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27568 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27569 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27570 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27571 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27572 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27573 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27574
27575 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27576 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27577 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27578 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27579 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27580 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27581 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27582 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27583 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27584 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27585 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27586 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27587 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27588 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27589
27590 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27591 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27592 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27593 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27594 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27595 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27596 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27597 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27598 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27599 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27600 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27601 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27602 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27603
27604 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27605 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27606
27607 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27608 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27609 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27610 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27611 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27612 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27613 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27614
27615 @smallexample
27616 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27617 @end smallexample
27618
27619 @noindent
27620 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27621 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27622 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27623 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27624
27625 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27626 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27627 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27628 but only when algebraic simplifications are used to simplify the
27629 formula. The variable @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose.
27630 The @kbd{a s} command will apply @code{EvalRules} and
27631 @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as well as all of its built-in
27632 simplifications.
27633
27634 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27635 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27636 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of algebraic
27637 simplifications. It then applies its own built-in simplifications
27638 throughout the formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with
27639 applying the default simplifications) until no further changes are
27640 possible.
27641
27642 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27643 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27644 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27645 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27646 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27647 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27648 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27649 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27650 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27651
27652 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27653 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27654
27655 @noindent
27656 If a buffer named @file{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27657 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27658 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27659 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27660 noted.
27661
27662 Calc always appends to @file{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27663 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27664
27665 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27666 @file{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27667 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27668 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27669 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27670 be needlessly slow.
27671
27672 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27673 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27674
27675 @noindent
27676 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27677 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27678 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27679 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27680 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27681 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27682 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27683
27684 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27685 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27686 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27687 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27688 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27689 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27690 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27691
27692 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27693 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27694 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27695 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27696 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27697 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27698 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27699 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27700
27701 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27702 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27703 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27704 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27705 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27706 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27707 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27708 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27709 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27710 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27711
27712 @cindex Quaternions
27713 The following rule set, contributed by
27714 @texline Fran\c cois
27715 @infoline Francois
27716 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27717 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27718 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27719 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27720 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27721 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27722 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27723 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27724 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27725 @key{RET}}.
27726
27727 @smallexample
27728 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27729 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27730 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27731 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27732 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27733 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27734 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27735 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27736 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27737 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27738 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27739 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27740 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27741 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27742 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27743 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27744 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27745 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27746 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27747 @end smallexample
27748
27749 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27750 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27751 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27752 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27753 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27754 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27755 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27756
27757 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27758 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27759 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27760 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27761 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27762 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27763
27764 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27765 @chapter Operating on Units
27766
27767 @noindent
27768 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27769 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27770 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27771 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27772 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27773
27774 @menu
27775 * Basic Operations on Units::
27776 * The Units Table::
27777 * Predefined Units::
27778 * User-Defined Units::
27779 * Logarithmic Units::
27780 * Musical Notes::
27781 @end menu
27782
27783 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27784 @section Basic Operations on Units
27785
27786 @noindent
27787 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27788 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27789 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27790 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27791 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27792 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27793 formula.
27794
27795 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27796 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27797 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27798 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27799 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27800 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27801
27802 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27803 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27804 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27805 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27806 representation of one millimeter.
27807
27808 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27809 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27810 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27811
27812 @kindex u s
27813 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27814 @ignore
27815 @mindex usimpl@idots
27816 @end ignore
27817 @tindex usimplify
27818 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27819 simplifies a units
27820 expression. It uses Calc's algebraic simplifications to simplify the
27821 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27822 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27823 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27824 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27825 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27826 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27827 automatically at all times.
27828
27829 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27830 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27831 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27832 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27833 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27834 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27835 applied to units expressions, in which case
27836 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27837 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27838 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27839
27840 @kindex u c
27841 @pindex calc-convert-units
27842 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27843 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27844 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27845 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27846 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27847 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27848 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27849 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27850 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27851
27852 @kindex u t
27853 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27854 @cindex Temperature conversion
27855 The @kbd{u c} command treats temperature units (like @samp{degC} and
27856 @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example, @kbd{u c} converts
27857 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10 degrees Celsius
27858 corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit. To convert absolute
27859 temperatures, you can use the @kbd{u t}
27860 (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command. The value on the stack
27861 must be a simple units expression with units of temperature only.
27862 This command would convert @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the
27863 equivalent temperature on the Fahrenheit scale.
27864
27865 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27866 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27867 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27868 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27869 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27870 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27871 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27872
27873 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27874 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27875 units are left over. (This can be disabled; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
27876 For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27877 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27878 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27879 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27880 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27881 input units.
27882
27883 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27884 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27885 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27886 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27887 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27888 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27889 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27890 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27891
27892 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27893 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27894 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27895 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27896 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27897 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27898
27899 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27900 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27901 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27902 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27903 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27904 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27905 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27906
27907 @cindex Composite units
27908 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27909 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27910 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27911 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27912 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27913 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27914 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27915 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27916 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27917 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27918 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27919 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27920 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27921
27922 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27923 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27924 to have, then for the new units. (If the value on the stack can be
27925 simplified so that it doesn't contain any units, like @samp{ft/in} can
27926 be simplified to 12, then @kbd{u c} will still prompt for both old
27927 units and new units. Assuming the old and new units you give are
27928 consistent with each other, the result also will not contain any
27929 units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}} converts
27930 the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27931
27932 @kindex u b
27933 @pindex calc-base-units
27934 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27935 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27936 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27937 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27938
27939 Like the @kbd{u c} command, the @kbd{u b} command treats temperature
27940 units as relative temperatures.
27941
27942 @kindex u r
27943 @pindex calc-remove-units
27944 @kindex u x
27945 @pindex calc-extract-units
27946 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27947 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27948 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27949 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27950 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27951 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27952
27953 @kindex u a
27954 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27955 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27956 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27957 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27958 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27959 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27960 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27961 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27962 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27963 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27964
27965 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27966 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27967 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27968 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27969 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27970 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27971 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27972 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27973 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27974 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27975 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27976 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27977 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27978 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27979 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27980 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27981
27982 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27983 @section The Units Table
27984
27985 @noindent
27986 @kindex u v
27987 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27988 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27989 in another buffer called @file{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27990 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27991 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27992 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27993 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27994 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27995 and steradians.
27996
27997 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27998 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27999 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
28000 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
28001 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
28002 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
28003
28004 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
28005 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
28006 argument to @kbd{u v}.
28007
28008 @kindex u V
28009 @pindex calc-view-units-table
28010 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
28011 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
28012 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
28013 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
28014 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
28015 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
28016 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
28017
28018 @kindex u g
28019 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
28020 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
28021 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
28022 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
28023 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
28024 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
28025 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
28026 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
28027 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
28028 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
28029
28030 @kindex u e
28031 @pindex calc-explain-units
28032 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
28033 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
28034 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
28035 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
28036 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
28037 column of the Units Table.
28038
28039 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
28040 @section Predefined Units
28041
28042 @noindent
28043 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
28044 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
28045 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
28046 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
28047 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
28048 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
28049 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
28050 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
28051 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
28052 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
28053 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
28054 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
28055 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
28056 international prototype of the kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
28057 kept at the Bureau international des poids et mesures in S@`evres,
28058 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
28059 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
28060 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
28061 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
28062 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
28063 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
28064 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
28065
28066 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
28067 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
28068 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
28069 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
28070 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
28071 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
28072 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
28073 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
28074
28075 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
28076 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
28077 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
28078 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
28079 of the various temperature scales.
28080
28081 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
28082 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
28083
28084 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
28085 @tex
28086 for \AA ngstroms.
28087 @end tex
28088 @ifnottex
28089 for Angstroms.
28090 @end ifnottex
28091
28092 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
28093 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
28094 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
28095 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
28096 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
28097 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
28098 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
28099 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
28100 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
28101 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
28102 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
28103 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
28104
28105 When Calc is using the @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
28106 and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
28107 use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
28108 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
28109 the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
28110 @samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
28111
28112
28113 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
28114 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
28115 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
28116 preferable to @code{e}.
28117
28118 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
28119 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
28120 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
28121
28122 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
28123 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
28124
28125 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28126 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28127
28128 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28129 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28130 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28131 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28132 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28133 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28134 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28135 units.
28136
28137 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28138 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28139 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28140 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28141 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28142 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28143 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28144 really is unitless.)
28145
28146 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28147
28148 @node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
28149 @section User-Defined Units
28150
28151 @noindent
28152 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28153 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28154
28155 @kindex u 0-9
28156 @pindex calc-quick-units
28157 @vindex Units
28158 @cindex @code{Units} variable
28159 @cindex Quick units
28160 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28161 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28162 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28163 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28164 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28165 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28166 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28167 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28168 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28169 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28170 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28171 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28172
28173 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28174 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28175 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28176 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28177 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28178 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28179
28180 @kindex u d
28181 @pindex calc-define-unit
28182 @cindex User-defined units
28183 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28184 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28185 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28186 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28187 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28188 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28189 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28190 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28191 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28192 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28193 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28194 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28195
28196 @kindex u u
28197 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28198 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28199 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28200 however.
28201
28202 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28203 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28204 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28205 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28206 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28207
28208 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28209 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28210 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28211 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28212 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28213 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28214 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28215 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28216 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28217
28218 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28219 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28220
28221 @kindex u p
28222 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28223 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28224 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28225 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28226 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
28227 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28228 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28229 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28230 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28231
28232 @node Logarithmic Units, Musical Notes, User-Defined Units, Units
28233 @section Logarithmic Units
28234
28235 The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28236 units which are manipulated differently than standard units. Calc
28237 provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28238
28239 Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28240 field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power);
28241 these two types of quantities are handled slightly different from each
28242 other. By default the Calc commands work as if power quantities are
28243 being used; with the @kbd{H} prefix the Calc commands work as if field
28244 quantities are being used.
28245
28246 The decibel level of a power
28247 @infoline @math{P1},
28248 @texline @math{P_1},
28249 relative to a reference power
28250 @infoline @math{P0},
28251 @texline @math{P_0},
28252 is defined to be
28253 @infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28254 @texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28255 (The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28256 one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28257 considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28258 the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28259 @math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28260 @infoline @math{F0}
28261 @texline @math{F_0}
28262 would correspond to a power of
28263 @infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28264 @texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28265 If
28266 @infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28267 @texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28268 then
28269
28270 @ifnottex
28271 @example
28272 10 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28273 @end example
28274 @end ifnottex
28275 @tex
28276 $$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28277 \log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28278 @end tex
28279
28280 @noindent
28281 In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28282 quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28283 level of a field quantity
28284 @infoline @math{F1},
28285 @texline @math{F_1},
28286 relative to a reference
28287 @infoline @math{F0},
28288 @texline @math{F_0},
28289 is defined as
28290 @infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28291 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28292 For example, the decibel value of a sound pressure level of
28293 @infoline @math{60 uPa}
28294 @texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28295 relative to
28296 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28297 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28298 (the threshold of human hearing) is
28299 @infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28300 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} = 20 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28301 which is about
28302 @infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28303 @texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28304 Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28305 logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28306
28307 Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28308 logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28309 of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28310 @infoline @math{P1},
28311 @texline @math{P_1},
28312 relative to a reference power
28313 @infoline @math{P0},
28314 @texline @math{P_0},
28315 is
28316 @infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28317 @texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28318 The neper level of a field
28319 @infoline @math{F1},
28320 @texline @math{F_1},
28321 relative to a reference field
28322 @infoline @math{F0},
28323 @texline @math{F_0},
28324 is
28325 @infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28326 @texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28327
28328 @vindex calc-lu-power-reference
28329 @vindex calc-lu-field-reference
28330 For power quantities, Calc uses
28331 @infoline @math{1 mW}
28332 @texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28333 as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28334 the value of the customizable variable
28335 @code{calc-lu-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28336 For field quantities, Calc uses
28337 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28338 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28339 as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28340 which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28341 changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28342 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28343 non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28344 capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28345
28346 @kindex l q
28347 @pindex calc-lu-quant
28348 @tindex lupquant
28349 @tindex lufquant
28350 The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-lu-quant}) [@code{lupquant}]
28351 command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28352 logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28353 reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28354 algebraic formula, @code{lupquant} can be given an optional second
28355 argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28356 @code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28357 @code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28358 The @kbd{H l q} [@code{lufquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28359 computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28360
28361 @kindex l d
28362 @pindex calc-db
28363 @tindex dbpower
28364 @tindex dbfield
28365 @kindex l n
28366 @pindex calc-np
28367 @tindex nppower
28368 @tindex npfield
28369 The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-db}) [@code{dbpower}] command will compute
28370 the decibel level of a power quantity using the default reference
28371 level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfield}] will compute the decibel level of
28372 a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n} (@code{calc-np})
28373 [@code{nppower}] and @kbd{H l n} [@code{npfield}] will similarly
28374 compute neper levels. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands
28375 will read a reference level from the stack; in an algebraic formula
28376 the reference level can be given as an optional second argument.
28377
28378 @kindex l +
28379 @pindex calc-lu-plus
28380 @tindex lupadd
28381 @tindex lufadd
28382 @kindex l -
28383 @pindex calc-lu-minus
28384 @tindex lupsub
28385 @tindex lufsub
28386 @kindex l *
28387 @pindex calc-lu-times
28388 @tindex lupmul
28389 @tindex lufmul
28390 @kindex l /
28391 @pindex calc-lu-divide
28392 @tindex lupdiv
28393 @tindex lufdiv
28394 The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28395 of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28396 corresponding to decibel levels
28397 @infoline @math{D1}
28398 @texline @math{D_1}
28399 and
28400 @infoline @math{D2}
28401 @texline @math{D_2}
28402 are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28403
28404 @ifnottex
28405 @example
28406 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28407 @end example
28408 @end ifnottex
28409 @tex
28410 $$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28411 @end tex
28412
28413 @noindent
28414 When field quantities are combined, it often means the corresponding
28415 powers are added and so the above formula might be used. In
28416 acoustics, for example, the sound pressure level is a field quantity
28417 and so the decibels are often defined using the field formula, but the
28418 sound pressure levels are combined as the sound power levels, and so
28419 the above formula should be used. If two field quantities themselves
28420 are added, the new decibel level will be
28421
28422 @ifnottex
28423 @example
28424 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28425 @end example
28426 @end ifnottex
28427 @tex
28428 $$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28429 @end tex
28430
28431 @noindent
28432 If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28433 then the corresponding decibel level will be
28434
28435 @ifnottex
28436 @example
28437 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28438 @end example
28439 @end ifnottex
28440 @tex
28441 $$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28442 @end tex
28443
28444 @noindent
28445 if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28446 will be
28447
28448 @ifnottex
28449 @example
28450 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28451 @end example
28452 @end ifnottex
28453 @tex
28454 $$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28455 @end tex
28456
28457 @noindent
28458 There are similar formulas for combining nepers. The @kbd{l +}
28459 (@code{calc-lu-plus}) [@code{lupadd}] command will ``add'' two
28460 logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the @kbd{H} prefix,
28461 @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufadd}] will add logarithmic unit field levels.
28462 Similarly, logarithmic units can be ``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -}
28463 (@code{calc-lu-minus}) [@code{lupsub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufsub}].
28464 The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-lu-times}) [@code{lupmul}] and @kbd{H l *}
28465 [@code{lufmul}] commands will ``multiply'' a logarithmic unit by a
28466 number; the @kbd{l /} (@code{calc-lu-divide}) [@code{lupdiv}] and
28467 @kbd{H l /} [@code{lufdiv}] commands will ``divide'' a logarithmic
28468 unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't play a role
28469 in this arithmetic.
28470
28471 @node Musical Notes, , Logarithmic Units, Units
28472 @section Musical Notes
28473
28474 Calc can convert between musical notes and their associated
28475 frequencies. Notes can be given using either scientific pitch
28476 notation or midi numbers. Since these note systems are basically
28477 logarithmic scales, Calc uses the @kbd{l} prefix for functions
28478 operating on notes.
28479
28480 Scientific pitch notation refers to a note by giving a letter
28481 A through G, possibly followed by a flat or sharp) with a subscript
28482 indicating an octave number. Each octave starts with C and ends with
28483 B and
28484 @c increasing each note by a semitone will result
28485 @c in the sequence @expr{C}, @expr{C} sharp, @expr{D}, @expr{E} flat, @expr{E},
28486 @c @expr{F}, @expr{F} sharp, @expr{G}, @expr{A} flat, @expr{A}, @expr{B}
28487 @c flat and @expr{B}.
28488 the octave numbered 0 was chosen to correspond to the lowest
28489 audible frequency. Using this system, middle C (about 261.625 Hz)
28490 corresponds to the note @expr{C} in octave 4 and is denoted
28491 @expr{C_4}. Any frequency can be described by giving a note plus an
28492 offset in cents (where a cent is a ratio of frequencies so that a
28493 semitone consists of 100 cents).
28494
28495 The midi note number system assigns numbers to notes so that
28496 @expr{C_(-1)} corresponds to the midi note number 0 and @expr{G_9}
28497 corresponds to the midi note number 127. A midi controller can have
28498 up to 128 keys and each midi note number from 0 to 127 corresponds to
28499 a possible key.
28500
28501 @kindex l s
28502 @pindex calc-spn
28503 @tindex spn
28504 The @kbd{l s} (@code{calc-spn}) [@code{spn}] command converts either
28505 a frequency or a midi number to scientific pitch notation. For
28506 example, @code{500 Hz} gets converted to
28507 @code{B_4 + 21.3094853649 cents} and @code{84} to @code{C_6}.
28508
28509
28510 @kindex l m
28511 @pindex calc-midi
28512 @tindex midi
28513 The @kbd{l m} (@code{calc-midi}) [@code{midi}] command converts either
28514 a frequency or a note given in scientific pitch notation to the
28515 corresponding midi number. For example, @code{C_6} gets converted to 84
28516 and @code{440 Hz} to 69.
28517
28518 @kindex l f
28519 @pindex calc-freq
28520 @tindex freq
28521 The @kbd{l f} (@code{calc-freq}) [@code{freq}] command converts either
28522 either a midi number or a note given in scientific pitch notation to
28523 the corresponding frequency. For example, @code{Asharp_2 + 30 cents}
28524 gets converted to @code{118.578040134 Hz} and @code{55} to
28525 @code{195.99771799 Hz}.
28526
28527 Since the frequencies of notes are not usually given exactly (and are
28528 typically irrational), the customizable variable
28529 @code{calc-note-threshold} determines how close (in cents) a frequency
28530 needs to be to a note to be recognized as that note
28531 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). This variable has a default value of
28532 @code{1}. For example, middle @var{C} is approximately
28533 @expr{261.625565302 Hz}; this frequency is often shortened to
28534 @expr{261.625 Hz}. Without @code{calc-note-threshold} (or a value of
28535 @expr{0}), Calc would convert @code{261.625 Hz} to scientific pitch
28536 notation @code{B_3 + 99.9962592773 cents}; with the default value of
28537 @code{1}, Calc converts @code{261.625 Hz} to @code{C_4}.
28538
28539
28540
28541 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28542 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28543
28544 @noindent
28545 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28546 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28547 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28548 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28549
28550 @menu
28551 * Storing Variables::
28552 * Recalling Variables::
28553 * Operations on Variables::
28554 * Let Command::
28555 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28556 @end menu
28557
28558 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28559 @section Storing Variables
28560
28561 @noindent
28562 @kindex s s
28563 @pindex calc-store
28564 @cindex Storing variables
28565 @cindex Quick variables
28566 @vindex q0
28567 @vindex q9
28568 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28569 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28570 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28571 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28572 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28573
28574 @kindex s t
28575 @pindex calc-store-into
28576 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28577 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28578 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28579
28580 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28581 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28582 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28583 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28584 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28585 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28586 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28587 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28588
28589 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28590 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28591 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28592 righthand sides simultaneously.
28593
28594 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28595 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28596 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28597 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28598 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28599 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28600
28601 @kindex s 0-9
28602 @kindex t 0-9
28603 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28604 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28605 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28606 for trail and time/date commands.)
28607
28608 @kindex s +
28609 @kindex s -
28610 @ignore
28611 @mindex @idots
28612 @end ignore
28613 @kindex s *
28614 @ignore
28615 @mindex @null
28616 @end ignore
28617 @kindex s /
28618 @ignore
28619 @mindex @null
28620 @end ignore
28621 @kindex s ^
28622 @ignore
28623 @mindex @null
28624 @end ignore
28625 @kindex s |
28626 @ignore
28627 @mindex @null
28628 @end ignore
28629 @kindex s n
28630 @ignore
28631 @mindex @null
28632 @end ignore
28633 @kindex s &
28634 @ignore
28635 @mindex @null
28636 @end ignore
28637 @kindex s [
28638 @ignore
28639 @mindex @null
28640 @end ignore
28641 @kindex s ]
28642 @pindex calc-store-plus
28643 @pindex calc-store-minus
28644 @pindex calc-store-times
28645 @pindex calc-store-div
28646 @pindex calc-store-power
28647 @pindex calc-store-concat
28648 @pindex calc-store-neg
28649 @pindex calc-store-inv
28650 @pindex calc-store-decr
28651 @pindex calc-store-incr
28652 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28653 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28654 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28655 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28656 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28657 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28658
28659 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28660 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28661 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28662 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28663 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28664 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28665 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28666 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28667 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28668 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28669 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28670 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28671 forwards and backwards:
28672
28673 @example
28674 @group
28675 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28676 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28677 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28678 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28679 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28680 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28681 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28682 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28683 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28684 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28685 @end group
28686 @end example
28687
28688 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28689 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28690 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28691 minus-two minus the variable.
28692
28693 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28694 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28695 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28696
28697 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28698 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28699 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28700 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28701 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28702 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28703 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28704
28705 @kindex s m
28706 @pindex calc-store-map
28707 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28708 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28709 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28710 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28711 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28712 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28713 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28714 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28715 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28716 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28717 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28718
28719 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28720 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28721 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28722 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28723 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28724 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28725 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28726
28727 @kindex s x
28728 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28729 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28730 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28731 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28732
28733 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28734 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28735 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28736
28737 @kindex s u
28738 @pindex calc-unstore
28739 @cindex Void variables
28740 @cindex Un-storing variables
28741 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28742 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28743 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28744 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28745 void state.
28746
28747 @kindex s c
28748 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28749 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28750 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28751 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28752 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28753 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28754 current precision.
28755
28756 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28757 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28758 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28759 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28760 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28761 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28762 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28763 normally void).
28764
28765 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28766 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28767 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28768 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28769 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28770 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28771 @kbd{s c}.
28772
28773 @kindex s k
28774 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28775 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28776 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28777 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28778 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28779 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28780 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28781 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28782 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28783 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28784 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28785
28786 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28787 @section Recalling Variables
28788
28789 @noindent
28790 @kindex s r
28791 @pindex calc-recall
28792 @cindex Recalling variables
28793 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28794 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28795 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28796 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28797 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28798
28799 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28800 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28801 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28802 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28803 latter will produce an error message.
28804
28805 @kindex r 0-9
28806 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28807 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28808
28809 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28810 @section Other Operations on Variables
28811
28812 @noindent
28813 @kindex s e
28814 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28815 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28816 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28817 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28818 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28819 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28820 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28821 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28822 description of editing.
28823
28824 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28825 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28826 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28827 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28828 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28829 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28830 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28831 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28832 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28833 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28834
28835 @kindex s A
28836 @kindex s D
28837 @ignore
28838 @mindex @idots
28839 @end ignore
28840 @kindex s E
28841 @ignore
28842 @mindex @null
28843 @end ignore
28844 @kindex s F
28845 @ignore
28846 @mindex @null
28847 @end ignore
28848 @kindex s G
28849 @ignore
28850 @mindex @null
28851 @end ignore
28852 @kindex s H
28853 @ignore
28854 @mindex @null
28855 @end ignore
28856 @kindex s I
28857 @ignore
28858 @mindex @null
28859 @end ignore
28860 @kindex s L
28861 @ignore
28862 @mindex @null
28863 @end ignore
28864 @kindex s P
28865 @ignore
28866 @mindex @null
28867 @end ignore
28868 @kindex s R
28869 @ignore
28870 @mindex @null
28871 @end ignore
28872 @kindex s T
28873 @ignore
28874 @mindex @null
28875 @end ignore
28876 @kindex s U
28877 @ignore
28878 @mindex @null
28879 @end ignore
28880 @kindex s X
28881 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28882 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28883 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28884 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28885 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28886 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28887 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28888 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28889 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28890 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28891 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28892 @pindex calc-store-Units
28893 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28894 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28895 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28896
28897 @table @kbd
28898 @item s A
28899 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28900 @item s D
28901 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28902 @item s E
28903 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Basic Simplifications}.
28904 @item s F
28905 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28906 @item s G
28907 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28908 @item s H
28909 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28910 @item s I
28911 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28912 @item s L
28913 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28914 @item s P
28915 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28916 @item s R
28917 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28918 @item s T
28919 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28920 @item s U
28921 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28922 @item s X
28923 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28924 @end table
28925
28926 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28927 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28928
28929 @kindex s p
28930 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28931 @cindex Storing variables
28932 @cindex Permanent variables
28933 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28934 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28935 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28936 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
28937 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28938 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28939 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28940 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28941 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28942
28943 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28944 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28945 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28946 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28947 and @code{PlotRejects};
28948 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28949 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28950 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28951 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28952
28953 @kindex s i
28954 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28955 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28956 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28957 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28958 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28959 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28960 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28961 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28962 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28963 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28964 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28965
28966 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28967 @section The Let Command
28968
28969 @noindent
28970 @kindex s l
28971 @pindex calc-let
28972 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28973 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28974 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28975 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28976 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28977 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28978
28979 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28980 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28981 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28982 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28983 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28984 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28985 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28986 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28987 by these commands.
28988
28989 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28990 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28991 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28992
28993 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28994 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28995 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28996
28997 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28998 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28999 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
29000 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
29001 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
29002 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
29003
29004 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
29005 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
29006
29007 @noindent
29008 @tindex evalto
29009 @tindex =>
29010 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
29011 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
29012 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
29013 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
29014 other language modes like Pascal and @LaTeX{}.) This is a binary
29015 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
29016 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
29017
29018 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
29019 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
29020 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
29021 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
29022 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
29023 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
29024
29025 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
29026 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
29027 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
29028
29029 @kindex s =
29030 @pindex calc-evalto
29031 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
29032 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
29033 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
29034 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
29035 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
29036
29037 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
29038 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
29039 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
29040 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
29041 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
29042 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
29043 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
29044 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
29045 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
29046 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
29047 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
29048 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
29049 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
29050 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
29051 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
29052
29053 @kindex m C
29054 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
29055 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
29056 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
29057 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
29058 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
29059 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
29060 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
29061 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
29062
29063 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
29064 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
29065 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
29066 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
29067 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
29068 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
29069 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
29070
29071 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
29072 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
29073 formula @samp{arcsin(sin(x))} will not be handled by Calc's algebraic
29074 simplifications, but Calc's unsafe simplifications will reduce it to
29075 @samp{x}. If you enter @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) =>} normally, the result
29076 will be @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))}. If you change to
29077 Extended Simplification mode, the result will be
29078 @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a e}
29079 once will have no effect on @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))},
29080 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
29081 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
29082 affected by commands like @kbd{a e}.
29083
29084 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
29085 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
29086 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
29087 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
29088 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
29089 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
29090 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
29091 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
29092 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
29093 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
29094
29095 @smallexample
29096 @group
29097 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
29098 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
29099 . . .
29100
29101 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
29102 @end group
29103 @end smallexample
29104
29105 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
29106 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
29107 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
29108 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
29109 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
29110 side effects.
29111
29112 @kindex s :
29113 @pindex calc-assign
29114 @tindex assign
29115 @tindex :=
29116 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
29117 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
29118 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
29119 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
29120 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
29121 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
29122 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
29123 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
29124 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
29125
29126 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
29127 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
29128 treatment to @samp{=>}.
29129
29130 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
29131 @chapter Graphics
29132
29133 @noindent
29134 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
29135 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
29136 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
29137 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
29138 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
29139 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
29140
29141 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
29142 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
29143 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
29144 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
29145 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
29146 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
29147 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
29148 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
29149 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
29150 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
29151 Posix-compatible terminal.
29152
29153 @menu
29154 * Basic Graphics::
29155 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
29156 * Managing Curves::
29157 * Graphics Options::
29158 * Devices::
29159 @end menu
29160
29161 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
29162 @section Basic Graphics
29163
29164 @noindent
29165 @kindex g f
29166 @pindex calc-graph-fast
29167 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
29168 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
29169 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
29170 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29171 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29172 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29173 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29174 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29175 to indicate the points themselves.
29176
29177 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29178 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29179 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29180
29181 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29182 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29183 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29184
29185 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29186 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29187 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29188 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29189 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29190 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29191 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29192 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29193 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29194
29195 @ignore
29196 @starindex
29197 @end ignore
29198 @tindex xy
29199 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29200 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29201 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29202 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29203 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29204 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29205 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29206 will be a circle.
29207
29208 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29209 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29210 variables.
29211
29212 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29213 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29214 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29215 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29216 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29217 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29218 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29219 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29220 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29221
29222 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29223 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29224
29225 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29226 @vindex PlotRejects
29227 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29228 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29229 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29230 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29231 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29232 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29233 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29234 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29235 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29236 @code{PlotRejects}.
29237
29238 @kindex g c
29239 @pindex calc-graph-clear
29240 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29241 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29242 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29243 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29244 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29245 window if there is one.
29246
29247 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29248 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29249
29250 @kindex g F
29251 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29252 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29253 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29254 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29255
29256 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29257 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29258 are several options for these values.
29259
29260 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29261 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29262 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29263 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29264 result is a surface plot where
29265 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
29266 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
29267 is the height of the point
29268 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29269 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29270 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29271 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29272 description of the @samp{set view} command.
29273
29274 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29275 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29276
29277 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29278 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29279 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29280 of values from the input vectors.
29281
29282 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29283 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29284 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29285 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29286 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
29287 3D surface.
29288
29289 @ignore
29290 @starindex
29291 @end ignore
29292 @tindex xyz
29293 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29294 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29295 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29296 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29297 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29298 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29299 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29300 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
29301 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29302 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29303 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29304 vectors with more than 5 elements.
29305
29306 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29307 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29308 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29309 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29310 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29311
29312 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29313 variables containing the relevant data.
29314
29315 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29316 @section Managing Curves
29317
29318 @noindent
29319 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29320 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29321 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29322 by using these commands directly.
29323
29324 @kindex g a
29325 @pindex calc-graph-add
29326 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29327 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29328 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29329 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29330 on the same axes.
29331
29332 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29333 will cause a special buffer, @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29334 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29335 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29336 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29337 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29338 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29339 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29340 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29341 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29342 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29343 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29344 the contents of the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29345
29346 @vindex PlotData1
29347 @vindex PlotData2
29348 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29349 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29350 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29351 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29352 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29353 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29354 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29355 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29356
29357 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29358 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29359 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29360 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29361 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29362 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29363
29364 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29365 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29366 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29367
29368 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29369 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29370 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29371 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29372 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29373 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29374
29375 For example, to plot
29376 @texline @math{\sin n x}
29377 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29378 for integers @expr{n}
29379 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29380 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29381 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29382 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29383 command.
29384
29385 @kindex g A
29386 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29387 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29388 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29389 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29390 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29391 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29392 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29393 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29394 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29395 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29396 command to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29397
29398 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29399 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29400 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29401 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29402 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29403 check for this.)
29404
29405 @kindex g d
29406 @pindex calc-graph-delete
29407 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29408 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29409 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29410 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29411
29412 @kindex g H
29413 @pindex calc-graph-hide
29414 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29415 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29416 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29417 point styles will be retained.
29418
29419 @kindex g j
29420 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
29421 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29422 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29423 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29424 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29425 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29426 affect the last curve in the list.
29427
29428 @kindex g p
29429 @pindex calc-graph-plot
29430 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29431 the graph described in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29432 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29433 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29434 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29435 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29436 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29437 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29438 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29439
29440 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29441 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29442 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29443 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29444 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29445 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29446 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29447
29448 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29449 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29450 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29451 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29452 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29453 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29454 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29455
29456 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29457 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29458 the current graph is three-dimensional.
29459
29460 @kindex g P
29461 @pindex calc-graph-print
29462 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29463 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29464 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29465 or @samp{set output} commands in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29466 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29467 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29468 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29469 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29470 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29471 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29472 always plot to the printer.
29473
29474 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29475 @section Graphics Options
29476
29477 @noindent
29478 @kindex g g
29479 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29480 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29481 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29482 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29483 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29484 changes the setting in @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29485 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29486
29487 @kindex g b
29488 @pindex calc-graph-border
29489 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29490 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29491 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29492
29493 @kindex g k
29494 @pindex calc-graph-key
29495 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29496 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29497 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29498 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29499 curves on the same graph.
29500
29501 @kindex g N
29502 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29503 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29504 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29505 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29506 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29507 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29508 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29509 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29510 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29511 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29512 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29513 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29514 will be computed for the surface.
29515
29516 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29517 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29518 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29519 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29520 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29521 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29522 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29523 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29524 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29525
29526 @kindex g h
29527 @pindex calc-graph-header
29528 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29529 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29530 The default title is blank (no title).
29531
29532 @kindex g n
29533 @pindex calc-graph-name
29534 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29535 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29536 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29537 list in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29538 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29539 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29540 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29541 not used.
29542
29543 @kindex g t
29544 @kindex g T
29545 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29546 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29547 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29548 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29549 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29550 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29551 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29552 but you can edit them into the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29553 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29554
29555 @kindex g r
29556 @kindex g R
29557 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29558 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29559 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29560 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29561 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29562 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29563 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29564 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29565 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29566 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29567 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29568
29569 @kindex g l
29570 @kindex g L
29571 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29572 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29573 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29574 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29575 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29576
29577 @kindex g C-l
29578 @kindex g C-r
29579 @kindex g C-t
29580 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29581 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29582 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29583 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29584 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29585 for the ``z'' axis.
29586
29587 @kindex g z
29588 @kindex g Z
29589 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29590 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29591 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29592 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29593 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29594 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29595 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29596 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29597 not available for 3D plots.
29598
29599 @kindex g s
29600 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29601 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29602 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29603 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29604 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29605 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29606 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29607 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29608 available for any device.
29609
29610 @kindex g S
29611 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29612 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29613 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29614 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29615 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29616 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29617 the error bars on or off.
29618
29619 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29620 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29621 @vindex LineStyles
29622 @vindex PointStyles
29623 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29624 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29625 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29626 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29627 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29628 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29629 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29630 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29631 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29632 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29633
29634 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29635 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29636 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29637 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29638 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29639
29640 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29641 @section Graphical Devices
29642
29643 @noindent
29644 @kindex g D
29645 @pindex calc-graph-device
29646 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29647 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29648 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29649 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29650 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29651
29652 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29653 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29654 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29655 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29656 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29657 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29658 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29659 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29660 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29661 value.
29662
29663 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29664 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29665 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29666 to a buffer called @file{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29667 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29668 dumb terminals will be
29669 @texline @math{80\times24}
29670 @infoline 80x24
29671 characters. The graph is displayed in
29672 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29673 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29674 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29675
29676 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29677 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29678 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29679 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29680 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29681 graph. In the @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29682 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29683 of the four directions.
29684
29685 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29686 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29687 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29688 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29689 plot on any text-only printer.
29690
29691 @kindex g O
29692 @pindex calc-graph-output
29693 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29694 output file used by GNUPLOT@. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29695 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29696 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29697 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29698 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29699 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29700 i.e., to @file{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29701
29702 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29703 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29704 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29705 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29706 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29707 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29708 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29709 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29710 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29711
29712 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29713 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29714 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29715 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29716 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29717 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29718
29719 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29720 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29721 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29722 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29723 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29724 of the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29725
29726 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29727 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29728 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29729 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29730 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29731 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29732 You may wish to configure the default and
29733 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29734 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29735 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29736 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29737 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29738
29739 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29740 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29741 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29742 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29743 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29744 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29745 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29746 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29747
29748 @kindex g x
29749 @pindex calc-graph-display
29750 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29751 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29752 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29753 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29754
29755 @kindex g X
29756 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29757 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29758 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29759 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29760 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29761 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29762 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29763 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29764
29765 The buffer called @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29766 session with GNUPLOT@. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29767 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29768 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29769 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29770 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29771 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29772 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29773 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29774 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29775 usage of GNUPLOT.
29776 }.
29777
29778 @kindex g C
29779 @pindex calc-graph-command
29780 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29781 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29782 GNUPLOT process. The @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29783 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29784 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29785
29786 @kindex g v
29787 @kindex g V
29788 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29789 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29790 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29791 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29792 and @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29793 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29794 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29795 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29796 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @file{*Gnuplot
29797 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29798 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29799
29800 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29801 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29802 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29803 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29804 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29805 you have to add them to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29806 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29807 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29808 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29809 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29810 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29811 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29812 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29813 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29814 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29815 with @kbd{g p}.
29816
29817 @kindex g q
29818 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29819 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29820 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29821 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29822 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29823 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29824 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29825
29826 @kindex g K
29827 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29828 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29829 except that it also views the @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29830 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29831 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29832
29833 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29834 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29835
29836 @noindent
29837 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29838 other Emacs editing buffers.
29839
29840 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29841 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29842
29843 @menu
29844 * Killing From Stack::
29845 * Yanking Into Stack::
29846 * Saving Into Registers::
29847 * Inserting From Registers::
29848 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29849 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29850 * X Cut and Paste::
29851 @end menu
29852
29853 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29854 @section Killing from the Stack
29855
29856 @noindent
29857 @kindex C-k
29858 @pindex calc-kill
29859 @kindex M-k
29860 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29861 @kindex C-w
29862 @pindex calc-kill-region
29863 @kindex M-w
29864 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29865 @kindex M-C-w
29866 @cindex Kill ring
29867 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29868 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29869 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29870 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29871 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29872 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29873 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29874 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29875 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29876 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29877 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29878 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29879 deleting anything.
29880
29881 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29882 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29883 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29884 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29885 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29886 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29887
29888 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29889 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29890 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29891 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29892 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29893 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29894 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29895 newline.
29896
29897 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29898 @section Yanking into the Stack
29899
29900 @noindent
29901 @kindex C-y
29902 @pindex calc-yank
29903 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29904 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29905 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29906 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29907 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29908 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29909 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29910 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29911 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29912 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29913 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29914 difference.)
29915
29916 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29917 @section Saving into Registers
29918
29919 @noindent
29920 @kindex r s
29921 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29922 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29923 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29924 @cindex Registers
29925 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29926 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29927 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29928 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29929 entries.
29930
29931 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29932 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29933 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29934 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29935 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29936 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29937 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29938 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29939 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29940
29941 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29942 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29943 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29944 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29945 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29946 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29947 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29948 added to the register.
29949
29950 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29951 @section Inserting from Registers
29952 @noindent
29953 @kindex r i
29954 @pindex calc-insert-register
29955 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29956 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29957 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29958 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29959 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29960 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29961
29962 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29963 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29964
29965 @noindent
29966 @kindex C-x * g
29967 @pindex calc-grab-region
29968 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29969 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29970 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29971 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29972 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29973 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29974 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29975 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29976
29977 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29978 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29979 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29980 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29981 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29982 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29983 delete given that prefix argument.
29984
29985 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29986 line.
29987
29988 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29989 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29990 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29991 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29992 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29993 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29994 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29995 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29996
29997 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29998 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29999
30000 @kindex C-x * r
30001 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
30002 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
30003 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
30004 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
30005 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
30006 whose contents are parsed.
30007
30008 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
30009 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
30010 only if every row contains the same number of values.
30011
30012 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
30013 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
30014 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
30015 is ignored.
30016
30017 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
30018 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
30019 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
30020 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
30021 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
30022 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
30023
30024 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
30025 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
30026 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
30027 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
30028 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
30029 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
30030 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
30031 as @samp{[2*a]}.
30032
30033 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
30034 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
30035 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
30036 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
30037 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
30038
30039 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
30040 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
30041 @texline @math{1\times1}
30042 @infoline 1x1
30043 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
30044
30045 @kindex C-x * :
30046 @kindex C-x * _
30047 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
30048 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
30049 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
30050 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
30051 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
30052 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
30053 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
30054 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
30055 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
30056 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
30057
30058 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
30059 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
30060 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
30061 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
30062 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
30063
30064 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
30065 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
30066 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
30067 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
30068 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
30069 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
30070
30071 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
30072 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
30073 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
30074 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
30075 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
30076 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
30077 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
30078
30079 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
30080 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
30081
30082 @noindent
30083 @kindex y
30084 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
30085 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
30086 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
30087 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
30088 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
30089 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
30090 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
30091 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
30092 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
30093
30094 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
30095 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
30096 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
30097 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
30098 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
30099 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
30100 latter strips off the trailing newline.
30101
30102 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
30103 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
30104 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
30105 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
30106 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
30107 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
30108 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
30109 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
30110 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
30111 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
30112
30113 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
30114 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
30115 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
30116 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
30117 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
30118 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
30119 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
30120 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
30121 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
30122 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
30123 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
30124 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
30125 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
30126 to overwriting one complete number with another.
30127
30128 @kindex C-x * y
30129 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
30130 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
30131 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
30132
30133 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
30134 @section X Cut and Paste
30135
30136 @noindent
30137 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
30138 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
30139 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
30140
30141 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
30142 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
30143 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
30144 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
30145 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
30146 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
30147 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
30148 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
30149 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
30150 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
30151 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
30152
30153 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
30154 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
30155 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
30156 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
30157 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
30158 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
30159 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
30160 in the Calc window.
30161
30162 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
30163 @chapter Keypad Mode
30164
30165 @noindent
30166 @kindex C-x * k
30167 @pindex calc-keypad
30168 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
30169 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
30170 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30171 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30172 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30173 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30174 calculations with the mouse.
30175
30176 @pindex full-calc-keypad
30177 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30178 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30179 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30180 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30181 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30182
30183 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30184 the @file{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30185 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30186 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30187
30188 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30189 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30190 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30191
30192 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30193 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30194 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30195 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30196 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30197 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30198 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30199 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30200
30201 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30202 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30203 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30204 original buffer.
30205
30206 @menu
30207 * Keypad Main Menu::
30208 * Keypad Functions Menu::
30209 * Keypad Binary Menu::
30210 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
30211 * Keypad Modes Menu::
30212 @end menu
30213
30214 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30215 @section Main Menu
30216
30217 @smallexample
30218 @group
30219 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
30220 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30221 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30222 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30223 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30224 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30225 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30226 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30227 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30228 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30229 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30230 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30231 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30232 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30233 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30234 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30235 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30236 @end group
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 @noindent
30240 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30241 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30242 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30243 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30244
30245 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30246 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30247 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30248 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30249 or any other function key.
30250
30251 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30252 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30253 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30254 stack.
30255
30256 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30257 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30258 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30259 below and in the following sections.
30260
30261 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30262 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30263
30264 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30265 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30266 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30267
30268 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30269 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30270 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30271 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30272
30273 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30274 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30275 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30276 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30277 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30278
30279 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30280 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30281 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30282 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30283
30284 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30285 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30286 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30287 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30288
30289 @table @kbd
30290 @item INV +/-
30291 is the same as @key{1/x}.
30292 @item INV +
30293 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30294 @item INV -
30295 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30296 @item INV *
30297 is the same as @key{y^x}.
30298 @item INV /
30299 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30300 @item HYP/INV 1
30301 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30302 @item HYP/INV 2
30303 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30304 @item HYP/INV 3
30305 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30306 @item INV/HYP 4
30307 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30308 @item INV/HYP 5
30309 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30310 @item INV 6
30311 is the same as @key{ABS}.
30312 @item INV 7
30313 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30314 @item INV 8
30315 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30316 @item INV 9
30317 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30318 @item INV 0
30319 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30320 @item INV .
30321 is the same as @key{PREC}.
30322 @item INV ENTER
30323 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30324 @item HYP ENTER
30325 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30326 @item INV HYP ENTER
30327 is the same as @key{OVER}.
30328 @item HYP +/-
30329 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30330 @item HYP EEX
30331 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30332 @item INV EEX
30333 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30334 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30335 by the two limits of the interval.
30336 @end table
30337
30338 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30339 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30340 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30341 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30342 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30343 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30344
30345 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30346 @section Functions Menu
30347
30348 @smallexample
30349 @group
30350 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
30351 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30352 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30353 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30354 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30355 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30356 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30357 @end group
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 @noindent
30361 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30362 prefix keys.
30363
30364 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30365 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30366
30367 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30368 extracts the imaginary part.
30369
30370 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30371 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30372 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30373 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30374 same limit as last time.
30375
30376 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30377
30378 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30379 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30380 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30381
30382 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30383 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30384
30385 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30386 finds the previous prime.
30387
30388 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30389 @section Binary Menu
30390
30391 @smallexample
30392 @group
30393 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
30394 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30395 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30396 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30397 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30398 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
30399 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30400 @end group
30401 @end smallexample
30402
30403 @noindent
30404 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30405 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30406 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30407
30408 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30409 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30410
30411 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30412 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30413 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30414 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30415
30416 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30417 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30418 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30419 The initial word size is 32 bits.
30420
30421 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30422 @section Vectors Menu
30423
30424 @smallexample
30425 @group
30426 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
30427 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30428 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30429 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30430 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30431 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30432 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30433 @end group
30434 @end smallexample
30435
30436 @noindent
30437 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30438
30439 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30440 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30441 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30442 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30443 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30444 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30445 rows into a matrix.
30446
30447 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30448 components separately.
30449
30450 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30451 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30452 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30453 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30454 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30455
30456 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30457 identity matrix.
30458
30459 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30460
30461 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30462
30463 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30464 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30465
30466 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30467 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30468 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30469 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30470
30471 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30472 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30473 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30474
30475 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30476 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30477 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30478
30479 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30480 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30481 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30482 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30483 all the elements of a vector.
30484
30485 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30486 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30487 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30488 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30489 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30490 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30491 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30492 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30493 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30494
30495 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30496 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30497 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30498 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30499 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30500 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30501 @expr{t}, respectively.
30502
30503 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30504 @section Modes Menu
30505
30506 @smallexample
30507 @group
30508 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30509 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30510 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30511 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30512 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30513 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30514 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30515 @end group
30516 @end smallexample
30517
30518 @noindent
30519 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30520
30521 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30522 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30523 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30524 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30525 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30526
30527 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30528 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30529 well as to the left.
30530
30531 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30532 for trigonometric functions.
30533
30534 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30535 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30536 fractional or floating-point results.
30537
30538 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30539 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30540
30541 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30542 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30543 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30544
30545 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30546 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30547
30548 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30549 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30550 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30551 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30552
30553 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30554 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30555 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30556 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30557 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30558
30559 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30560 @chapter Embedded Mode
30561
30562 @noindent
30563 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30564 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30565 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30566 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30567
30568 @menu
30569 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30570 * More About Embedded Mode::
30571 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30572 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30573 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30574 @end menu
30575
30576 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30577 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30578
30579 @noindent
30580 @kindex C-x * e
30581 @pindex calc-embedded
30582 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30583 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30584 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30585 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30586 are visiting your own files.
30587
30588 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30589 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30590 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to @LaTeX{}.
30591 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30592 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30593 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30594 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30595 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30596 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30597 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30598 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30599
30600 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30601 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30602 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30603 understands are:
30604
30605 @enumerate
30606 @item
30607 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30608 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30609 @item
30610 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30611 @item
30612 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30613 @item
30614 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30615 @item
30616 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30617 @end enumerate
30618
30619 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30620 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30621 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30622
30623 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30624 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30625 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30626 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30627
30628 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30629 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30630 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30631
30632 @kindex C-x * w
30633 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30634 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30635 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30636 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30637 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30638 backward to delimit the formula.
30639
30640 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30641 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30642 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30643 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30644 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30645 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30646 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30647 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30648 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30649 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30650 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30651
30652 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30653 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30654 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30655 an algebraic entry.
30656
30657 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30658 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30659 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30660 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30661 not affected by Embedded mode.
30662
30663 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30664 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30665 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30666 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30667 find you need to see the entire stack.
30668
30669 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30670 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30671 inequality:
30672
30673 @example
30674 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30675 @end example
30676
30677 @noindent
30678 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30679 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30680 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30681 to match Calc's usual display style:
30682
30683 @example
30684 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30685 @end example
30686
30687 @noindent
30688 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30689 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30690 Embedded mode.
30691
30692 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30693 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30694 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30695 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30696 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30697 needs to be commuted.
30698
30699 @example
30700 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30701 @end example
30702
30703 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30704 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30705 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30706 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30707
30708 @example
30709 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30710 @end example
30711
30712 @noindent
30713 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30714 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30715 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30716 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30717 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30718 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30719 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30720
30721 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30722 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30723 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30724 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30725 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30726 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30727 Embedded mode is concerned.
30728
30729 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30730 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30731 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30732 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30733 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30734 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30735 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30736 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30737 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30738 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30739
30740 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30741 @section More About Embedded Mode
30742
30743 @noindent
30744 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30745 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30746 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30747 written. If the formula contains any @LaTeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30748 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @LaTeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30749 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30750 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30751
30752 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30753 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a @LaTeX{} formula when
30754 not in @LaTeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30755 whatever language mode is in effect.
30756
30757 @tex
30758 \bigskip
30759 @end tex
30760
30761 @kindex d p
30762 @pindex calc-show-plain
30763 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30764 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30765 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30766 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30767 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30768 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30769 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30770 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30771 version.
30772
30773 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30774 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30775 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}, so if your formula is
30776 embedded in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} document its plain version will be
30777 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30778 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30779 in a comment for those modes, also.
30780 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30781 formula delimiters.
30782
30783 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30784 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30785 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30786 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30787 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30788 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30789 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30790 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30791
30792 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30793 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30794 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30795 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30796 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30797 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30798
30799 @tex
30800 \bigskip
30801 @end tex
30802
30803 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30804 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30805 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30806 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30807 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30808 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30809 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30810 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30811 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30812 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30813 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30814 ``plain'' mode.
30815
30816 @tex
30817 \bigskip
30818 @end tex
30819
30820 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30821 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30822 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30823 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30824 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30825
30826 @smallexample
30827 The derivative of
30828
30829 ln(ln(x))
30830
30831 is
30832
30833 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30834
30835 whose value at x = 2 is
30836
30837 @r{(the value)}
30838
30839 and at x = 3 is
30840
30841 @r{(the value)}
30842 @end smallexample
30843
30844 @kindex C-x * d
30845 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30846 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30847 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30848 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30849 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30850 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30851
30852 For this example, you would start with just
30853
30854 @smallexample
30855 The derivative of
30856
30857 ln(ln(x))
30858 @end smallexample
30859
30860 @noindent
30861 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30862 is
30863
30864 @smallexample
30865 The derivative of
30866
30867 ln(ln(x))
30868
30869
30870 ln(ln(x))
30871 @end smallexample
30872
30873 @noindent
30874 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30875 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30876 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30877 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30878 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30879 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30880
30881 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30882 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30883 various formulas and numbers.
30884
30885 @tex
30886 \bigskip
30887 @end tex
30888
30889 @kindex C-x * f
30890 @kindex C-x * '
30891 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30892 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30893 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30894 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30895 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30896 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30897 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30898 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30899 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30900
30901 @kindex C-x * n
30902 @kindex C-x * p
30903 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30904 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30905 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30906 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30907 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30908 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30909 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30910 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30911 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30912 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30913 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30914 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30915 formula, they just move the cursor.
30916
30917 @kindex C-x * `
30918 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30919 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30920 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30921 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30922 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30923
30924 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30925 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30926
30927 @noindent
30928 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30929 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30930 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30931 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30932
30933 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30934
30935 @example
30936 foo := 5
30937 @end example
30938
30939 @noindent
30940 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30941 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30942 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30943 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30944 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30945
30946 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30947 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30948 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30949 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30950 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30951
30952 @example
30953 foo + 7 => 12
30954 @end example
30955
30956 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30957
30958 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30959 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30960
30961 @example
30962 foo := 17
30963
30964 foo + 7 => 24
30965 @end example
30966
30967 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30968 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30969 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30970 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30971 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30972
30973 @example
30974 17
30975
30976 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30977 @end example
30978
30979 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30980 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30981 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30982 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30983
30984 @kindex C-x * j
30985 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30986 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30987 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30988 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30989 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30990 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30991 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30992
30993 @example
30994 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30995 @end example
30996
30997 @noindent
30998 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30999
31000 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
31001 mode.
31002
31003 @kindex C-x * u
31004 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
31005 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
31006 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
31007 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
31008 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
31009 command is a convenient way to do this.
31010
31011 @example
31012 foo := 6
31013
31014 foo + 7 => 13
31015 @end example
31016
31017 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
31018 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
31019 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
31020 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
31021 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
31022 that formula will not be disturbed.
31023
31024 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
31025 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
31026 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
31027 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
31028 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
31029
31030 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
31031 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
31032
31033 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
31034 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
31035 file.
31036
31037 @kindex C-x * a
31038 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
31039 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
31040 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
31041 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
31042 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
31043 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
31044 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
31045 changed.
31046
31047 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
31048 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
31049 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
31050 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
31051 a few lines that look like this:
31052
31053 @example
31054 --- Local Variables: ---
31055 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
31056 --- End: ---
31057 @end example
31058
31059 @noindent
31060 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
31061 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
31062 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
31063 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
31064 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
31065 trailing strings.
31066
31067 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
31068 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
31069 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
31070 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
31071 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
31072 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
31073 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
31074 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
31075 Emacs manual}.
31076
31077 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
31078 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
31079 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
31080 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
31081 saved.
31082
31083 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
31084 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
31085 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
31086 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
31087 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
31088 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
31089
31090 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
31091 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
31092 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
31093 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
31094 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
31095 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
31096 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
31097 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
31098 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
31099 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
31100 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
31101 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
31102 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
31103 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
31104 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
31105
31106 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
31107 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
31108 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
31109 following assignment is used.
31110
31111 @example
31112 x => 1
31113
31114 x := 1
31115
31116 x => 1
31117
31118 x := 2
31119
31120 x => 2
31121 @end example
31122
31123 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
31124 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
31125 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
31126 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
31127 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
31128 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
31129
31130 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
31131 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
31132 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
31133 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
31134 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
31135 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
31136 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
31137
31138 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
31139 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
31140 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
31141 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
31142 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
31143 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
31144 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
31145 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
31146 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
31147 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
31148 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
31149
31150 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31151 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
31152
31153 @kindex m e
31154 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
31155 @noindent
31156 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
31157 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
31158 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
31159 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
31160 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
31161 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
31162
31163 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
31164 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
31165 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
31166 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
31167 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
31168 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
31169
31170 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31171 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31172 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31173 delimiter of the formula.
31174
31175 @example
31176 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31177 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31178 @end example
31179
31180 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31181 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31182 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31183 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31184 the file, or up to a line of the form
31185
31186 @example
31187 % [calc-defaults]
31188 @end example
31189
31190 @noindent
31191 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31192 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31193 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31194
31195 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31196 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31197 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31198 below).
31199
31200 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31201 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31202 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31203 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31204 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31205 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31206 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31207 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31208 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31209
31210 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31211 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31212 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31213 one.
31214
31215 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31216 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31217 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31218 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31219 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31220 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31221 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31222 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31223 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31224
31225 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31226 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31227 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31228 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31229 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31230 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31231
31232 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31233 that look like this, respectively:
31234
31235 @example
31236 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31237 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31238 @end example
31239
31240 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31241 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31242 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31243 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31244 yet, is not relevant here.)
31245
31246 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31247 of the file:
31248
31249 @example
31250 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31251 @end example
31252
31253 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31254 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31255 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31256 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31257 formulas in the file.
31258
31259 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31260 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31261 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31262 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31263 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31264
31265 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31266 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31267 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31268 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31269 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31270 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31271
31272 @example
31273 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31274 1.23e2
31275
31276 456.
31277 @end example
31278
31279 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31280 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31281
31282 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31283 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31284 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31285 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
31286 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
31287 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31288 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31289 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31290 annotations at all.
31291
31292 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31293 for @code{Save} have no effect.
31294
31295 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31296 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
31297
31298 @noindent
31299 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31300 variables described here. These variables are customizable
31301 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31302 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31303 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31304 the end of the file;
31305 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31306 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31307 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31308
31309 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31310 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31311 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31312 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31313 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31314 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31315 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31316 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31317 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31318 in detail.
31319
31320 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31321 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31322 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31323 Lisp program.
31324
31325 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31326 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31327 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31328 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31329 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31330 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31331 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31332 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31333
31334 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31335 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31336 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31337 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31338 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31339 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31340
31341 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31342 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31343 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31344 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31345 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31346 one or two dollar signs.
31347
31348 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31349 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31350 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31351
31352 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31353 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31354 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31355 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31356 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31357 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31358 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31359
31360 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31361 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31362 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31363 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31364 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31365 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31366 account for each of these six backslashes!)
31367
31368 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31369 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31370 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31371 regular expression to match the above example would be
31372 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31373 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31374 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31375 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31376 case).
31377
31378 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31379 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31380 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31381 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
31382
31383 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31384 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31385 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31386 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31387 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31388 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31389 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31390 be different for certain major modes.
31391
31392 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31393 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31394 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31395 different for different major modes. Without
31396 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31397 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31398
31399 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31400 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31401 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31402 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31403 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31404 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31405 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31406 the file.
31407
31408 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31409 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31410 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31411 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31412 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31413 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31414 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31415
31416 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31417 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31418 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31419 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31420 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31421 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31422 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31423 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31424 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31425 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31426 different for different major modes.
31427 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31428 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31429 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31430 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31431
31432 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31433 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31434 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31435 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31436 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31437 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31438 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31439 modes.
31440
31441 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31442 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31443 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31444 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31445 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31446 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31447
31448 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31449 @chapter Programming
31450
31451 @noindent
31452 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31453 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31454
31455 @enumerate
31456 @item
31457 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31458 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31459 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31460 as loops and conditionals.
31461
31462 @item
31463 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31464 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31465 as an interactive command.
31466
31467 @item
31468 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31469 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31470 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31471 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31472 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31473
31474 @item
31475 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31476 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31477 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31478 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31479 rewrite rules.
31480 @end enumerate
31481
31482 @kindex z
31483 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31484 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31485 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31486 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31487 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31488 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31489 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31490
31491 @menu
31492 * Creating User Keys::
31493 * Keyboard Macros::
31494 * Invocation Macros::
31495 * Algebraic Definitions::
31496 * Lisp Definitions::
31497 @end menu
31498
31499 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31500 @section Creating User Keys
31501
31502 @noindent
31503 @kindex Z D
31504 @pindex calc-user-define
31505 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31506 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31507 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31508
31509 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31510 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31511 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31512 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31513 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31514 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31515 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31516 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31517
31518 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31519 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31520
31521 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31522 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31523 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31524
31525 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31526 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31527 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31528 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31529 of a letter if you wish.
31530
31531 @kindex Z U
31532 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31533 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31534 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31535 key we defined above.
31536
31537 @kindex Z P
31538 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31539 @cindex Storing user definitions
31540 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31541 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31542 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31543 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31544 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31545 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31546 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
31547 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31548 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31549 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31550 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31551
31552 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31553 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31554 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31555 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31556 command will save all of these definitions.
31557 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31558 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31559 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31560 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31561 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31562 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31563 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31564 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31565
31566 @kindex Z E
31567 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31568 @cindex Editing user definitions
31569 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31570 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31571 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31572 following sections.
31573
31574 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31575 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31576
31577 @noindent
31578 @kindex X
31579 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31580 @cindex Keyboard macros
31581 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31582 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31583 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31584 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31585 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31586 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31587 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31588 information.
31589
31590 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31591 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31592 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31593 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31594 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31595 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31596 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31597 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31598 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31599 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31600 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31601 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31602 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31603
31604 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31605 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31606 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31607 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31608
31609 @menu
31610 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31611 * Conditionals in Macros::
31612 * Loops in Macros::
31613 * Local Values in Macros::
31614 * Queries in Macros::
31615 @end menu
31616
31617 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31618 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31619
31620 @noindent
31621 @kindex Z K
31622 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31623 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31624 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31625 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31626 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31627 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31628 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31629 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31630 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31631 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31632 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31633 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31634 descriptive command name if you wish.
31635
31636 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31637 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31638 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31639 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31640
31641 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31642 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31643
31644 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31645 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31646 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31647 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31648 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31649 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31650 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31651 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31652 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31653 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31654 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31655 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31656 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31657 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31658 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31659
31660 @kindex C-x * m
31661 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31662 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31663 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31664 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31665 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31666
31667 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31668 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31669
31670 @noindent
31671 @kindex Z [
31672 @kindex Z ]
31673 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31674 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31675 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31676 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31677 @cindex Conditional structures
31678 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31679 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31680 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31681 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31682 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31683 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31684 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31685
31686 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31687 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31688 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31689 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31690 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31691 command is skipped.
31692
31693 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31694 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31695 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31696 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31697 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31698 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31699
31700 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31701 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31702
31703 @kindex Z :
31704 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31705 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31706 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31707 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31708 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31709 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31710 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31711
31712 @kindex Z |
31713 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31714 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31715 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31716 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31717 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31718 it will execute @var{part3}.
31719
31720 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31721 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31722 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31723 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31724 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31725 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31726 does not.
31727
31728 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31729 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31730 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31731 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31732 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31733 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31734 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31735 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31736 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31737
31738 @kindex Z C-g
31739 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31740 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31741 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31742
31743 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31744 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31745
31746 @noindent
31747 @kindex Z <
31748 @kindex Z >
31749 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31750 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31751 @cindex Looping structures
31752 @cindex Iterative structures
31753 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31754 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31755 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31756 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31757 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31758 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31759 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31760 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31761 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31762
31763 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31764 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31765 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31766 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31767 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31768 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31769 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31770 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31771 macro.
31772
31773 @kindex Z /
31774 @pindex calc-break
31775 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31776 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31777 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31778 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31779 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31780 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31781 in the C language.
31782
31783 @kindex Z (
31784 @kindex Z )
31785 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31786 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31787 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31788 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31789 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31790 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31791 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31792 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31793 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31794 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31795 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31796
31797 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31798 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31799 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31800 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31801 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31802 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31803 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31804
31805 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31806 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31807 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31808 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31809 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31810 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31811
31812 @kindex Z @{
31813 @kindex Z @}
31814 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31815 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31816 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31817 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31818 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31819 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31820 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31821 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31822 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31823 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31824 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31825 this feature.)
31826
31827 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31828 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31829 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31830 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31831 as easily as in a macro definition.
31832
31833 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31834 conditional and looping commands.
31835
31836 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31837 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31838
31839 @noindent
31840 @cindex Local variables
31841 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31842 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31843 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31844 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31845 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31846 modes.
31847
31848 @kindex Z `
31849 @kindex Z '
31850 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31851 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31852 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31853 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31854 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31855 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31856
31857 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31858 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31859 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31860 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31861 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31862
31863 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31864 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31865 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31866 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31867 in exceptional conditions.
31868
31869 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31870 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31871 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31872 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31873 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31874 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31875 macros were involved.
31876
31877 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31878 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31879 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31880 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31881 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31882 thereof) are also saved.
31883
31884 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31885 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31886 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31887 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31888 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31889
31890 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31891 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31892 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31893 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31894 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31895 outside the construct.
31896
31897 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31898 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31899 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31900
31901 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31902 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31903
31904 @c @noindent
31905 @c @kindex Z =
31906 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31907 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31908 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31909 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31910 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31911 @c to turn such messages off.
31912
31913 @noindent
31914 @kindex Z #
31915 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31916 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31917 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31918 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31919 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31920 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31921 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31922 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31923 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31924 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31925 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31926 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31927
31928 As an example,
31929 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31930 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31931 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31932 will not be part of the macro.)
31933
31934 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31935 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31936 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31937 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31938 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31939 return control to the keyboard macro.
31940
31941 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31942 @section Invocation Macros
31943
31944 @kindex C-x * z
31945 @kindex Z I
31946 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31947 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31948 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31949 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31950 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31951 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31952 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31953 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31954 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31955 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31956
31957 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31958 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31959 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31960 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31961 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31962 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31963
31964 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31965 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31966 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31967 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31968 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31969
31970 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31971 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31972 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31973
31974 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31975 @section Programming with Formulas
31976
31977 @noindent
31978 @kindex Z F
31979 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31980 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31981 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31982 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31983 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31984 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31985 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31986 non-numeric arguments.
31987
31988 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31989 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31990 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31991 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31992 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31993 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31994 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31995
31996 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31997 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31998 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31999 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
32000
32001 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
32002 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
32003 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
32004 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
32005 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
32006 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
32007 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
32008 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
32009 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
32010
32011 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
32012 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
32013 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
32014 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
32015 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
32016 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
32017 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
32018 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
32019 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
32020 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
32021 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
32022 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
32023
32024 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
32025 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
32026 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
32027 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
32028 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
32029 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
32030 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
32031
32032 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
32033 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
32034 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
32035 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
32036
32037 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
32038 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
32039 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
32040 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
32041 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
32042 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
32043 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
32044 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
32045 question.
32046
32047 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
32048 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
32049 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
32050 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
32051
32052 @kindex Z G
32053 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
32054 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
32055 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
32056 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
32057 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
32058 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
32059 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
32060 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
32061
32062 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
32063 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
32064 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
32065 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
32066 @kbd{C-x k} to
32067 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
32068 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
32069 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
32070 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
32071
32072 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
32073 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
32074 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
32075
32076 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
32077 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
32078 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
32079 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
32080 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
32081 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
32082 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
32083 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
32084 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
32085
32086 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
32087 @section Programming with Lisp
32088
32089 @noindent
32090 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
32091 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
32092 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
32093 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
32094 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
32095 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
32096 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
32097 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
32098 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
32099
32100 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
32101 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
32102 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
32103 to program the Calculator.
32104
32105 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
32106 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
32107 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
32108 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
32109 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
32110
32111 @menu
32112 * Defining Functions::
32113 * Defining Simple Commands::
32114 * Defining Stack Commands::
32115 * Argument Qualifiers::
32116 * Example Definitions::
32117
32118 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
32119 * Internals::
32120 @end menu
32121
32122 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32123 @subsection Defining New Functions
32124
32125 @noindent
32126 @findex defmath
32127 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
32128 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
32129 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
32130 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
32131 example,
32132
32133 @example
32134 (defmath myfact (n)
32135 (if (> n 0)
32136 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32137 1))
32138 @end example
32139
32140 @noindent
32141 This actually expands to the code,
32142
32143 @example
32144 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32145 (if (math-posp n)
32146 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32147 1))
32148 @end example
32149
32150 @noindent
32151 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
32152
32153 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
32154 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
32155 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
32156 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
32157
32158 @smallexample
32159 (defmath myfact (n)
32160 (if (> n 0)
32161 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32162 (if (= n 0)
32163 1
32164 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
32165 @end smallexample
32166
32167 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
32168 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
32169 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
32170 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32171 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32172 efficiently as possible.
32173
32174 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32175 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32176 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32177 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32178 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32179 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32180
32181 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32182 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32183 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32184 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32185 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32186 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32187 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32188
32189 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32190 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32191 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32192 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32193 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32194
32195 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32196
32197 @itemize @bullet
32198 @item
32199 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32200 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32201 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32202 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32203 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32204
32205 @item
32206 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32207 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32208 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32209 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32210 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32211 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32212 into one element of a matrix.
32213
32214 @item
32215 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32216 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32217 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32218 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32219 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32220 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32221 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32222 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32223 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32224 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32225 things, not just two.
32226
32227 @item
32228 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32229 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32230 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32231 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32232 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32233
32234 @item
32235 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32236 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32237 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32238 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32239
32240 @item
32241 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32242 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32243 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32244 inside the body of the function.
32245 @end itemize
32246
32247 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32248 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32249 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32250 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32251 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32252
32253 @smallexample
32254 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32255 (and (numberp x)
32256 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32257 @end smallexample
32258
32259 expands to
32260
32261 @smallexample
32262 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32263 (and (math-numberp x)
32264 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32265 @end smallexample
32266
32267 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32268 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32269 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32270 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32271 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32272
32273 @example
32274 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
32275 @end example
32276
32277 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32278 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
32279 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
32280 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32281 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32282 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32283 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32284 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32285 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32286 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32287 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32288
32289 @example
32290 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32291 (defmath ... )
32292 (defmath ... )
32293 ))
32294 @end example
32295
32296 @noindent
32297 @vindex calc-define
32298 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32299 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32300 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32301 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32302 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32303 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32304 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32305 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32306 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32307
32308 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32309 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32310 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32311 after Calc itself is loaded.
32312
32313 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32314 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32315 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32316 that the @file{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32317
32318 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32319 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32320 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32321 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32322 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32323 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32324 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32325 protect against this situation, you can put
32326
32327 @example
32328 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32329 @end example
32330
32331 @findex calc-check-defines
32332 @noindent
32333 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32334 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32335 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32336 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32337
32338 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32339 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32340 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32341 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32342
32343 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32344 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32345
32346 @noindent
32347 @findex interactive
32348 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32349 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32350 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32351 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32352 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32353 the command work in the Calc environment.
32354
32355 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32356 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32357
32358 @smallexample
32359 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32360 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32361 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32362 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32363 @end smallexample
32364
32365 This expands to the pair of definitions,
32366
32367 @smallexample
32368 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32369 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32370 (interactive "p")
32371 (calc-wrapper
32372 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32373
32374 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32375 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32376 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32377 @end smallexample
32378
32379 @noindent
32380 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32381 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32382 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32383 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32384
32385 @findex calc-wrapper
32386 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32387 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32388
32389 @smallexample
32390 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32391 (unwind-protect
32392 (save-current-buffer
32393 (calc-select-buffer)
32394 @emph{body of function}
32395 @emph{renumber stack}
32396 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32397 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32398 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32399 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32400 @end smallexample
32401
32402 @findex calc-select-buffer
32403 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @file{*Calculator*}
32404 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32405 the @file{*Calc Trail*} window.
32406
32407 @findex calc-set-command-flag
32408 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32409 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32410 following command flags:
32411
32412 @table @code
32413 @item renum-stack
32414 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32415 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32416 @code{calc-push}.
32417
32418 @item clear-message
32419 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32420 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32421
32422 @item no-align
32423 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32424
32425 @item position-point
32426 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32427 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32428 this command finishes.
32429
32430 @item keep-flags
32431 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32432 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32433
32434 @item do-edit
32435 Switch to buffer @file{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32436
32437 @item hold-trail
32438 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32439 there.
32440 @end table
32441
32442 @kindex Y
32443 @kindex Y ?
32444 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32445 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32446 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32447 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32448 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32449 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32450 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32451 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32452 future versions of Calc.
32453
32454 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32455 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32456 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32457 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32458 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32459 within your package.
32460
32461 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32462 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32463 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32464 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32465 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32466 if necessary without having to modify the file.
32467
32468 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32469 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32470 decreases the precision.
32471
32472 @smallexample
32473 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32474 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32475
32476 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32477 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32478
32479 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32480
32481 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32482 'increase-precision)
32483 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32484 'decrease-precision)
32485
32486 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32487 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32488 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32489
32490 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32491 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32492 (interactive "p")
32493 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32494
32495 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32496 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32497 (interactive "p")
32498 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32499
32500 )) ; end of calc-define property
32501
32502 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32503 @end smallexample
32504
32505 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32506 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32507
32508 @noindent
32509 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32510 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32511
32512 @example
32513 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32514 @end example
32515
32516 @noindent
32517 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32518 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32519 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32520 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32521 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32522 parameters is valid.
32523
32524 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32525 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32526 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32527 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32528 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32529 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32530
32531 As an example, the definition
32532
32533 @smallexample
32534 (defmath myfact (n)
32535 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32536 (interactive 1 "fact")
32537 (if (> n 0)
32538 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32539 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32540 @end smallexample
32541
32542 @noindent
32543 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32544 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32545
32546 @smallexample
32547 (defun calc-myfact ()
32548 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32549 (interactive)
32550 (calc-slow-wrapper
32551 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32552 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32553
32554 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32555 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32556 (if (math-posp n)
32557 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32558 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32559 @end smallexample
32560
32561 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32562 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32563 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32564 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32565 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32566
32567 @findex calc-top-list-n
32568 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32569 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32570 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32571 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32572
32573 @findex calc-enter-result
32574 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32575 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32576 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32577 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32578 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32579 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32580
32581 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32582 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32583 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32584 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32585 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32586
32587 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32588 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32589 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32590
32591 @example
32592 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32593 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32594 @var{body})
32595 @end example
32596
32597 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32598 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32599 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32600
32601 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32602 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32603 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32604 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32605 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32606
32607 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32608 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32609
32610 @noindent
32611 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32612 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32613
32614 @example
32615 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32616 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32617 &rest @var{param})
32618 @var{body})
32619 @end example
32620
32621 @noindent
32622 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32623
32624 @example
32625 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32626 @end example
32627
32628 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32629
32630 @table @samp
32631 @item complete
32632 @findex complete
32633 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32634 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32635 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32636 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32637
32638 @item integer
32639 @findex integer
32640 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32641 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32642 formulas are rejected.
32643
32644 @item natnum
32645 @findex natnum
32646 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32647
32648 @item fixnum
32649 @findex fixnum
32650 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32651 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32652 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32653
32654 @item float
32655 @findex float
32656 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32657 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32658 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32659
32660 @item @var{pred}
32661 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32662 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32663
32664 @item not-@var{pred}
32665 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32666 @end table
32667
32668 For example,
32669
32670 @example
32671 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32672 &rest (integer d))
32673 @var{body})
32674 @end example
32675
32676 @noindent
32677 expands to
32678
32679 @example
32680 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32681 (and (math-matrixp b)
32682 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32683 (or (math-constp b)
32684 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32685 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32686 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32687 @var{body})
32688 @end example
32689
32690 @noindent
32691 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32692 body of the function.
32693
32694 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32695 @subsection Example Definitions
32696
32697 @noindent
32698 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32699 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32700 @pxref{Internals}.
32701
32702 @menu
32703 * Bit Counting Example::
32704 * Sine Example::
32705 @end menu
32706
32707 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32708 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32709
32710 @noindent
32711 @ignore
32712 @starindex
32713 @end ignore
32714 @tindex bcount
32715 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32716 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32717 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32718 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32719 create an intermediate set.
32720
32721 @smallexample
32722 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32723 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32724 (let ((count 0))
32725 (while (> n 0)
32726 (if (oddp n)
32727 (setq count (1+ count)))
32728 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32729 count))
32730 @end smallexample
32731
32732 @noindent
32733 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32734 Emacs Lisp function:
32735
32736 @smallexample
32737 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32738 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32739 (let ((count 0))
32740 (while (math-posp n)
32741 (if (math-oddp n)
32742 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32743 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32744 count))
32745 @end smallexample
32746
32747 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32748 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32749 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32750 involve actual division.
32751
32752 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32753 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32754 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32755 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32756 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32757
32758 @smallexample
32759 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32760 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32761 (let ((count 0))
32762 (while (not (fixnump n))
32763 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32764 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32765 n (car qr))))
32766 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32767
32768 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32769 (let ((count 0))
32770 (while (> n 0)
32771 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32772 n (lsh n -1)))
32773 count))
32774 @end smallexample
32775
32776 @noindent
32777 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32778 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32779 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32780 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32781 uses.
32782
32783 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32784 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32785 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32786 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32787 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32788 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32789 same thing with a single division by 512.
32790
32791 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32792 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32793
32794 @noindent
32795 @ignore
32796 @starindex
32797 @end ignore
32798 @tindex mysin
32799 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32800 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32801 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32802 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32803
32804 @smallexample
32805 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32806 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32807 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32808 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32809 newsum
32810 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32811 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32812 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32813 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32814 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32815 x (* x xnegsqr)
32816 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32817 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32818 (break)) ; then we are done.
32819 (setq sum newsum))
32820 sum))
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32824 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32825 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32826 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32827 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32828 by a separate algorithm.
32829
32830 @smallexample
32831 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32832 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32833 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32834 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32835 (cond ((complexp x)
32836 (mysin-complex x))
32837 ((< x 0)
32838 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32839 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32840
32841 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32842 (cond ((>= x 7)
32843 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32844 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32845 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32846 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32847 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32848 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32849 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32850 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32851 @end smallexample
32852
32853 @noindent
32854 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32855 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32856 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32857 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32858
32859 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32860 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32861 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32862 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32863 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32864 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32865 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32866 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32867 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32868 that this rule misses.
32869
32870 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32871 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32872 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32873 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32874
32875 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32876 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32877
32878 @noindent
32879 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32880 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32881 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32882 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32883 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32884 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32885 much simpler to use!
32886
32887 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32888 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32889
32890 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32891 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32892 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32893
32894 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32895 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32896 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32897 loaded and initialized for you.
32898
32899 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32900 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32901
32902 @ifinfo
32903 @example
32904
32905 @end example
32906 @end ifinfo
32907 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32908
32909 @noindent
32910 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32911 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32912 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32913 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32914
32915 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32916 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32917 one by one below.
32918
32919 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32920 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32921 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32922 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32923 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32924 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32925
32926 @ifinfo
32927 @example
32928
32929 @end example
32930 @end ifinfo
32931 @subsubsection Error Handling
32932
32933 @noindent
32934 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32935 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32936 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32937 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32938 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32939 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32940
32941 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32942 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32943 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32944 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32945
32946 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32947 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32948 ignored.
32949
32950 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32951 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32952 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32953
32954 @ifinfo
32955 @example
32956
32957 @end example
32958 @end ifinfo
32959 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32960
32961 @noindent
32962 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32963 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32964 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32965 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32966 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32967 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32968
32969 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32970 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32971 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32972
32973 @ifinfo
32974 @example
32975
32976 @end example
32977 @end ifinfo
32978 @subsubsection Default Modes
32979
32980 @noindent
32981 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32982 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32983 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32984 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32985 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32986 mode is used.
32987
32988 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32989 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32990 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32991
32992 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32993 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32994 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32995 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32996 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32997 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32998
32999 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
33000 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
33001 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
33002 of the default of 12.
33003
33004 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
33005 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
33006 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
33007 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
33008 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
33009
33010 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
33011 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
33012 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
33013 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
33014 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
33015 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
33016
33017 @ifinfo
33018 @example
33019
33020 @end example
33021 @end ifinfo
33022 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
33023
33024 @noindent
33025 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
33026 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
33027 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
33028 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
33029 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
33030
33031 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
33032 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
33033 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
33034 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
33035 structure.
33036
33037 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
33038 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
33039 an error if that object is not a constant).
33040
33041 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
33042 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
33043 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
33044 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
33045 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
33046 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
33047
33048 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
33049 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
33050 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
33051 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
33052
33053 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
33054 to format it as a string.
33055
33056 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
33057 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
33058 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
33059
33060 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
33061 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
33062 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
33063
33064 @ifinfo
33065 @example
33066
33067 @end example
33068 @end ifinfo
33069 @subsubsection Predicates
33070
33071 @noindent
33072 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
33073 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
33074 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
33075 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
33076
33077 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
33078 one value is less than another.
33079
33080 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
33081 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
33082 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
33083 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
33084 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
33085
33086 @ifinfo
33087 @example
33088
33089 @end example
33090 @end ifinfo
33091 @subsubsection Variable Values
33092
33093 @noindent
33094 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
33095 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
33096 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
33097 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
33098 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
33099 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
33100 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
33101
33102 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
33103 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
33104 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
33105 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
33106 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
33107 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
33108
33109 @example
33110 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
33111 @end example
33112
33113 @ifinfo
33114 @example
33115
33116 @end example
33117 @end ifinfo
33118 @subsubsection Stack Access
33119
33120 @noindent
33121 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
33122 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
33123 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
33124 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
33125 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
33126 usual way).
33127
33128 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
33129 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
33130 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
33131 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
33132 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
33133 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
33134 the stack.
33135
33136 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
33137 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
33138 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
33139 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
33140 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
33141
33142 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
33143 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
33144 as a string.
33145
33146 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
33147 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
33148 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
33149 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
33150 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
33151 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
33152
33153 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
33154 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
33155 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
33156
33157 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @file{*Calculator*}
33158 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
33159 the stack buffer if necessary.
33160
33161 @ifinfo
33162 @example
33163
33164 @end example
33165 @end ifinfo
33166 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
33167
33168 @noindent
33169 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
33170 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33171 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33172 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33173 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33174 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33175 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33176
33177 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33178 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33179 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33180 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33181 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33182
33183 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33184 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33185 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33186
33187 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33188
33189 @ifinfo
33190 @example
33191
33192 @end example
33193 @end ifinfo
33194 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33195
33196 @noindent
33197 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33198 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33199 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33200 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33201 @code{calc-eval}.
33202
33203 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33204 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33205 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33206 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33207
33208 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33209 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33210 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33211 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33212 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33213 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33214 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33215 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33216 your original buffer when it is done.
33217
33218 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33219 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33220
33221 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33222 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33223
33224 @ifinfo
33225 @example
33226
33227 @end example
33228 @end ifinfo
33229 @subsubsection Example
33230
33231 @noindent
33232 @findex convert-temp
33233 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33234 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33235 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33236 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33237 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33238 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33239 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33240
33241 @example
33242 (defun convert-temp ()
33243 (interactive)
33244 (save-excursion
33245 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33246 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33247 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33248 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33249 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33250 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33251 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33252 (if (equal type "F")
33253 (setq type "C"
33254 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33255 (setq type "F"
33256 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33257 (goto-char top2)
33258 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33259 (insert-before-markers type)
33260 (goto-char top1)
33261 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33262 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33263 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33264 (insert number))))
33265 @end example
33266
33267 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33268 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33269 instead of after it.
33270
33271 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33272 @subsection Calculator Internals
33273
33274 @noindent
33275 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33276 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33277 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33278 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33279 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33280 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33281 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33282 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33283
33284 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33285 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33286 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33287 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33288 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33289 in the remaining component files.
33290
33291 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33292 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33293 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33294 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33295 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33296 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33297 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33298 prove this file will already be loaded.
33299
33300 @menu
33301 * Data Type Formats::
33302 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
33303 * Stack Lisp Functions::
33304 * Predicates::
33305 * Computational Lisp Functions::
33306 * Vector Lisp Functions::
33307 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33308 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
33309 * Hooks::
33310 @end menu
33311
33312 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33313 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
33314
33315 @noindent
33316 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33317 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33318 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33319 which is not a Lisp list.
33320
33321 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33322 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for sufficiently large positive integers
33323 (where ``sufficiently large'' depends on the machine), or
33324 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative
33325 integers. Each @var{d} is a base-@expr{10^n} ``digit'' (where again,
33326 @expr{n} depends on the machine), a Lisp integer from 0 to
33327 99@dots{}9. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33328 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33329 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} might be stored as
33330 @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33331
33332 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33333 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33334 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33335 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33336 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33337 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33338
33339 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33340 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33341 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33342 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33343 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33344 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33345
33346 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33347 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33348 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33349 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33350 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33351 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33352 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33353 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33354 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33355 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33356
33357 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33358 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33359 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33360 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33361 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33362
33363 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33364 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33365 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33366 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33367 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33368 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33369 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33370 negative real number.)
33371
33372 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33373 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33374 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33375 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33376 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33377
33378 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33379 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33380 January 1, 1 AD@. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33381 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33382
33383 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33384 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33385 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33386
33387 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33388 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33389 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33390 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33391 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33392 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33393
33394 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33395 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33396 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33397 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33398 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33399 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33400 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33401 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33402 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33403 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33404
33405 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33406 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33407 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33408 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33409 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33410 generally unused by Calc data structures.
33411
33412 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33413 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33414 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33415 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33416 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33417 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33418 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33419 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33420 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33421 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33422 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33423 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33424 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33425 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33426 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33427 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33428 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33429 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33430 the variable is used.
33431
33432 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33433 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33434 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33435 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33436 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33437 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33438 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33439 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33440 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33441 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33442 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33443 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33444 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33445 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33446 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33447 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33448 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33449 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33450 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33451
33452 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33453 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
33454
33455 @noindent
33456 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33457 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33458 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33459 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33460
33461 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33462 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33463 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33464 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33465 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33466 @end defun
33467
33468 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33469 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33470 remove it from that list.
33471 @end defun
33472
33473 @defun calc-record-undo rec
33474 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33475 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33476 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33477 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33478 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33479 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33480 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33481 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33482 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33483 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33484 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33485 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33486 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33487 @end defun
33488
33489 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33490 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33491 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33492 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33493 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33494 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33495 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33496 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33497 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33498 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33499 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33500 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33501 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33502 @end defun
33503
33504 @defun calc-is-inverse
33505 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33506 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33507 @end defun
33508
33509 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33510 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33511 @end defun
33512
33513 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33514 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33515
33516 @noindent
33517 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33518 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33519
33520 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33521 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33522 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33523 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33524 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33525 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33526 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33527 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33528 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33529
33530 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33531 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33532 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33533 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33534 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33535 @end defun
33536
33537 @defun calc-top-list n m
33538 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33539 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33540 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33541 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33542 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33543 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33544 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33545 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33546 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33547 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33548
33549 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33550 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33551 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33552 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33553 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33554 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33555 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33556 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33557 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33558 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33559 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33560 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33561 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33562 @end defun
33563
33564 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33565 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33566 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33567 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33568
33569 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33570 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33571 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33572 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33573 contain selections.
33574 @end defun
33575
33576 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33577 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33578 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33579 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33580 will be used.
33581 @end defun
33582
33583 @defun calc-normalize n
33584 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33585 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33586 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33587 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33588 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33589 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33590 @end defun
33591
33592 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33593 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33594 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33595 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33596 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33597 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33598 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33599 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33600 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33601 @code{calc-top-list}.
33602 @end defun
33603
33604 @defun calc-top-n m
33605 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33606 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33607 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33608 @end defun
33609
33610 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33611 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33612 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33613 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33614 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33615 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33616 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33617
33618 @smallexample
33619 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33620 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33621 @end smallexample
33622
33623 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33624 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33625 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33626 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33627 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33628 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33629 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33630 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33631 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33632 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33633 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33634 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33635 are present.
33636 @end defun
33637
33638 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33639 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33640 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33641 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33642 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33643 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33644
33645 @smallexample
33646 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33647 (interactive "P")
33648 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33649 @end smallexample
33650 @end defun
33651
33652 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33653 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33654 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33655 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33656 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33657 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33658 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33659 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33660 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33661 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33662 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33663 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33664 top element.
33665 @end defun
33666
33667 @defun calc-stack-size
33668 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33669 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33670 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33671 @end defun
33672
33673 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33674 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33675 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33676 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33677 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33678 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33679 @end defun
33680
33681 @defun calc-substack-height n
33682 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33683 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33684 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33685 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33686 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33687 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33688 entries.)
33689 @end defun
33690
33691 @defun calc-refresh
33692 Erase the @file{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33693 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33694 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33695 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33696 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33697 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33698 @end defun
33699
33700 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33701 @subsubsection Predicates
33702
33703 @noindent
33704 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33705 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33706 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33707 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33708 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33709 the full range of Calc data types.
33710
33711 @defun zerop x
33712 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33713 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33714 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33715 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33716 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33717 @end defun
33718
33719 @defun negp x
33720 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33721 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33722 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33723 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33724 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33725 @end defun
33726
33727 @defun posp x
33728 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33729 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33730 @end defun
33731
33732 @defun looks-negp x
33733 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33734 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33735 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33736 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33737 @end defun
33738
33739 @defun integerp x
33740 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33741 @end defun
33742
33743 @defun fixnump x
33744 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33745 @end defun
33746
33747 @defun natnump x
33748 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33749 @end defun
33750
33751 @defun fixnatnump x
33752 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33753 @end defun
33754
33755 @defun num-integerp x
33756 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33757 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33758 the decimal point.
33759 @end defun
33760
33761 @defun messy-integerp x
33762 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33763 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33764 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33765 @end defun
33766
33767 @defun num-natnump x
33768 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33769 @end defun
33770
33771 @defun evenp x
33772 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33773 @end defun
33774
33775 @defun looks-evenp x
33776 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33777 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33778 @end defun
33779
33780 @defun oddp x
33781 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33782 @end defun
33783
33784 @defun ratp x
33785 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33786 fraction.
33787 @end defun
33788
33789 @defun realp x
33790 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33791 or floating-point number.
33792 @end defun
33793
33794 @defun anglep x
33795 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33796 @end defun
33797
33798 @defun floatp x
33799 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33800 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33801 is a float.
33802 @end defun
33803
33804 @defun complexp x
33805 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33806 (but not a real number).
33807 @end defun
33808
33809 @defun rect-complexp x
33810 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33811 @end defun
33812
33813 @defun polar-complexp x
33814 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33815 @end defun
33816
33817 @defun numberp x
33818 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33819 @end defun
33820
33821 @defun scalarp x
33822 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33823 @end defun
33824
33825 @defun vectorp x
33826 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33827 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33828 @end defun
33829
33830 @defun numvecp x
33831 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33832 @end defun
33833
33834 @defun matrixp x
33835 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33836 all of the same size.
33837 @end defun
33838
33839 @defun square-matrixp x
33840 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33841 @end defun
33842
33843 @defun objectp x
33844 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33845 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33846 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33847 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33848 @end defun
33849
33850 @defun objvecp x
33851 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33852 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33853 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33854 @end defun
33855
33856 @defun primp x
33857 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33858 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33859 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33860 and intervals.
33861 @end defun
33862
33863 @defun constp x
33864 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33865 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33866 components are @code{constp}.
33867 @end defun
33868
33869 @defun lessp x y
33870 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33871 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33872 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33873 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33874 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33875 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33876 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33877 @end defun
33878
33879 @defun beforep x y
33880 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33881 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33882 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33883 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33884 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33885 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33886 by Calc's algebraic simplifications to put the terms of a product into
33887 canonical order: This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to
33888 @samp{2 x y}.
33889 @end defun
33890
33891 @defun equal x y
33892 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33893 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33894 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33895 0 and 0.0 as different.
33896 @end defun
33897
33898 @defun math-equal x y
33899 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33900 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33901 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33902 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33903 @end defun
33904
33905 @defun equal-int x n
33906 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33907 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33908 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33909 whenever possible.
33910 @end defun
33911
33912 @defun nearly-equal x y
33913 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33914 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33915 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33916 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33917 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33918 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33919 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33920 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33921 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33922 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33923 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33924 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33925 @end defun
33926
33927 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33928 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33929 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33930 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33931 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33932 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33933 @var{y} must be real.
33934 @end defun
33935
33936 @defun is-true x
33937 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33938 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33939 or a provably non-zero formula.
33940 @end defun
33941
33942 @defun reject-arg val pred
33943 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33944 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33945 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33946 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33947 @end defun
33948
33949 @defun inexact-value
33950 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33951 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33952 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33953 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33954 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33955 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33956 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33957 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33958 @end defun
33959
33960 @defun overflow
33961 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33962 @end defun
33963
33964 @defun underflow
33965 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33966 @end defun
33967
33968 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33969 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33970
33971 @noindent
33972 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33973 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33974 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33975 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33976 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33977 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33978 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33979
33980 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33981 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33982 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33983 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33984 respectively, instead.
33985
33986 @defun normalize val
33987 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33988 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33989 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33990 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33991 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33992 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33993 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33994 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33995 return 6.
33996
33997 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33998 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33999 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
34000 the formula still in symbolic form.
34001
34002 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
34003 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
34004 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
34005 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
34006 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
34007 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
34008 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
34009 on the stack.
34010 @end defun
34011
34012 @defun evaluate-expr expr
34013 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
34014 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
34015 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
34016 @end defun
34017
34018 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
34019 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
34020 digits. This is a macro which expands to
34021
34022 @smallexample
34023 (math-normalize
34024 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
34025 @var{body}))
34026 @end smallexample
34027
34028 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
34029 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
34030 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
34031 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
34032 @end defmac
34033
34034 @defun make-frac n d
34035 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
34036 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
34037 @end defun
34038
34039 @defun make-float mant exp
34040 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
34041 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
34042 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
34043 if @var{exp} is out of range.
34044 @end defun
34045
34046 @defun make-sdev x sigma
34047 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
34048 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
34049 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
34050 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
34051 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34052 @end defun
34053
34054 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
34055 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
34056 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
34057 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
34058 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
34059 @end defun
34060
34061 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
34062 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
34063 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
34064 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
34065 @end defun
34066
34067 @defun make-mod n m
34068 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
34069 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
34070 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
34071 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
34072 @end defun
34073
34074 @defun float x
34075 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
34076 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
34077 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
34078 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
34079 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34080 @end defun
34081
34082 @defun compare x y
34083 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
34084 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
34085 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
34086 undefined or cannot be determined.
34087 @end defun
34088
34089 @defun numdigs n
34090 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
34091 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
34092 considered to have zero digits.
34093 @end defun
34094
34095 @defun scale-int x n
34096 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
34097 digits with truncation toward zero.
34098 @end defun
34099
34100 @defun scale-rounding x n
34101 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
34102 integer rather than truncating.
34103 @end defun
34104
34105 @defun fixnum n
34106 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
34107 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
34108 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
34109 @end defun
34110
34111 @defun sqr x
34112 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
34113 @end defun
34114
34115 @defun quotient x y
34116 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
34117 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
34118 direction of rounding is undefined.
34119 @end defun
34120
34121 @defun idiv x y
34122 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
34123 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
34124 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
34125 slower than for @code{quotient}.
34126 @end defun
34127
34128 @defun imod x y
34129 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
34130 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
34131 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
34132 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
34133 @end defun
34134
34135 @defun idivmod x y
34136 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
34137 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
34138 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
34139 @end defun
34140
34141 @defun pow x y
34142 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
34143 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
34144 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
34145 @end defun
34146
34147 @defun abs-approx x
34148 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
34149 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
34150 the absolute values of the components.
34151 @end defun
34152
34153 @findex e
34154 @findex gamma-const
34155 @findex ln-2
34156 @findex ln-10
34157 @findex phi
34158 @findex pi-over-2
34159 @findex pi-over-4
34160 @findex pi-over-180
34161 @findex sqrt-two-pi
34162 @findex sqrt-e
34163 @findex two-pi
34164 @defun pi
34165 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
34166 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
34167 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
34168 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
34169 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
34170 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
34171 first are essentially free.
34172 @end defun
34173
34174 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34175 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34176 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34177 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34178 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34179 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34180 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34181 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34182 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34183 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34184 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34185 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34186 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34187 @end defmac
34188
34189 @findex half-circle
34190 @findex quarter-circle
34191 @defun full-circle symb
34192 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34193 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34194 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34195 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34196 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34197 @end defun
34198
34199 @defun power-of-2 n
34200 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34201 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34202 particular @var{n} is expensive.
34203 @end defun
34204
34205 @defun integer-log2 n
34206 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34207 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34208 return @code{nil}.
34209 @end defun
34210
34211 @defun div-mod a b m
34212 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34213 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34214 @end defun
34215
34216 @defun pow-mod a b m
34217 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34218 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34219 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34220 @end defun
34221
34222 @defun isqrt n
34223 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34224 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34225 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34226 @end defun
34227
34228 @defun to-hms a ang
34229 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34230 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34231 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34232 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34233 @end defun
34234
34235 @defun from-hms a ang
34236 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34237 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34238 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34239 is returned as-is.
34240 @end defun
34241
34242 @defun to-radians a
34243 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34244 angular mode.
34245 @end defun
34246
34247 @defun from-radians a
34248 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34249 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34250 @end defun
34251
34252 @defun to-radians-2 a
34253 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34254 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34255 @end defun
34256
34257 @defun from-radians-2 a
34258 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34259 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34260 @end defun
34261
34262 @defun random-digit
34263 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34264 @end defun
34265
34266 @defun random-digits n
34267 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34268 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34269 @end defun
34270
34271 @defun random-float
34272 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34273 @end defun
34274
34275 @defun prime-test n iters
34276 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34277 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34278 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34279 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34280 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34281 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34282 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34283 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34284 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34285 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34286 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34287 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34288 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34289 @end defun
34290
34291 @defun to-simple-fraction f
34292 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34293 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34294 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34295 fast.
34296 @end defun
34297
34298 @defun to-fraction f tol
34299 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34300 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34301 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34302 @end defun
34303
34304 @defun quarter-integer n
34305 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34306 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34307 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34308 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34309 returns @code{nil}.
34310 @end defun
34311
34312 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34313 @subsubsection Vector Functions
34314
34315 @noindent
34316 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34317 matrices.
34318
34319 @defun math-concat x y
34320 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34321 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34322 @end defun
34323
34324 @defun vec-length v
34325 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34326 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34327 rows in the matrix.
34328 @end defun
34329
34330 @defun mat-dimens m
34331 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34332 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34333 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34334 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34335 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34336 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34337 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34338 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34339 elements.
34340 @end defun
34341
34342 @defun dimension-error
34343 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34344 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34345 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34346 @end defun
34347
34348 @defun build-vector args
34349 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34350 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34351 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34352 @end defun
34353
34354 @defun make-vec obj dims
34355 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34356 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34357 filled with 27's.
34358 @end defun
34359
34360 @defun row-matrix v
34361 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34362 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34363 leave it alone.
34364 @end defun
34365
34366 @defun col-matrix v
34367 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34368 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34369 already a matrix, leave it alone.
34370 @end defun
34371
34372 @defun map-vec f v
34373 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34374 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34375 of vector @var{v}.
34376 @end defun
34377
34378 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
34379 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34380 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34381 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34382 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34383 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34384 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34385 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34386 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34387 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34388 @end defun
34389
34390 @defun reduce-vec f v
34391 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34392 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34393 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34394 @end defun
34395
34396 @defun reduce-cols f m
34397 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34398 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34399 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34400 @end defun
34401
34402 @defun mat-row m n
34403 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34404 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34405 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34406 @end defun
34407
34408 @defun mat-col m n
34409 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34410 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34411 @end defun
34412
34413 @defun mat-less-row m n
34414 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34415 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34416 @end defun
34417
34418 @defun mat-less-col m n
34419 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34420 @end defun
34421
34422 @defun transpose m
34423 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34424 @end defun
34425
34426 @defun flatten-vector v
34427 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34428 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34429 @end defun
34430
34431 @defun copy-matrix m
34432 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34433 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34434 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34435 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34436 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34437 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34438 @end defun
34439
34440 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34441 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34442 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34443 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34444 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34445 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34446 @var{m}.
34447 @end defun
34448
34449 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34450 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34451
34452 @noindent
34453 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34454 Calculator.
34455
34456 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
34457 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34458 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34459 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34460 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34461 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34462 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34463 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34464 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34465 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34466 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34467 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34468 their corresponding sub-formulas.
34469
34470 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34471 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34472 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34473 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34474 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34475 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34476 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34477 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34478 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34479 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34480 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34481 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34482 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34483 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34484 @end defun
34485
34486 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34487 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34488 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34489 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34490 the formula in-place.
34491 @end defun
34492
34493 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34494 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34495 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34496 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34497 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34498 @end defun
34499
34500 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34501 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34502 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34503 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34504 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34505 to reflect the new selection.
34506 @end defun
34507
34508 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34509 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34510 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34511 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34512 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34513 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34514 @end defun
34515
34516 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34517 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34518 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34519 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34520 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34521 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34522 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34523 This function does not take associativity into account.
34524 @end defun
34525
34526 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34527 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34528 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34529 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34530 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34531 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34532 return the whole expression.
34533 @end defun
34534
34535 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34536 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34537 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34538 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34539 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34540 @end defun
34541
34542 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34543 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34544 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34545 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34546 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34547 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34548 function does not take associativity into account.
34549 @end defun
34550
34551 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34552 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34553 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34554 @end defun
34555
34556 @defun simplify expr
34557 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying Calc's algebraic
34558 simplifications. This always returns a copy of the expression; the
34559 structure @var{expr} points to remains unchanged in memory.
34560
34561 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34562 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34563 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34564 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34565 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34566 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34567 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34568 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34569 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34570 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34571 needed: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34572 further simplifications were possible.
34573 @end defun
34574
34575 @defun simplify-extended expr
34576 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34577 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34578 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34579 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34580 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34581 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34582 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34583 before taking any action.
34584 @end defun
34585
34586 @defun simplify-units expr
34587 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34588 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34589 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34590 @end defun
34591
34592 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34593 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34594 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34595 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34596 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34597 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34598 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34599 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34600 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34601 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34602 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34603 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34604 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34605 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34606
34607 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34608 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34609 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34610 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34611 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34612
34613 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34614 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34615 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34616 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34617
34618 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34619 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34620 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34621 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34622 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34623
34624 @smallexample
34625 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34626 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34627 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34628 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34629 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34630 (or math-living-dangerously
34631 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34632 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34633 @end smallexample
34634
34635 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34636 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34637 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34638 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34639 @end defmac
34640
34641 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34642 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34643 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34644 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34645 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34646 @end defun
34647
34648 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34649 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34650 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34651 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34652 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34653 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34654 square roots:
34655
34656 @smallexample
34657 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34658 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34659 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34660 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34661 (math-normalize
34662 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34663 (math-cancel-common-factor
34664 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34665 @end smallexample
34666 @end defun
34667
34668 @defun frac-gcd a b
34669 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34670 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34671 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34672 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34673 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34674 @end defun
34675
34676 @defun map-tree func expr many
34677 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34678 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34679 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34680 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34681 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34682 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34683 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34684 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34685 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34686 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34687 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34688 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34689 @end defun
34690
34691 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34692 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34693 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34694 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34695 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34696 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34697 message.
34698 @end defun
34699
34700 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34701 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34702 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34703 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34704 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34705 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34706 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34707 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34708 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34709 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34710 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34711 @end defun
34712
34713 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34714 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34715 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34716 @end defun
34717
34718 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34719 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34720 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34721 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34722 times.
34723 @end defun
34724
34725 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34726 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34727 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34728 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34729 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34730 @end defun
34731
34732 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34733 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34734 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34735 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34736 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34737 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34738 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34739 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of nondifferentiable
34740 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34741 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34742
34743 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34744 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34745 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34746 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34747 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34748 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34749 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34750 is defined by
34751
34752 @smallexample
34753 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34754 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34755 @end smallexample
34756
34757 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34758 @smallexample
34759 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34760 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34761 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34762 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34763 @end smallexample
34764 @end defun
34765
34766 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34767 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34768 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34769 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34770 @end defun
34771
34772 @defun integ expr var low high
34773 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34774 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34775 @end defun
34776
34777 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34778 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34779 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34780 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34781 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34782 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34783 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34784 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34785 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34786 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34787 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34788
34789 @smallexample
34790 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34791 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34792 (and int
34793 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34794
34795 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34796 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34797 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34798 @end smallexample
34799
34800 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34801 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34802 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34803 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34804 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34805 result.
34806 @end defmac
34807
34808 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34809 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34810 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34811 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34812 @var{v}.
34813 @end defmac
34814
34815 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34816 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34817 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34818 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34819 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34820 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34821 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34822 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34823 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34824 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34825 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34826
34827 @smallexample
34828 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34829 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34830 @end smallexample
34831
34832 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34833 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34834 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34835 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34836 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34837 @end defun
34838
34839 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34840 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34841 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34842 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34843 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34844 @end defun
34845
34846 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34847 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34848 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34849 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34850 @end defun
34851
34852 @defun expr-contains expr var
34853 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34854 of @var{expr}.
34855
34856 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34857 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34858 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34859 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34860 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34861 @code{eq} to each other.
34862 @end defun
34863
34864 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34865 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34866 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34867 @end defun
34868
34869 @defun expr-depends expr var
34870 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34871 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34872 in common.
34873 @end defun
34874
34875 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34876 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34877 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34878 @end defun
34879
34880 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34881 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34882 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34883 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34884 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34885 @end defun
34886
34887 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34888 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34889 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34890 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34891 are ignored.
34892 @end defun
34893
34894 @defun expr-weight expr
34895 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34896 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34897 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34898 @end defun
34899
34900 @defun expr-height expr
34901 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34902 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34903 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34904 @end defun
34905
34906 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34907 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34908 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34909 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34910 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34911 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34912 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34913 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34914 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34915 a polynomial of degree 0.
34916 @end defun
34917
34918 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34919 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34920 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34921 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34922 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34923 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34924 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34925 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34926 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34927 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34928 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34929 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34930 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34931 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34932 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34933 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34934 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34935 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34936 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34937 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34938 @end defun
34939
34940 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34941 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34942 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34943 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34944 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34945 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34946 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34947 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34948 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34949 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34950 is found.
34951 @end defun
34952
34953 @defun poly-simplify poly
34954 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34955 clipping off trailing zeros.
34956 @end defun
34957
34958 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34959 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34960 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34961 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34962 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34963 @end defun
34964
34965 @defun poly-mul a b
34966 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34967 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34968 @end defun
34969
34970 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34971 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34972 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34973 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34974 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34975 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34976 @end defun
34977
34978 @defun check-unit-name var
34979 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34980 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34981 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34982 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34983 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34984 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34985 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34986 @end defun
34987
34988 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34989 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34990 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34991 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34992 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34993 @end defun
34994
34995 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34996 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34997 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34998 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34999 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
35000 @end defun
35001
35002 @defun to-standard-units expr which
35003 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
35004 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
35005 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
35006 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
35007 is an expression to substitute for it.
35008 @end defun
35009
35010 @defun remove-units expr
35011 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
35012 This expression is generally normalized before use.
35013 @end defun
35014
35015 @defun extract-units expr
35016 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
35017 by ones.
35018 @end defun
35019
35020 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
35021 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
35022
35023 @noindent
35024 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
35025 Calc numbers and formulas.
35026
35027 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
35028 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
35029 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
35030 @end defun
35031
35032 @defun read-number str
35033 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
35034 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
35035 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
35036 @end defun
35037
35038 @defun read-expr str
35039 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
35040 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
35041 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
35042 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
35043 a string describing the problem.
35044 @end defun
35045
35046 @defun read-exprs str
35047 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
35048 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
35049 shown above is returned instead.
35050 @end defun
35051
35052 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
35053 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
35054 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
35055 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
35056 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
35057 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
35058 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
35059 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
35060 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
35061 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
35062 @code{calc-normalize} first.
35063
35064 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
35065 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
35066 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
35067 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
35068 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
35069 that actually appeared in the input.
35070 @end defun
35071
35072 @defun format-number a
35073 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
35074 @end defun
35075
35076 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
35077 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
35078 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
35079 This is a simple format designed
35080 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
35081 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
35082 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
35083 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
35084 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
35085 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
35086 @end defun
35087
35088 @defun format-nice-expr a width
35089 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
35090 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
35091 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
35092 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
35093 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
35094 @end defun
35095
35096 @defun format-value a width
35097 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
35098 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
35099 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
35100 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
35101 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
35102 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
35103 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
35104 window is used.
35105 @end defun
35106
35107 @defun compose-expr a prec
35108 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
35109 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
35110 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
35111 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
35112 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
35113 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
35114 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
35115 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
35116 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
35117 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
35118 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
35119 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
35120 normal function-call notation for that language.
35121 @end defun
35122
35123 @defun composition-to-string c w
35124 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
35125 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
35126 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
35127 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
35128 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
35129 @end defun
35130
35131 @defun comp-width c
35132 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
35133 @end defun
35134
35135 @defun comp-height c
35136 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
35137 @end defun
35138
35139 @defun comp-ascent c
35140 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
35141 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
35142 @end defun
35143
35144 @defun comp-descent c
35145 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
35146 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
35147 @end defun
35148
35149 @defun comp-first-char c
35150 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
35151 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
35152 return @code{nil}.
35153 @end defun
35154
35155 @defun comp-last-char c
35156 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
35157 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
35158 @end defun
35159
35160 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35161 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
35162 @comment
35163 @comment @noindent
35164 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
35165
35166 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35167 @subsubsection Hooks
35168
35169 @noindent
35170 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
35171 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
35172 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
35173 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35174 other customization-related variables are also described here.
35175
35176 @defvar calc-load-hook
35177 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35178 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35179 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35180 @end defvar
35181
35182 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35183 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35184 @end defvar
35185
35186 @defvar calc-start-hook
35187 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35188 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35189 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35190 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35191 @end defvar
35192
35193 @defvar calc-mode-hook
35194 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35195 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35196 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35197 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35198 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35199 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35200 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35201 been evaluated yet.
35202 @end defvar
35203
35204 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35205 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35206 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35207 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35208 per Emacs session.
35209 @end defvar
35210
35211 @defvar calc-end-hook
35212 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35213 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35214 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35215 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35216 @end defvar
35217
35218 @defvar calc-window-hook
35219 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35220 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35221 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35222 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35223 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35224 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35225 @end defvar
35226
35227 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35228 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35229 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35230 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35231 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35232 @end defvar
35233
35234 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35235 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35236 @end defvar
35237
35238 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35239 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35240 new buffer.
35241 @end defvar
35242
35243 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35244 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35245 new formula.
35246 @end defvar
35247
35248 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35249 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35250 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35251 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35252 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35253 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35254 @code{calc-edit} command.)
35255 @end defvar
35256
35257 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35258 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35259 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35260 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35261 message is inserted.
35262 @end defvar
35263
35264 @defvar calc-reset-hook
35265 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35266 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35267 @end defvar
35268
35269 @defvar calc-other-modes
35270 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35271 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35272 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35273 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35274 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35275 @end defvar
35276
35277 @defvar calc-mode-map
35278 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35279 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35280 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35281 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35282 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35283 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35284 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35285 extensions are loaded.
35286 @end defvar
35287
35288 @defvar calc-digit-map
35289 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35290 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35291 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35292 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35293 @end defvar
35294
35295 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35296 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35297 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35298 @end defvar
35299
35300 @defvar calc-store-var-map
35301 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35302 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35303 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35304 @end defvar
35305
35306 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35307 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35308 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35309 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35310 @end defvar
35311
35312 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
35313 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35314 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35315 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35316 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35317 non-default variables are written out.
35318 @end defvar
35319
35320 @defvar calc-local-var-list
35321 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35322 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35323 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35324 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35325 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35326 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35327 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35328 @end defvar
35329
35330 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35331 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35332 @include gpl.texi
35333
35334 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35335 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35336 @include doclicense.texi
35337
35338 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35339 @appendix Customizing Calc
35340
35341 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35342 to use a different prefix, you can put
35343
35344 @example
35345 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35346 @end example
35347
35348 @noindent
35349 in your .emacs file.
35350 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35351 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35352 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35353 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35354 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35355 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35356 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35357
35358 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35359 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
35360 calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
35361 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35362 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35363 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35364 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35365 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35366 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35367 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35368
35369 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35370 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35371 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35372 to see how regular expressions work.
35373
35374 @defvar calc-settings-file
35375 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35376 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35377 definitions.
35378 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35379 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35380 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35381 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35382
35383 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35384 unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35385 value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
35386 @end defvar
35387
35388 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35389 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35390 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35391 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35392 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35393 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35394 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35395 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35396 @end defvar
35397
35398 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35399 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35400 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35401 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35402 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35403 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35404 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35405 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35406 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35407 to display or print the output.
35408
35409 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35410 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35411 @code{"lp %s"}.
35412 @end defvar
35413
35414 @defvar calc-language-alist
35415 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35416 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35417 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35418 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35419 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35420 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35421 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35422 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35423 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35424 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35425 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35426
35427 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35428 @example
35429 ((latex-mode . latex)
35430 (tex-mode . tex)
35431 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35432 (context-mode . tex)
35433 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35434 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35435 (c-mode . c)
35436 (c++-mode . c)
35437 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35438 (f90-mode . fortran))
35439 @end example
35440 @end defvar
35441
35442 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35443 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35444 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35445 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35446 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35447 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35448 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35449 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35450 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35451
35452 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35453 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35454 @samp{%} and a space.
35455
35456 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35457 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35458 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35459 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35460 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35461 @example
35462 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35463 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35464 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35465 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35466 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35467 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35468 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35469 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35470 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35471 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35472 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35473 @end example
35474 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35475 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35476 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35477 @end defvar
35478
35479 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35480 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35481 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35482 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35483 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35484 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35485 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35486 They are regular expressions;
35487 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35488 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35489 delimiters''.
35490
35491 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35492 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35493 @enumerate
35494 @item
35495 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35496 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35497 @item
35498 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35499 @item
35500 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35501 @item
35502 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35503 @item
35504 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35505 @end enumerate
35506
35507 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35508 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35509 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35510 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35511 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35512 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35513 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35514 @code{nil}.
35515 @end defvar
35516
35517 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35518 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35519 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35520 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35521 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35522 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35523
35524 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35525 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35526
35527 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35528 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35529 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35530 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35531 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35532 @code{nil}.
35533 @end defvar
35534
35535 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35536 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35537 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35538 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35539 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35540 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35541 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35542 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35543 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35544
35545 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35546 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35547 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35548 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35549 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35550
35551 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35552 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35553 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35554 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35555 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35556 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35557 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35558 @example
35559 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35560 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35561 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35562 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35563 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35564 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35565 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35566 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35567 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35568 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35569 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35570 @end example
35571 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35572 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35573 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35574 @end defvar
35575
35576 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35577 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35578 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35579 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35580 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35581 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35582 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35583
35584 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35585 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35586 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35587 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35588 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35589 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35590 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35591 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35592 closing newline are omitted.)
35593
35594 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35595 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35596 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35597 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35598 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35599 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35600 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35601 @code{nil}.
35602 @end defvar
35603
35604 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35605 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35606 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35607 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35608 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35609 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35610 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35611 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35612 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35613
35614 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35615 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35616 @code{"\n"}.
35617 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35618 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35619 lines by themselves.
35620
35621 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35622 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35623 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35624 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35625 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35626 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35627 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35628 @example
35629 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35630 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35631 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35632 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35633 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35634 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35635 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35636 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35637 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35638 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35639 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35640 @end example
35641 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35642 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35643 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35644 @end defvar
35645
35646 @defvar calc-lu-power-reference
35647 @defvarx calc-lu-field-reference
35648 See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35649 The variables @code{calc-lu-power-reference} and
35650 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35651 strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35652 units.
35653
35654 The default value of @code{calc-lu-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35655 and the default value of @code{calc-lu-field-reference} is
35656 @code{"20 uPa"}.
35657 @end defvar
35658
35659 @defvar calc-note-threshold
35660 See @ref{Musical Notes}.@*
35661 The variable @code{calc-note-threshold} is a number (written as a
35662 string) which determines how close (in cents) a frequency needs to be
35663 to a note to be recognized as that note.
35664
35665 The default value of @code{calc-note-threshold} is 1.
35666 @end defvar
35667
35668 @defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35669 @defvarx calc-selected-face
35670 @defvarx calc-nonselected-face
35671 See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
35672 The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35673 determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35674 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35675 a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35676 character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35677 character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35678 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35679 then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35680 non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35681 or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
35682 @code{calc-nonselected-face}.
35683 @end defvar
35684
35685 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35686 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35687 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35688 formulas in normal language modes. If
35689 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35690 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35691 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35692 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35693 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35694 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35695 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35696 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35697 @end defvar
35698
35699 @defvar calc-ensure-consistent-units
35700 When converting units, the variable @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35701 determines whether or not the target units need to be consistent with the
35702 original units. If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is @code{nil}, then
35703 the target units don't need to have the same dimensions as the original units;
35704 for example, converting @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will produce @samp{30.48 m/s}.
35705 If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is non-@code{nil}, then the target units
35706 need to have the same dimensions as the original units; for example, converting
35707 @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will result in an error, since @samp{ft/s} and @samp{m}
35708 have different dimensions. The default value of @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35709 is @code{nil}.
35710 @end defvar
35711
35712 @defvar calc-context-sensitive-enter
35713 The commands @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-pop} will typically
35714 duplicate the top of the stack. If
35715 @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is non-@code{nil}, then the
35716 @code{calc-enter} will copy the element at the cursor to the
35717 top of the stack and @code{calc-pop} will delete the element at the
35718 cursor. The default value of @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is
35719 @code{nil}.
35720 @end defvar
35721
35722 @defvar calc-undo-length
35723 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35724 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35725 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35726 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35727 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35728 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35729 @end defvar
35730
35731 @defvar calc-gregorian-switch
35732 See @ref{Date Forms}.@*
35733 The variable @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is either a list of integers
35734 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} or @code{nil}.
35735 If it is @code{nil}, then Calc's date forms always represent Gregorian dates.
35736 Otherwise, @code{calc-gregorian-switch} represents the date that the
35737 calendar switches from Julian dates to Gregorian dates;
35738 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} will be the first Gregorian
35739 date. The customization buffer will offer several standard dates to
35740 choose from, or the user can enter their own date.
35741
35742 The default value of @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is @code{nil}.
35743 @end defvar
35744
35745 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35746 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35747
35748 @noindent
35749 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35750
35751 @example
35752 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35753 @end example
35754
35755 @noindent
35756 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35757 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35758 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35759 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35760 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35761 regular mailbox.
35762
35763 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35764 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35765 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35766 them right in.
35767
35768 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35769 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35770 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35771 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35772
35773 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35774 repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35775
35776 @c [summary]
35777 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35778 @appendix Calc Summary
35779
35780 @noindent
35781 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35782 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35783 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35784 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35785 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35786 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35787 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35788 command name refer to notes at the end.
35789
35790 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35791 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35792 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35793
35794 @iftex
35795 @begingroup
35796 @tex
35797 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35798 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35799 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35800 \leavevmode%
35801 {\smallfonts
35802 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35803 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35804 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35805 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35806 \thinspace%
35807 {\tt#5}%
35808 {\sl#6}%
35809 }}%
35810 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35811 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35812 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35813 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35814 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35815 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35816 @end tex
35817 @let@:=@sumsep
35818 @let@r=@sumrow
35819 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35820 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35821 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35822 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35823 @end iftex
35824 @format
35825 @iftex
35826 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35827 @let@c@sumbreak
35828 @end iftex
35829 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35830 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35831 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35832 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35833 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35834 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35835 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35836 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35837 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35838 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35839 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35840 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35841 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35842 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35843 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35844 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35845 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35846 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35847 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35848 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35849 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35850 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35851 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35852 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35853 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35854 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35855 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35856 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35857
35858 @c
35859 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35860 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35861 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35862 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35863 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35864 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35865 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35866 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35867 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35868
35869 @c
35870 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35871 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35872 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35873
35874 @c
35875 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35876 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35877 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35878 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35879 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35880 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35881 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35882 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35883 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35884 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35885 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35886 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35887 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35888 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35889 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35890 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35891 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35892
35893 @c
35894 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35895 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35896 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35897 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35898 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35899 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35900 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35901 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35902 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35903
35904 @c
35905 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35906 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35907 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35908 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35909 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35910 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35911 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35912
35913 @c
35914 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35915 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35916 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35917 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35918 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35919 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35920 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35921
35922 @c
35923 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35924 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35925 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35926 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35927 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35928 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35929
35930 @c
35931 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35932 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35933 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35934 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35935 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35936 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35937 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35938
35939 @c
35940 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35941 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35942 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35943 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35944 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35945 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35946 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35947 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35948 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35949 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35950 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35951 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35952 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35953 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35954 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35955 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35956 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35957 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35958 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35959 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35960 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35961 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35962 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35963 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35964 @r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
35965 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35966 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35967 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35968 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35969 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35970 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35971 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35972 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35973 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35974 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35975 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35976 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35977 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35978 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35979 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35980 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35981 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35982 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35983 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35984 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35985
35986 @c
35987 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35988 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35989 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35990 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35991 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35992 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35993 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35994 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35995 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35996 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35997 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35998 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35999 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
36000
36001 @c
36002 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
36003 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
36004 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
36005 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
36006
36007 @c
36008 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
36009 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
36010 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
36011 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
36012
36013 @c
36014 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
36015 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
36016 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
36017 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
36018 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
36019 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
36020 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
36021 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
36022 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
36023 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
36024 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
36025 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
36026 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
36027 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
36028 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
36029 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
36030 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
36031 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
36032 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
36033 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
36034
36035 @c
36036 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36037 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36038 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36039 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
36040 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
36041 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
36042 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
36043 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
36044 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
36045 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
36046 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
36047 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
36048 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
36049 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
36050 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
36051 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
36052 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
36053 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
36054 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
36055
36056 @c
36057 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
36058 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
36059 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
36060 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36061 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36062 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
36063 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
36064 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
36065 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36066 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36067 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36068 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36069 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
36070 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
36071 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
36072
36073 @c
36074 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
36075 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
36076 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
36077 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
36078 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
36079 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
36080 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36081 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36082 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
36083 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
36084 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
36085 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
36086 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
36087 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
36088 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
36089 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
36090 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36091 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36092 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
36093 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
36094 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
36095 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
36096 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
36097
36098 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
36099 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
36100 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
36101 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
36102
36103 @c
36104 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36105 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36106 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
36107 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
36108 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
36109 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
36110 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
36111 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
36112 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
36113 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
36114 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
36115
36116 @c
36117 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
36118 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
36119
36120 @c
36121 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
36122
36123 @c
36124 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
36125 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
36126 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
36127 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
36128 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
36129 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
36130 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
36131 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
36132 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
36133 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
36134 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
36135 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
36136
36137 @c
36138 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
36139 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
36140 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
36141 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
36142
36143 @c
36144 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
36145 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
36146 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
36147 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
36148 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
36149 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
36150 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
36151 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
36152 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
36153 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
36154 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
36155 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
36156 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
36157 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
36158 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
36159 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
36160 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
36161 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
36162
36163 @c
36164 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
36165 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
36166 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
36167 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
36168 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
36169 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
36170 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
36171 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
36172 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
36173 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
36174 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
36175 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
36176
36177 @c
36178 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
36179 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
36180
36181 @c
36182 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
36183 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
36184 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
36185 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
36186 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
36187 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
36188 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
36189 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
36190 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
36191 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
36192 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
36193 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
36194
36195 @c
36196 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
36197 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
36198 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
36199 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
36200 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
36201 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
36202 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
36203 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
36204 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
36205 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
36206 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
36207 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
36208 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
36209 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
36210 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
36211 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
36212 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
36213
36214 @c
36215 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
36216 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
36217 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
36218 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
36219 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36220 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36221 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36222 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36223 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36224 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36225 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36226 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36227 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36228 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36229 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36230 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36231 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36232 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36233 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36234
36235 @c
36236 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36237 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36238 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36239 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36240 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36241 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36242 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36243 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36244 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36245 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36246 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36247 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36248 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36249 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36250 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36251 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36252
36253 @c
36254 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36255 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36256 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36257
36258 @c
36259 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36260 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36261 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36262 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36263 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36264 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36265 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36266 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36267 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36268 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36269
36270 @c
36271 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
36272 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36273 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
36274 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36275 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36276 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36277
36278 @c
36279 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36280 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36281 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36282 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36283 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36284
36285 @c
36286 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36287 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36288 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36289 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36290 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36291 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36292 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36293 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36294 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36295 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36296 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36297 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36298 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36299 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36300
36301 @c
36302 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36303 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36304 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36305 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36306 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36307 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36308 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36309 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36310 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36311 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36312 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36313 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36314
36315 @c
36316 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36317 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36318 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36319 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36320 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36321 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36322 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36323 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36324 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36325 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36326 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36327 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36328 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36329 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36330 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36331 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36332 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36333 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36334 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36335 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36336
36337 @c
36338 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36339 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36340 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36341 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36342 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36343 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36344 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36345 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36346 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36347 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36348 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36349 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36350 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36351
36352 @c
36353 @r{ a b@: l + @: @: @:lupadd@:(a,b)}
36354 @r{ a b@: H l + @: @: @:lufadd@:(a,b)}
36355 @r{ a b@: l - @: @: @:lupsub@:(a,b)}
36356 @r{ a b@: H l - @: @: @:lufsub@:(a,b)}
36357 @r{ a b@: l * @: @: @:lupmul@:(a,b)}
36358 @r{ a b@: H l * @: @: @:lufmul@:(a,b)}
36359 @r{ a b@: l / @: @: @:lupdiv@:(a,b)}
36360 @r{ a b@: H l / @: @: @:lufdiv@:(a,b)}
36361 @r{ a@: l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a)}
36362 @r{ a b@: O l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a,b)}
36363 @r{ a@: H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a)}
36364 @r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a,b)}
36365 @r{ a@: l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a)}
36366 @r{ a b@: O l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a,b)}
36367 @r{ a@: H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a)}
36368 @r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a,b)}
36369 @r{ a@: l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a)}
36370 @r{ a b@: O l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a,b)}
36371 @r{ a@: H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a)}
36372 @r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a,b)}
36373 @r{ a@: l s @: @: @:spn@:(a)}
36374 @r{ a@: l m @: @: @:midi@:(a)}
36375 @r{ a@: l f @: @: @:freq@:(a)}
36376
36377 @c
36378 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36379 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36380 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36381 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36382 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36383 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36384 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36385 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36386 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36387 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36388 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36389 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36390 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36391 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36392 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36393
36394 @c
36395 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36396 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36397 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36398 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36399 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36400 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36401 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36402 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36403 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36404 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36405 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36406
36407 @c
36408 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36409 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36410
36411 @c
36412 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36413 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36414 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36415 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36416 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36417 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36418 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36419 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36420 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36421 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36422 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36423 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36424 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36425 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36426 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36427 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36428 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36429
36430 @c
36431 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36432 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36433 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36434 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36435 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36436 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36437 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36438 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36439 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36440 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36441 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36442 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36443 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36444
36445 @c
36446 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36447 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36448 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36449 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36450 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36451 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36452 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36453 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36454 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36455 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36456 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36457
36458 @c
36459 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36460 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36461 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36462 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36463 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36464
36465 @c
36466 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36467 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36468 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36469 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36470 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36471 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36472 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36473 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36474 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36475 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36476 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36477 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36478 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36479
36480 @c
36481 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36482 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36483 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36484 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36485 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36486 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36487 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36488 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36489 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36490 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36491 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36492 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36493 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36494 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36495 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36496 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36497 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36498 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36499 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36500
36501 @c
36502 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36503 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36504
36505 @c
36506 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36507 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36508 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36509 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36510 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36511 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36512 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36513 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36514 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36515 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36516 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36517 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36518 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36519 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36520
36521 @c
36522 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36523 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36524 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36525 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36526 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36527 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36528 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36529 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36530 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36531 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36532 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36533 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36534 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36535 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36536 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36537 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36538
36539 @c
36540 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36541 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36542 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36543
36544 @c
36545 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36546 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36547 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36548 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36549 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36550 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36551 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36552 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36553 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36554 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36555
36556 @c
36557 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36558 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36559 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36560 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36561 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36562 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36563
36564 @c
36565 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36566
36567 @c
36568 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36569 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36570 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36571 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36572 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36573 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36574 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36575 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36576 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36577 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36578 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36579 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36580 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36581 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36582 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36583 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36584 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36585 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36586 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36587 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36588 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36589 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36590 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36591 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36592 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36593 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36594 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36595 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36596 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36597 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36598 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36599 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36600
36601 @c
36602 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36603 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36604 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36605 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36606 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36607 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36608 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36609 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36610 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36611 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36612 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36613 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36614 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36615 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36616 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36617 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36618 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36619 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36620 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36621 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36622 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36623 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36624 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36625 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36626 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36627 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36628 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36629 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36630 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36631
36632 @c
36633 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36634
36635 @c
36636 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36637
36638 @c
36639 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36640 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36641 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36642 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36643
36644 @c
36645 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36646 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36647 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36648 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36649 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36650 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36651 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36652
36653 @c
36654 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36655
36656 @c
36657 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36658 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36659 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36660
36661 @c
36662 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36663 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36664 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36665 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36666 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36667 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36668 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36669 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36670 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36671 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36672 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36673
36674 @end format
36675
36676 @noindent
36677 NOTES
36678
36679 @enumerate
36680 @c 1
36681 @item
36682 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36683 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36684 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36685 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36686
36687 @c 2
36688 @item
36689 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36690 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36691 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36692
36693 @c 3
36694 @item
36695 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36696 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36697 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36698
36699 @c 4
36700 @item
36701 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36702
36703 @c 5
36704 @item
36705 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36706 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36707
36708 @c 6
36709 @item
36710 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36711 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36712
36713 @c 7
36714 @item
36715 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36716 1=Basic simplifications, 2=Algebraic simplifications, 3=Extended simplifications
36717
36718 @c 8
36719 @item
36720 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36721
36722 @c 9
36723 @item
36724 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36725 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36726
36727 @c 10
36728 @item
36729 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36730 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36731
36732 @c 11
36733 @item
36734 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36735
36736 @c 12
36737 @item
36738 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36739 prefix always clears the mode.
36740
36741 @c 13
36742 @item
36743 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36744
36745 @c 14
36746 @item
36747 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36748 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36749 @iftex
36750 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36751 @end iftex
36752 @table @asis
36753 @item Integer
36754 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36755 @item Float
36756 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36757 @item 0.0
36758 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36759 @item Error form
36760 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36761 @item Interval
36762 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36763 @item Vector
36764 Random element from the vector.
36765 @end table
36766 @iftex
36767 }
36768 @end iftex
36769
36770 @c 15
36771 @item
36772 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36773 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36774
36775 @c 16
36776 @item
36777 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36778 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36779
36780 @c 17
36781 @item
36782 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0--6, 0--31, or 0--366).
36783
36784 @c 18
36785 @item
36786 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36787 the new units.
36788
36789 @c 19
36790 @item
36791 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36792 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36793
36794 @c 20
36795 @item
36796 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36797 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36798 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36799 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36800
36801 @c 21
36802 @item
36803 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36804 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36805 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36806 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36807
36808 @c 22
36809 @item
36810 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36811 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36812 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36813 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36814 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36815 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36816 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36817 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36818 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36819
36820 @c 23
36821 @item
36822 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36823 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36824 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36825 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36826 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36827 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36828
36829 @c 24
36830 @item
36831 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36832 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36833 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36834 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36835 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36836 @iftex
36837 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36838 @end iftex
36839 @table @cite
36840 @item -1
36841 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36842 @item -2
36843 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36844 @item -3
36845 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36846 @item -4
36847 (@var{2}) Error form.
36848 @item -5
36849 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36850 @item -6
36851 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36852 @item -7
36853 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36854 @item -8
36855 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36856 @item -9
36857 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36858 @item -10
36859 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36860 @item -11
36861 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36862 @item -12
36863 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36864 @item -13
36865 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36866 @item -14
36867 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36868 @item -15
36869 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36870 @end table
36871 @iftex
36872 }
36873 @end iftex
36874
36875 @c 25
36876 @item
36877 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36878 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36879 the input vector.
36880
36881 @c 26
36882 @item
36883 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36884
36885 @c 27
36886 @item
36887 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36888
36889 @c 28
36890 @item
36891 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36892
36893 @c 29
36894 @item
36895 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36896
36897 @c 30
36898 @item
36899 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36900 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36901 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36902 of the result of the edit.
36903
36904 @c 31
36905 @item
36906 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36907
36908 @c 32
36909 @item
36910 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36911
36912 @c 33
36913 @item
36914 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36915 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36916
36917 @c 34
36918 @item
36919 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36920 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36921 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36922 backward by that many lines.
36923
36924 @c 35
36925 @item
36926 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36927 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36928 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36929 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36930
36931 @c 36
36932 @item
36933 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36934 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36935 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36936 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36937
36938 @c 37
36939 @item
36940 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36941
36942 @c 38
36943 @item
36944 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36945 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36946
36947 @c 39
36948 @item
36949 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36950 @expr{v - v_0}.
36951
36952 @c 40
36953 @item
36954 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36955 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36956 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36957 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36958 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36959
36960 @c 41
36961 @item
36962 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36963
36964 @c 42
36965 @item
36966 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36967 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36968
36969 @c 43
36970 @item
36971 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36972 value for this graph.
36973
36974 @c 44
36975 @item
36976 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36977
36978 @c 45
36979 @item
36980 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36981 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36982 otherwise.
36983
36984 @c 46
36985 @item
36986 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36987 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36988 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36989 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36990 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36991 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36992 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36993 to evaluate variables.
36994
36995 @c 47
36996 @item
36997 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36998 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36999 assigns
37000 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
37001 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
37002
37003 @c 48
37004 @item
37005 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
37006 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
37007 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
37008 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
37009 and a vector from the stack.
37010
37011 @c 49
37012 @item
37013 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
37014 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
37015
37016 @c 50
37017 @item
37018 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
37019 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
37020 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
37021
37022 @c 51
37023 @item
37024 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
37025 default 2D resolution.
37026
37027 @c 52
37028 @item
37029 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
37030 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
37031 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
37032 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
37033 @end enumerate
37034
37035 @iftex
37036 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
37037 @page
37038 @endgroup
37039 @end iftex
37040
37041
37042 @c [end-summary]
37043
37044 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
37045 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
37046
37047 @printindex ky
37048
37049 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
37050 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
37051
37052 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
37053 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
37054 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
37055 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
37056
37057 @printindex pg
37058
37059 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
37060 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
37061
37062 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
37063 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
37064 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
37065 @iftex
37066 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
37067 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
37068 @end iftex
37069
37070 @printindex tp
37071
37072 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
37073 @unnumbered Concept Index
37074
37075 @printindex cp
37076
37077 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
37078 @unnumbered Index of Variables
37079
37080 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
37081 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
37082 corresponding Lisp variable.
37083
37084 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
37085 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
37086
37087 @printindex vr
37088
37089 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
37090 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
37091
37092 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
37093 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
37094 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
37095 @samp{math-}.
37096
37097 @printindex fn
37098
37099 @bye